Rexton Y200
Rexton Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Maintenance And Repair ..................................... 0B-2 At Least Annually ................................................ 0B-4
Maintenance And Lubrication ............................... 0B-2 Standard Bolts Specifications .............................. 0B-5
Normal Vehicle Use ............................................. 0B-2 Basic Specification ............................................... 0B-6
Explanation Of Scheduled Dimension ........................................................... 0B-6
Maintenance Services ....................................... 0B-2 Specifications ...................................................... 0B-7
Owner Inspections And Services ......................... 0B-3 Recommended Fluids And Lubricants .................. 0B-9
While Operating the Vehicle ................................. 0B-3 Vehicle Identification Number System .............. 0B-10
At Each Fuel Fill ................................................... 0B-3 Vehicle Identification Number (Vin) ..................... 0B-10
At Least Twice a Month ....................................... 0B-3 ManufacturerS Plate ........................................... 0B-11
At Least Monthly ................................................. 0B-3 Engine Number .................................................. 0B-12
At Least Twice a Year .......................................... 0B-3 Vehicle Lifting Procedures .................................. 0B-14
Each Time The Oil is Changed ............................. 0B-4
0B-2 GENERAL INFORMATION
• To carry passengers and cargo within the limitation • Gasoline Engine : 60,000 km (36,000 miles)
of the tire inflation prassure. Refer to “Tire and • Diesel Engine : 45,000 km (24,000 miles)
Wheel” in section 2E. Spark Plug Replacement
• To be driven on reasonable road surfaces and Replace spark plugs with same type.
within legal operating limits.
• Type : BOSCH : F8DC4
BERU : 14F-8DU4
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED Champion : C11YCC
MAINTENANCE SERVICES • Gap : 0.8 ± 0.1 mm
The services listed in the maintenance schedule are Spark Plug Wire Replacement
further explained below. When the following Clean wires and inspect them for burns, cracks or other
maintenance services are performed, make sure all damage. Check the wire boot fit at the Distributor and
the parts are replaced and all the necessary repairs at the spark plugs. Replace the wires as needed.
are done before driving the vehicle. Always use the
proper fluid and lubricants. Brake System Service
Engine Oil and Oil Filter Change Check the disc brake pads or the drum brake linings.
Check the pad and the lining thickness carefully.
Always use above the API SH grade or recommended
engine oil. Tire and Wheel Inspection and Rotation
Engine Oil Viscosity Check the tires for abnormal wear or damage. To
equalize wear and obtain maximum tire life, rotate the
Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an effect on fuel tires. If irregular or premature wear exists, check the
economy and cold weather operation. Lower viscosity wheel alignment and check for damaged wheels. While
engine oils can provide better fuel economy and cold the tires and wheels are removed, inspect the brakes.
weather performance; however, higher temperature
weather conditions require higher viscosity engine oils
for satisfactory lubrication. Using oils of any viscosity Tire Rotation (Left-hand Drive Type)
other than those viscosities recommended could result
in engine damage.
Cooling System Service
Drain, flush and refill the system with new coolant.
Refer to “Recommended Fluids And Lubricants” in
this section.
Air Cleaner Element Replacement
Clean the air cleaner element every.
• Gasoline Engine : 15,000 km (10,000 miles)
• Diesel Engine : 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
YAA0B010
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-3
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-4 GENERAL INFORMATION
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-5
YAA0B020
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-6 GENERAL INFORMATION
BASIC SPECIFICATION
DIMENSION
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-7
SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-8 GENERAL INFORMATION
SPECIFICATIONS (Cont’d)
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-9
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-10 GENERAL INFORMATION
YAA0B040
* K P T G 0 B 1 9 S 1 P 000000
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-11
MANUFACTURER’S PLATE
YAA0B050
YAA0B060
Diesel Engine
YAA0B070
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-12 GENERAL INFORMATION
ENGINE NUMBER
Diesel Engine
Serial Number
0 : Manual T/M
1 : Hydr - Auto Coupling
2 : Automatic T/M
0 : Common
YAA0B080
1 : Left - Hand Drive
2 : Right - Hand Drive
The engine number is stamped on the cylinder block
in front of injection pump.
5 : REXTON
661 : 2299cc
662 : 2874cc
YAA0B090
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL INFORMATION 0B-13
Serial Number
0 : Manual T/M
1 : Hydr - Auto Coupling
2 : Automatic T/M
0 : Common
YAA0B100
1 : Left - Hand Drive
2 : Right - Hand Drive
• The engine number is stamped on the lower rear
side of the alternator.
5 : REXTON
99 : 3.2L
97 : 2.3L
ENGINE TYPE
YAA0B120
YAA0B110
SSANGYONG Y200
0B-14 GENERAL INFORMATION
YAA0B130 YAA0B140
Using Jack
YAA0B150 YAA0B160
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1
ENGINE
SECTION 1A
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-3
COMPONENT LOCATOR
M162 ENGINE
Front View
YAD1A010
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-4 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
Side View
YAD1A020
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-5
M161 ENGINE
Front View
YAD1A030
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-6 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
Side View
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
YAD1A040
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-7
DIESEL ENGINE
Front View
YAD1A050
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-8 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
Side View
YAD1A060
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-9
3. Operate the vehicle under normal operating • There are cracks in the components.
conditoins. • The shaft surface is scratched, nicked or damaged.
4. Visually inspect the suspected component. You • A loose or worn bearing is causing excess seal
should be able to trace the leak path over the white wear.
powder surface to the source.
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-10 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
YAD1A070
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-11
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-12 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
YAD1A080
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-13
Tools Required
001 589 76 21 00 Compression Pressure Tester
001 589 73 21 00 Hand Vacuum Pump
601 589 65 09 00 Socket
Measuring Procedure
Notice: Ensure that no gear is engaged and that
the vehicle is protected from rolling.
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-14 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
YAD1A110
Universal Tool
Cylinder Pressure Leakage Tester Bosch, EFAW 210A
Sun, CLT 228
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-15
Leakage Test
1. Warm the engine up to normal operating
temperature.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the spark plugs.
4. Check the coolant level by opening the coolant
reservoir cap and replenish if insufficient.
5. Open the engine oil filler cap.
6. Connect the tester to air pressure line and adjust
the scale of tester.
7. Install the connecting hose to spark plug hole.
M162 Engine
8. Position the piston of No.1 cylinder at TDC by
rotating the crankshaft.
YAD1A120
YAD1A130
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-16 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
YAD1A140
Universal Tools
Cylinder Pressure Leakage Tester Bosch, EFAW 210 A or Sun CLT 228
Connection Piece Bosch order no. 1 687 010 016
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-17
Leakage Test
1. Run the engine to be the coolant temperature
80 °C (176 °F).
2. Remove the fuel injection nozzle.
3. Open the coolant reservoir.
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if necessary.
5. Open the oil filler cap.
6. Remove the air cleaner cover and element.
7. Position the piston at TDC.
8. Install the connector (1) and connection piece (2).
YAD1A150
9. Calibrate the tester and connect the connection
hose (3)
10. Pressurize with compressed air and compare the
pressure changes with permissible pressure
leakage.
11. If permissible pressure leakage is out of standard,
check followings :
- Intake and exhaust lines.
- Sounds in oil filler area.
- Air bubbles in radiator coolant.
12. Do pressure leakage test for the remaining
cylinders according to the firing order.
• firing order: 1-2-4-5-3
13. Remove the tester.
14. Close the coolant reservoir cap and oil filler cap.
15. Install the air cleaner element and cover.
16. Install the fuel injection nozzle.
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-18 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL DIAGNOSIS
Lack of Engine Decline of • Refer to above in this page. • Refer to above in this page.
Power Compression
Pressure
Malfunction of • Improper ignition timing. • Adjust the ignition timing.
Ignition System
• Faulty spark plug. • Adjust or replace the spark
plug.
• Electric leakage or poor • Connect the cable correctly or
connection of the high tension replace it.
cable.
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-19
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-20 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-21
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-22 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-23
SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Application M162 Engine M161 Engine Diesel Engine
Engine Model M162.990 M161.970 Four-Stroke Diesel
Displacement (CC) 3199 2295 2874
Cylinder (Bore x Stroke) (mm) 89.9 x 84.0 90.9 x 88.4 89 x 92.4
PES 5 M55
Fuel Injection / Ignition System MSE 3.63D MSE 3.53D
C320 RS 168
Compression Ratio 10 : 1 10.4 : 1 22 : 1
Number of Cylinders 6 4 5
Camshaft Valve Arrangement DOHC DOHC SOHC
Camshaft Drive Type Chain-Driven ← ←
Max. Output (ps/rpm) 220 / 6000 149 / 5500 120 / 4000
Max. Torque (kg•m/rpm) 31.6 / 3900 22.4 / 4000 25.5 / 4000
Firing Order 1-5-3-6-2-4 1-3-4-2 1-2-4-5-3
Distributorless
Ignition Type ← -
Double Ignition
Ignition Timing BTDC 8° BTDC 6° ± 2° BTDC 18° ± 10°
Valve Timing Intake Open/ ATDC 11° / ATDC 13.15° / ATDC 11.33° /
Close ABDC 34° ABDC 13.57° ABDC 17°
Exhaust Open/ BBDC 31° / BBDC 16.58° / BBDC 28° /
Close BTDC 14° BTDC 17.05° BTDC 15.25°
Valve Clearance Adjustment Automatic Control ← ←
Idle Speed (rpm) 700 ± 50 750 ± 50 720 - 820
Fuel Injection Pressure (kg/cm²) 3-4 3.2 - 4.2 138 - 146
Oil Capacity (liter) 8.2 7.5 8.0 - 9.5
Lubrication Type Forced by Gear Pump ← ←
Full Flow with Combined Full-Flow and
Oil Filter Type
Paper Filter ← Partial Flow Filter
Fuel Unleaded Gasoline ← Diesel
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-24 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
PERFORMANCE CURVE
M162 Engine
YAD1A160
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-25
M161 Engine
YAD1A170
SSANGYONG Y200
1A-26 ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION
Diesel Engine
YAD1A180
SSANGYONG Y200
ENGINE GENERAL INFORMATION 1A-27
001 589 76 21 00
001 589 73 21 00
Compression Pressure
Hand Vacuum Pump
Tester
YAD1A190 YAD1A210
120 589 02 09 00
610 589 65 09 00
Spark PlugWrench
Socket
YAD1A220 YAD1A200
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1B1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Repair Instructions .............................................. 1B1-2 Camshaft ........................................................ 1B1-66
On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 1B1-2 Camshaft Timing Position ................................ 1B1-71
Engine Assembly ................................................. 1B1-2 Valve Spring .................................................... 1B1-74
Poly V-Belt and Tensioning Device ...................... 1B1-10 Valve Stem Seal .............................................. 1B1-78
Poly V-Belt ...................................................... 1B1-10 Chain Tensioner ............................................... 1B1-79
Poly V-Belt Inspection ...................................... 1B1-12 Timing Chain ................................................... 1B1-83
Tensioning Device ........................................... 1B1-14 Tensioning Rail ................................................ 1B1-88
Crankcase and Cylinder Head ............................. 1B1-16 Cylinder Head Guide Rail ................................. 1B1-89
Crankcase Ventilation System .......................... 1B1-16 Crankcase Guide Rail ...................................... 1B1-90
Generator ........................................................ 1B1-18 Crankshaft Sprocket ........................................ 1B1-91
Power Steering Pump and A/C Bracket ............ 1B1-19 Lubrication System ............................................. 1B1-93
Engine Mount .................................................. 1B1-22 Engine Oil Specification ................................... 1B1-93
Cylinder Head Cover ........................................ 1B1-24 Oil Circulation .................................................. 1B1-94
Cylinder Head Front Cover ............................... 1B1-26 Engine Oil and Oil Filter Element ...................... 1B1-95
Cylinder Head ................................................. 1B1-28 Oil Filter ........................................................... 1B1-97
Oil Pan ............................................................ 1B1-31 Oil Pump ......................................................... 1B1-99
Timing Gear Case Cover .................................. 1B1-33 Oil Pressure Relief Valve ................................ 1B1-100
Crankshaft Sealing Rear Cover ........................ 1B1-35 Oil Non-Return Valve ...................................... 1B1-101
Crankshaft Assembly ......................................... 1B1-37 Oil Dipstick Guide Tube ................................. 1B1-102
Belt Pulley and Vibration Damper ..................... 1B1-37 Unit Repair ...................................................... 1B1-103
Crankshaft Front Radial Seal ............................ 1B1-40 Oil Gallery in Crankcase ................................ 1B1-103
Crankshaft Rear Radial Seal ............................. 1B1-42 Oil Gallery in Cylinder Head ........................... 1B1-105
Crankshaft ....................................................... 1B1-44 Core Plugs in Crankcase ................................ 1B1-108
Connecting Rod ............................................... 1B1-50 Cylinder Bore ................................................ 1B1-110
Piston .............................................................. 1B1-52 Crankcase Mating Surface ............................. 1B1-112
Piston Ring ...................................................... 1B1-55 Cylinder Head Mating Surface ........................ 1B1-114
Flywheel / Driven Plate ..................................... 1B1-57 Specifications ................................................. 1B1-116
Timing Device and Valve .................................... 1B1-60 Fastener Tightening Specifications ................. 1B1-116
Camshaft Adjuster ........................................... 1B1-60 Special Tools and Equipment ........................ 1B1-118
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt ................................... 1B1-65 Special Tools Table ........................................ 1B1-118
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-2 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
YAD1B010
1 Engine Assembly
Tools Required
000 589 10 99 01 Torque Wrench
000 589 40 37 00 Hose Clamp
112 589 00 72 00 Oil Extractor
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-3
YAD1B020
KAA1C010
YAD1B030
YAD1B040
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-4 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B050
YAD1B060
YAD1B070
YAD1B080
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-5
YAD1B090
YAD1B100
YAD1B4M0
KAA1F070
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-6 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B110
YAD1B120
YAD1B130
YAA1F150
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-7
YAD1B140
YAD1B4N0
YAD1B150
YAD1B160
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-8 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
KAA5A2N0
YAD1B180
YAD1B190
YAD1B200
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-9
YAD1B210
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-10 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B330
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-11
YAD1B340
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-12 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B370
YAD1B380
3. Pointed rib.
4. Belt cord visible in the base of rib.
YAD1B390
YAD1B400
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-13
YAD1B410
YAD1B420
YAD1B430
YAD1B440
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-14 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
TENSIONING DEVICE
Preceding Work : Removal of poly v-belt
YAD1B350
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-15
YAD1B250
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-16 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B220
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-17
Operation at Full-Load
• The throttle valve (19) is fully opened.
All the blowby gases flow into the intake air duct
(13) after passing through the oil separator (15,16)
of the cylinder head cover (14) when fully loaded.
This dilluted air will be supplied to the combustion
chamber through the intake manifold (12).
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-18 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
GENERATOR
YAD1B230
1 Nut (M8) .............22.5-27.5 N•m (16.5-20.5 lb-ft) 4 Bolt (M8 x 70, 1 piece)
2 Bolt (M8 x 30, 3 pieces) ........................... 22.5-27.5 N•m (16.5-20.5 lb-ft)
........................... 22.5-27.5 N•m (16.5-20.5 lb-ft) 5 Bolt (M8 x 75, 1 piece)
3 Bolt (M8 x 40, 1 piece) ........................... 22.5-27.5 N•m (16.5-20.5 lb-ft)
........................... 22.5-27.5 N•m (16.5-20.5 lb-ft)
YAD1B240
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-19
YAD1B5A0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-20 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B250
YAD1B090
YAD1B260
YAD1B270
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-21
YAD1B280
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;; Tightening Torque 22.5 - 27.5 N•m
(16.6 - 20.3 lb-ft)
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyy
YAD1B290
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-22 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MOUNT
YAD1B300
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-23
YAD1B310
YAD1B320
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-24 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B450
YAD1B460
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-25
YAD1B470
YAD1B480
YAD1B490
YAD1B500
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-26 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B510
YAD1B520
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-27
YAD1B530
YAD1B540
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-28 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD
Preceding Work : Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of cylinder head front cover
Removal of upper intake manifold
YAD1B550
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-29
Tools Required
116 589 01 34 00 Threaded Pin
116 589 20 33 00 Sliding Hammer
617 589 00 10 00 Allen Wrench Socket
YAD1B600
YAD1B610
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-30 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B620
YAD1B630
YAD1B640
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-31
OIL PAN
YAD1B5B0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-32 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-33
YAD1B690
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-34 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B590
YAD1B700
Installation Notice
Bolt (3, 4) :
22.5 - 27.5 N•m
(16.6 - 20.3 lb-ft)
Tightening Torque
Bolt (9) :
9 - 11 N•m
(80 - 97 lb-in)
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-35
YAD1B710
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-36 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
601 589 03 43 00 Crankshaft Rear Seal Installer
YAD1B740
YAD1B750
YAD1B760
YAD1B770
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-37
CRANKSHAFT ASSEMBLY
BELT PULLEY AND VIBRATION DAMPER
Preceding Work : Removal of cooling fan and viscous clutch
Removal of fan shroud
Removal of drive belt
YAD1B650
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-38 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Components
YAD1B660
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-39
Tools Required
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
YAD1B670
YAD1B680
YAD1B250
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-40 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B780
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-41
Tools Required
601 589 03 14 00 Crankshaft Front Seal Installer
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the radial seal with a screw driver.
Notice: Use a clean cloth not to damage the radial
seal mounting hole and the crankshaft.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-42 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B840
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-43
Tools Required
601 589 03 43 00 Crankshaft Rear Seal Installer
Replacement Proceudre
1. Remove the radial seal with a screw driver.
Notice: Use a clean cloth not to damage the radial
seal mounting hole and the crankshaft.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-44 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT
Preceding Work : Removal of engine assembly
Removal of timing gear case cover
Removal of cylinder head
Removal of crankshaft sealing rear cover
Removal of oil pan
Removal of oil pump
Removal of baffle plate
YAD1B860
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-45
YAD1B870
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-46 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B880
••• Red
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-47
Notice:
• Make sure the crankshaft bearing cap properly
seated in place in the crankcase side. When
perfectly installed, the projected part (arrow)
locates in the left side (intake manifold side).
• Assemble so that the projected part of the cap
and crankcase face the same direction.
YAD1B920
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-48 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Inspection
1. If the length ‘L’ of the crankshaft bearing cap bolt
exceeds 63.8 mm, replace it.
YAD1B930
YAD1B940
YAD1B950
YAD1B960
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-49
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-50 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CONNECTING ROD
Preceding Work : Removal of piston
YAD1B970
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-51
Inspection
1. Measure the basic bore of the connecting rod
bearing.
Notice: If the basic bore exceeds the value of
51.614 mm, replace the bearing or check the
connecting rod.
YAD1B980
YAD1B990
YAD1B0A0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-52 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON
Preceding Work : Removal of engine
Removal of cylinder head
Removal of oil pan
Removal of oil pump
Removal of baffle plate
YAD1B2P0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-53
Removal Procedure
1. Unscrew the connecting rod bearing cap bolt (3)
and remove the cap.
2. Remove the connecting rod and the piston upward.
Notice: Make sure that the bearing cap and shell
are not changed each other.
3. Remove the snap ring (5) and pull out the piston
pin (6).
Notice: Remove the snap ring using a clean cloth
as shown in the right picture so that the piston,
YAD1B2Q0
piston ring, and the snap ring don’t get damaged.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-54 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Installation Procedure
YAD1B2R0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-55
PISTON RING
Preceding Work : Removal of piston
YAD1B2T0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-56 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Replacement Procedure
1. Measure the piston ring’s gap.
YAD1B2U0
YAD1B2V0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-57
YAD1B810
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-58 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-59
Sectional View
YAD1B830
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-60 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B0B0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-61
Functions
When the engine is running, the camshaft rotates the
intake camshaft hydrauically/mechanically relative to
the camshaft sprocket by 34° crankangle to the
‘advanced’ position and back to the ‘retarded’ position.
The camshaft adjuster is actuated electromechanically
by the ECU. The positioning time of approx. 1 second
is dependent on the engine oil pressure at the
camshaft adjuster and on the oil viscosity and oil
temperature, respectively. The position indicator (b)
on the camshaft sprocket (13) provides the camshaft
rotational speed to the position sensor (9) as an input
parameter for the engine ignition control unit.
“Retarded” Position
1. Ignition suitch OFF (‘retarded’)
The compression spring (17) pushes the control
piston (18) against the circlip (19). The engine oil
pressure in the camshaft is eliminated.
2. From 0 to 1000 - 2000 r pm (‘retarded’)
The torque of the internally helically toothed
camshaft sprocket (13) acting in the direction of
rotation of the engine pushes the externally helically
toothed positioning piston(14) against the cover(12)
as a result of the screw action. Consequently, the
likewise internally helically toothed positioning
piston (14) holds the externally helically toothed
YAD1B0C0
flanged shaft (16) together with the bolted-on
12 Seal Cover camshaft (22) in the ‘retarded position’. The
13 Camshaft Sprocket compressing spring (17) pushes the control
14 Adjust Piston (Stops Towards The Front) piston(18) against the circlip (19). The engine oil
16 Flange Shaft flows through 2 oblique drillings in the camshaft
17 Compression Spring flange and in the flanged shaft (16) in to the working
18 Control Piston (Stops Towards The Rear) chamber (A) and holds the positioning piston (14)
19 Circlip additionally in the ‘retarded’ position with the
22 Intake Camshaft available engine oil pressure.
23 Oil Outlet Drilling Leak oil flows off over control and positioning piston
surface, through the control piston drilling and 2
A Working Chamber (Oil Pressure) drillings (23) in the camshaft flange.
Y49 Electromagnetic Actuator (Not Functioning)
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-62 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-63
YAD1B670
YAD1B590
5. Unscrew the nut (6) and remove the ring and seal
cover (11).
Installation Notice
60 - 70 N•m
Tightening Torque
(44 - 52 lb-ft)
YAD1B0E0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-64 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-65
YAD1B0G0
YAD1B0H0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-66 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CAMSHAFT
Preceding Work : Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of cylinder head front cover
Removal of coolant connection fitting
YAD1B0J0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-67
Tools Required
DW 110-120 Holding Pin
Removal Procedure
1. Turn the crankshaft and position the No. 1 cylinder
piston at BTDC 30°.
2. Remove the generator.
3. Remove the chain tensioner. Refer to “Chain
Tensioner” in this section.
YAD1B240
YAD1B530
YAD1B0L0
YAD1B600
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-68 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
8. Unscrew the intake side bolts (8, 11, 13, 14) and
the exhaust side bolts (1, 4, 6, 7).
9. Loosen the remaining bolts and unscrew the intake
and exhaust side camshaft bearing cap bolts.
Notice: Number the camshaft bearing cap bolts
when removing them, so that they don’t get mixed
up.
YAD1B0M0
Installation Procedure
1. Turn the crankshaft and position the No. 1 cylinder
piston at BTDC 30°.
Notice: Turn the crankshaft in the direction of
engine rotation.
YAD1B0N0
YAD1B0P0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-69
YAD1B0Q0
YAD1B0R0
YAD1B600
YAD1B0S0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-70 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B530
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-71
YAD1B0T0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-72 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
DW 110-120 Holding Pin
Inspection
1. Position the No.1 cylinder piston to TDC (OT) by
turning the crankshaft.
Notice: When the OT mark on vibration damper is
aligned with timing gear case cover, the intake
and exhaust cam of cylinder will make the slope
to the center and will face up. In this way, the
adjustment hole of the intake and exhaust
camshaft will match in line with the cylinder head
YAD1B670 upper end, at 3 o’clock, and 9 o’clock direction
each other.
2. Check the timing as below procedure;
- Check if the camshaft adjustment hole is
positioned to 3 o’clock direction at the intake
side and to 9 o’clock direction at the exhaust
side, respectively and align with the cylinder
head mating surface.
- At this condition, check if the OT mark on
vibration damper aligns with the marker on the
timing gear case.
YAD1B0U0
Adjustment Procedure
1. Position the No.1 cylinder to BTDC 30° .
2. Remove the chain tensioner.
3. Remove the exhaust camshaft sprocket.
4. Align the intake and exhaust camshaft flange hole
with the cylinder head upper surface.
• Intake Side : 3 o’clock direction
• Exhaust Side : 9 o’clock direction
5. Align the holes on intake and exhaust camshaft
to the hole on cylinder head. Insert the holding
pin DW 110-120 into the hole.
6. Secure the intake and exhaust camshaft.
7. Position the piston of No.1 cylinder at TDC (OT)
by turning the crankshaft.
8. Turn the camshaft adjuster of the intake camshaft
to the left as much as possible (cam adjuster
‘retarded’ position).
9. Install the chain to the intake camshaft sprocket.
Notice: Timing chain must be placed on the guide
rail in gear case cover.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-73
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-74 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
VALVE SPRING
Preceding Work : Removal of camshaft
Removal of spark plug
YAD1B0V0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-75
Tools Required
111 589 01 59 00 Supporting Bar
111 589 18 61 00 Lever Pusher
111 589 25 63 00 Thrust Piece
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
DW 110-090 Connecting Hose
DW 110-100 Valve Tappet Remover
YAD1B1D0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-76 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B680
YAD1B1E0
YAD1B1F0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-77
(d) 8.5
Size (mm)
(D) 12.3
YAD1B1G0
YAD1B1H0
• Valve Cotter
(B) 9.0
Size (mm)
(H) 9.2 - 9.8
YAD1B1J0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-78 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1K0
Tools Required
119 589 00 43 00 Drift
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the valve stem seal (2) using the pliers.
Notice: Check the valve stem seal for damage and
replace if necessary.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-79
CHAIN TENSIONER
YAD1B1N0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-80 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Removal Procedure
1. Position the No.1 cylinder to TDC (OT).
Notice: Remove the oil filler cap at adjustment
position, and check whether the intake camshaft
cam’s lobe (arrow) stays in the upper side.
YAD1B1Q0
YAD1B1R0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-81
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the thrust pin (6) and the snap ring (5) to
the chain tensioner housing (7).
Notice: When connecting the thrust pin, push in
the thrust pin far enough so that it doesn’t protrude
at the chain tensioner housing.
YAD1B1S0
YAD1B1T0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-82 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Sectional View
YAD1B1U0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-83
TIMING CHAIN
Preceding Work : Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of spark plug
YAD1B1V0
1 Pin 5 Link
2 New Timing Chain 6 Center Plate
3 Timing Chain (Used) 7 Outer Plate
4 Wedge
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-84 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
000 589 58 43 00 Chain Assembly
DW 110-120 Holding Pin
Replacement Procedure
1. Position the No.1 cylinder to TDC (OT).
YAD1B670
YAD1B0Q0
YAD1B1X0
YAD1B1Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-85
YAD1B1Z0
11. Install the jaw (a) and the thrust piece (b) to the
assembly tool as shown in the figures.
YAD1B2B0
YAD1B2C0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-86 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
12. Place the outer plate (7, thickness 1.2 mm) inside
the thrust piece (b).
YAD1B2D0
YAD1B2E0
YAD1B2F0
YAD1B2E0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-87
YAD1B2G0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-88 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
TENSIONING RAIL
Preceding Work : Removal of timing gear case cover
YAD1B2H0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-89
YAD1B2J0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-90 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B2K0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-91
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
Preceding Work : Removal of oil pan
Removal of tensioning rail
Removal of crankcase guide rail
YAD1B2L0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-92 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
615 589 01 33 00 Crankshaft Sprocker Puller
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Put the assembly mark at the crankshaft sprocket
(4) and the timing chain (10) with the paint (arrow).
Notice: Align the assembly marks on cranshaft
sprocket and timing chain. Also, align the
assembly marks on camshaft sprocket and timing
chain when installing.
YAA1C850
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-93
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
ENGINE OIL SPECIFICATION
YAD1B2W0
1 Drain Plug ................................ 25 N•m (18 lb-ft) 3 Engine Oil Filler Cap
2 Oil Filter 4 Dipstick Gauge
Specifications
Application Descrition
Capacity Min : 6.7 L, Max : 8.2 L
Quality • API SH or above grade
• ACEA : A2 or A3
• Approved oil by MB Sheet 229.1
Viscosity • Approved oil by MB Sheet 224.1
Replacemant • Initial at 1000-1500 km, Replace every 15000 km
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-94 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
OIL CIRCULATION
YAD1B2X0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-95
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-96 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3B0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-97
OIL FILTER
Preceding Work : Removal of starter motor
Removal of upper intake manifold
YAD1B3C0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-98 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3D0
3. Remove the oil filter bolt and then remove the oil
filter.
Installation Notice
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-99
OIL PUMP
Preceding Work : Removal of oil pan
YAD1B3E0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-100 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3G0
2. Remove the spring (2), guide pin (3) and the piston
(4).
3. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
Notice: Don’t use the seal for the screw plug.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-101
YAD1B3H0
Functions
The non-return valve prevents the oil in the chain
tensioner from drying up. In other words, it stops oil-
returning in order to prevent the oil in the chain tensioner
from getting dry. As a result, the chain tensioner can
be activated with oil in itself.
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the non-return valve using a pliers.
2. Insert new non-return valve with hand.
YAD1B3J0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-102 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3K0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-103
UNIT REPAIR
OIL GALLERY IN CRANKCASE
Preceding Work : Removal of crankshaft
Removal of oil spray nozzle
YAD1B3M0
Cleaning Procedure
1. Remove the plug (1) with a screwdriver.
2. Using a round bar (3) and hammer, remove the
steel ball (2).
3. Using the compressed air, blow into the oil
galleries and clean it off.
YAD1B4L0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-104 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3N0
Tools Required
102 589 12 15 00 Drift
Sealing Procedure
1. Enlarge the end of main oil gallery (4) to be
diameter of 16mm, depth of 15mm.
2. Using an M16 x 1.5 thread (tap), make the thread
at the end of main oil gallery (4).
3. Throughly clean the oil gallery with compressed
air and tighten the screw plug (M16 x 1.5) after
applying sealing bond on it.
4. Apply Loctite 270 on new plug and tighten to the
hole until the drift 102 589 12 15 00 is stopped
after inserting new plug into the drift.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-105
YAD1B3Q0
Cleaning Procedure
1. Remove the screw plug (1) and the seal (2).
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 15 N•m (11 lb-ft)
Replace the seal with new one.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-106 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Sealing Procedure
1. Remove the screw plug (1) and the seal.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 15 N•m (11 lb-ft)
YAD1B3R0
2. Remove the steel ball from the oil gallery (4), (5),
(6) and (7) using the round bar (12, φ 6 x 700 mm).
YAD1B3S0
YAD1B3T0
YAD1B3U0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-107
YAD1B3V0
YAD1B3W0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-108 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B3X0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-109
Tools Required
102 589 00 15 00 Drift
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the intake and exhaust manifolds.
2. Pull back the core plug until the end of one side
comes out using the screw driver.
YAD1B3Z0
YAD1B4A0
YAD1B4B0
YAD1B4C0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-110 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BORE
YAD1B4D0
Repair Size
Type Group Code Letter1) Cylinder Bore Size (mm)
Standard Size φ 89.9 A φ 89.900 - φ 90.906
X φ 89.906 - φ 89.912
B φ 89.912 - φ 89.918
1st Repair Size A φ 90.150 - φ 90.156
(Standard Size + 0.25) X φ 89.156 - φ 90.162
B φ 90.162 - φ 90.168
2nd Repair Size A φ 90.400 - φ 90.406
(Standard Size + 0.5) X φ 90.406 - φ 90.412
B φ 90.412 - φ 90.418
1)
The group code letters are carved on the surface of the piston crown and in the mating surface
of the crankcase.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-111
YAD1B4E0
Chamfer Angle
YAD1B4F0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-112 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4G0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-113
Chamfering Procedure
1. Chamfer angle : 60°
YAD1B4F0
YAD1B4H0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-114 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4J0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-115
Universal Tool
Sceledum, Type RTY
Surface Grinding Machine Roaro
Schio/Italy
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-116 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SPECIFICATIONS
FASTENER TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-117
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-118 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1W0 YAD1B0W0
YAD1B3Y0 YAD1B0X0
YAD1B3P0 YAD1B580
YAD1B2Y0 YAD1B0Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B1-119
601 589 03 43 00
116 589 01 34 00
Crankshaft Rear Seal
Threaded Pin Installer
YAD1B570 YAD1B730
YAD1B1L0 YAD1B4K0
YAD1B790 YAD1B2M0
YAD1B720 YAD1B560
SSANGYONG Y200
1B1-120 M162 ENGINE MECHANICAL
DW110-090 DW110-120
Connecting Hose Holding Pin
YAD1B0Z0 YAD1B0K0
DW110-100
Valve Tappet Remover
YAD1B1A0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1B2
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Maintenance and Repair ................................... 1B2-2 Valve Stem Seal .............................................. 1B2-63
On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 1B2-2 Chain Tensioner ............................................... 1B2-64
Engine Assembly .............................................. 1B2-2 Timing Chain ................................................... 1B2-68
Crankcase Ventilation System ............................ 1B2-9 Tensioning Rail ................................................ 1B2-73
Generator ........................................................ 1B2-13 Cylinder Head Guide Rail ................................. 1B2-74
Engine Mount .................................................. 1B2-14 Crankcase Guide Rail ...................................... 1B2-76
Poly V-Belt ...................................................... 1B2-16 Crankshaft Sprocket ........................................ 1B2-77
Tensioning Device ........................................... 1B2-18 Piston .............................................................. 1B2-79
Tensioning Device Shock Absorber .................. 1B2-19 Connecting Rod ............................................... 1B2-82
Poly V-Belt Inspection ...................................... 1B2-20 Piston Ring ...................................................... 1B2-84
Cylinder Head Cover ........................................ 1B2-22 Oil Pan ............................................................ 1B2-86
Cylinder Head Front Cover ............................... 1B2-24 Engine Oil and Oil Filter Element ...................... 1B2-88
Cylinder Head ................................................. 1B2-26 Oil Pump ......................................................... 1B2-91
Timing Gear Case Cover .................................. 1B2-30 Oil Pressure Relief Valve .................................. 1B2-93
Crankshaft Sealing Rear Cover ........................ 1B2-33 Oil Non-Return Valve ........................................ 1B2-94
Belt Pulley and Vibration Damper ..................... 1B2-35 Oil Dipstick Guide Tube ................................... 1B2-95
Crankshaft Front Radial Seal ............................ 1B2-38 Unit Repair ........................................................ 1B2-96
Crankshaft Rear Radial Seal ............................. 1B2-40 Core Plugs in Crankcase .................................. 1B2-96
Crankshaft ....................................................... 1B2-41 Cylinder Bore .................................................. 1B2-98
Flywheel / Driven Plate ..................................... 1B2-47 Crankcase Mating Surface ............................. 1B2-100
Camshaft Adjuster ........................................... 1B2-50 Cylinder Head Mating Surface ........................ 1B2-102
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt ................................... 1B2-53 Specifications ................................................. 1B2-104
Camshaft ........................................................ 1B2-54 Fastener Tightening Specifications ................. 1B2-104
Camshaft Timing Position ................................ 1B2-57 Special Tools and Equipment ........................ 1B2-106
Valve Spring .................................................... 1B2-59 Special Tools Table ........................................ 1B2-106
1B2-2 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4S0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-3
YAD1B020
YAD1B4T0
YAD1B4U0
YAD1B040
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-4 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4V0
YAD1B4W0
YAD1B4X0
YAD1B080
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-5
YAD1B090
YAD1B4Y0
Installation Notice
21 - 25 N•m
Tightening Torque
(15 - 18 lb-ft)
YAD1B4Z0
YAD1B110
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-6 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B120
YAD1B130
YAD1B5A0
YAD1B5B0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-7
YAA1F800
YAD1B5C0
YAD1B160
YAD1B5D0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-8 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B5E0
YAD1B5F0
YAD1B5G0
YAD1B5H0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-9
YAD1B5J0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-10 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-11
YAD1B5K0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-12 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-13
GENERATOR
YAD1B5L0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-14 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MOUNT
YAD1B5M0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-15
YAD1B5G0
YAD1B5N0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-16 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
POLY V - BELT
Preceding Work: Removal of cooling fan
YAD1B5P0
YAD1A130
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-17
YAD1B5Q0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-18 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
TENSIONING DEVICE
Preceding Work: Removal of tensioning device shock absorber
YAD1B5R0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-19
YAD1B5T0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-20 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B5U0
YAD1B380
3. Pointed rib.
4. Belt cord visible in the base of rib.
YAD1B390
YAD1B400
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-21
YAD1B410
YAD1B420
YAD1B430
YAD1B440
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-22 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B5V0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-23
YAD1B4T0
YAD1B5A0
YAD1B5X0
YAD1B5Z0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-25
YAD1B6A0
YAD1B6B0 Notice: Replace the O-ring with new one and apply
the sealant.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-26 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of cylinder head front cover
Removal of intake manifold
Removal of cylinder head lower line (intake manifold side)
YAD1B6C0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-27
Tools Required
617 589 00 10 00 Allen Wrench Socket
116 589 20 33 00 Sliding Hammer
116 589 01 34 00 Threaded Pin
111 589 03 15 00 Holding Pin
YAD1B6D0
YAD1B6E0
YAD1B6F0
YAD1B6G0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-28 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B6J0
YAD1B6K0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-29
YAD1B6M0
YAD1B6N0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-30 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B6P0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-31
Tools Required
116 589 20 33 00 Sliding Hammer
116 589 01 34 00 Threaded Pin
YAD1B6D0
YAD1B6J0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-32 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B6K0
YAD1B6Q0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-33
YAD1B6S0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-34 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
601 589 03 43 00 Crankshaft Rear Seal Installer
YAD1B740
YAD1B750
YAD1B760
YAD1B6T0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-35
YAD1B6U0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-36 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Components
YAD1B660
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-37
Tools Required
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
YAD1B6V0
YAD1B680
YAD1B6W0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-38 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B6X0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-39
Tools Required
601 589 03 14 00 Crankshaft Front Seal Installer
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the radial seal with a screw driver.
Notice: Use a clean cloth not to damage the radial
seal mounting hole and the crankshaft.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-40 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B840
Tools Required
601 589 03 43 00 Crankshaft Rear Seal Installer
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the radial seal with a screw driver.
Notice: Use a clean cloth not to damage the radial
seal mounting hole and the crankshaft.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-41
CRANKSHAFT
Preceding Work: Removal of engine
Removal of cylinder head
Removal of timing gear case cover
Removal of crankcase sealing rear cover
Removal of oil pan
Removal of baffle plate
Removal of oil pump
YAD1B6Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-42 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B6Z0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-43
Marking
Bearing Color Selected
Letter
B Blue
Y Yellow
R Red
W White
YAD1B890
V Violet
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-44 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Notice:
• Make sure the crankshaft bearing cap properly
seated in place in the crankcase side. When
perfectly installed, the projected part (arrow) locates
in the left side (intake manifold side).
• Assemble so that the projected part of the cap and
crankcase face the same direction.
YAD1B920
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-45
Inspection
1. If the length ‘L’ of the crankshaft bearing cap
bolt exceeds 63.8 mm, replace it.
YAD1B930
YAD1B940
YAD1B950
YAD1B960
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-46 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-47
YAD1B810
Normal Size D - M x 15
Stretch Side Diameter d When New 8.5 - 0.2 mm
Min. Diameter 8.0 mm
Bolt Length L When New 21.8 - 22.2 mm
Tightening Torque 1st step 45 + 5 N•m (33 + 37 lb-ft), 2nd step 90° + 10°
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-48 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-49
Sectional View
YAD1B830
1 OilPan 8 Washer
2 Cover 9 Bolt
3 Radial Seal 10 Front Drive Plate
4 Bolt 11 Rear Drive Plate
5 Crankshaft 12 Rivet
6 Dowel Pin 13 Segment
7 Washer (Thickness : 3.5 mm) 14 Ring Gear
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-50 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CAMSHAFT ADJUSTER
YAD1B7A0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-51
YAD1B6D0
YAD1B6F0
YAD1B6E0
YAD1B6G0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-52 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-53
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-54 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CAMSHAFT
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of camshaft adjust actuator and cylinder head front cover
YAD1B7D0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-55
YAD1B6D0
YAD1B6F0
YAD1B7E0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-56 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B7F0
YAD1B7G0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-57
YAD1B7H0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-58 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
111 589 03 15 00 Holding Pin
Inspection Procedure
1. Position the NO.1 cylinder piston to ATDC 20 ° by
turning the crankshaft.
Notice: When the ATDC 20 °mark on vibration
damper is aligned with timing gear case cover,
the intake and ex-haust cam of cylinder will make
the slope to the center and will face up. In this
way, the insert hole in NO.1 and NO.4 camshaft
bearing cap will match in line with the flange hole
YAD1B6D0 for camshaft sprocket.
YAD1B6E0
Adjustment Procedure
1. Position the NO.1 cylinder to ATDC 20 °.
2. Remove the chain tensioner.
3. Remove the exhaust camshaft sprocket.
4. Adjust the timing position with inserting the
holding pin 111 589 03 15 00 into the NO.1 and
NO.4 camshaft bearing cap hole and flange hole
while rotating the camshaft by using wrench.
5. Install the chain to the intake camshaft sprocket.
6. Install the chain to the exhaust camshaft sprocket
and tighten the bolt.
Installation Notice
1st step: 18 - 22 N•m
Tightening Torque (13 - 16 lb-ft)
2nd step: 90° ± 5°
The sprocket bolt is designed to be used only
once, so replace with new one.
7. Install the chain tensioner.
Installation Notice
Screw Plug 40 N•m
Tightening (30 lb-ft)
Torque Tensioner 72 - 88 N•m
Assembly (53 - 65 lb-ft)
8. Check the camshaft timing.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-59
VALVE SPRING
Preceding Work: Removal of camshaft
Removal of spark plug
YAD1B0V0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-60 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
111 589 01 59 00 Supporting Bar
111 589 18 61 00 Lever Pusher
111 589 25 63 00 Thrust Piece
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
DW110 - 090 Connecting Hose
DW110 - 100 Valve Tappet Remover
YAD1B7J0
YAD1B1D0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-61
YAD1B680
YAD1B1E0
YAD1B1F0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-62 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1G0
YAD1B1H0
• Valve Cotter
(B) 9.0
Size (mm)
(H) 9.2 - 9.8
YAD1B1J0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-63
YAD1B1K0
Tools Required
119 589 00 43 00 Drift
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the valve stem seal (2) using the pliers.
Notice: Check the valve stem seal for damage
and replace if necessary.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-64 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CHAIN TENSIONER
YAD1B1N0
Removal Procedure
1. Position the number 1 cylinder to ATDC 20 ° .
Notice: Remove the oil filler cap at adjustment
position, and check whether the intake camshaft
cam’s lobe (arrow) stays in the upper side.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-65
YAD1B1Q0
YAD1B1R0
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the thrust pin (6) and the snap ring (5) to
the chain tensioner housing (7).
Notice: When connecting the thrust pin, push in
the thrust pin far enough so that it doesn’t protrude
at the chain tensioner housing.
YAD1B1S0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-66 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1T0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-67
Sectional View
YAD1B1U0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-68 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
TIMING CHAIN
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head cover
Removal of spark plug
YAD1B1V0
1 Pin 5 Link
2 New Timing Chain 6 Center Plate
3 Timing Chain (Used) 7 Outer Plate
4 Wedge
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-69
Tools Required
000 589 58 43 00 Chain Assembly
111 589 03 15 00 Holding Pin
Replacement Procedure
1. Position the NO.1 cylinder to ATDC 20 ° .
YAD1B6D0
YAD1B6E0
YAD1B1X0
YAD1B1Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-70 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1Z0
9. Take out the used timing chain out from the chain
housing.
YAD1B2A0 10. Connect both separators of the new timing chain
with the link (5) and the center plate (6).
11. Install the jaw (a) and the thrust piece (b) to the
assembly tool as shown in the figures.
YAD1B2B0
YAD1B2C0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-71
12. Place the outer plate (7, thickness 1.2 mm) inside
the thrust piece (b).
YAD1B2D0
YAD1B2E0
YAD1B2F0
YAD1B2E0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-72 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-73
TENSIONING RAIL
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head
YAD1B7K0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-74 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B7L0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-75
Tools Required
111 589 03 15 00 Holding Pin
YAD1B7M0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-76 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B7N0
2. Remove the guide rail (2) from the guide rail pin
(1).
Notice:
• Replace the plastic guide (2) if damaged.
• Connect the plastic guide (2) and the guide rail
(1) by aligning them accurately when installing.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-77
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
Preceding Work: Removal of oil pan
Removal of tensioning rail
Removal of crank case guide rail
YAD1B2L0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-78 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
615 589 01 33 00 Crankshaft Sprocket Puller
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-79
PISTON
Preceding Work: Removal of engine
Removal of cylinder head
Removal of oil pan
Removal of oil pump
Removal of baffle plate
YAD1B2R0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-80 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Removal Procedure
1. Unscrew the connecting rod bolt (3) and remove
the cap.
2. Remove the connecting rod and the piston upward.
Notice: Make sure that the bearing cap and shell
are not changed each other.
Installation Procedure
YAD1B2R0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-81
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-82 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CONNECTING ROD
Preceding Work: Removal of piston
YAD1B970
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-83
Inspection
1. Measure the basic bore of the connecting rod
bearing.
Notice: If the basic bore exceeds the value of
51.614 mm, replace the bearing or check the
connecting rod.
YAD1B980
YAD1B990
YAD1B0A0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-84 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON RING
Preceding Work: Removal of piston
YAD1B2T0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-85
Replacement Procedure
1. Measure the piston ring’s gap.
Groove 1 0.20 - 0.40 mm
End Gap of the
Groove 2 0.20 - 0.40 mm
Piston Ring
Groove 3 0.20 - 0.45 mm
Gap Between Groove 1 0.028 - 0.060 mm
the Piston and the Groove 2 0.010 - 0.045 mm
Piston Ring Groove 3 0.010 - 0.045 mm
Notice: If out of specification, replace the piston
ring.
YAD1B2U0
YAD1B2V0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-86 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
OIL PAN
YAD1B7P0
1 Bolt 5 Bolt
2 Bolt 6 OilPan
3 Bolt 7 Gasket
4 Bolt
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-87
Oil Circulation
YAD1B7Q0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-88 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B7R0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-89
Tools Required
103 589 02 09 00 Oil Filter Remover
Replacement Procedure
1. Install the oil filter remover 103 589 02 09 00 on
the oil filter cover.
Notice: Make the screw cover removable by
tightening the bolt at the side of the oil filter
remover 103 589 02 09 00.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-90 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-91
OIL PUMP
Preceding Work: Removal of oil pan
YAD1B7U0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-92 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
Insert the steel gasket into the oil pump and bolt
(4) mounting surface.
YAD1B7W0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-93
YAD1B7X0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-94 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B7Y0
Functions
The non-return valve prevents the oil in the chain ten-
sioner from drying up. In other words, it stops oil-
returning in order to prevent the oil in the chain
tensioner from getting dry. As a result, the chain
tensioner can be activated with oil in itself.
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the non-return valve using a pliers.
2. Insert new non-return valve with hand.
YAD1B7Z0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-95
YAD1B8A0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-96 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
UNIT REPAIR
CORE PLUGS IN CRANKCASE
Preceding Work: Draining of the coolant
YAD1B8B0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-97
Tools Required
102 589 00 15 00 Drift
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the intake and exhaust manifolds.
2. Pull back the core plug until the end of one side
comes out using the screw driver.
YAD1B3Z0
YAD1B4A0
YAD1B4B0
YAD1B4C0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-98 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BORE
YAD1B8C0
Engine Group Code Letter of Cylinder Piston Type to be Used Cylinder Bore Size (mm)
A A or X φ 90.906 - φ 90.912
X A, X or B φ 90.906 - φ 90.912
E23 B X or B φ 90.912 - φ 90.918
X+5 X+5 φ 90.950 - φ 90.968
X + 10 X + 10 φ 91.000 - φ 91.018
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-99
Group Code Letter Cylinder Group Code Letter 1) Cylinder Bore Size (mm)
Standard Size A φ 89.900 - φ 89.906
∅ 90.9 X φ 89.906 - φ 89.912
B φ 89.912 - φ 89.918
1st Repair Size A φ 90.150 - φ 90.156
(Standard Size + 0.25) X φ 89.156 - φ 90.162
B φ 90.162 - φ 90.168
2nd Repair Size A φ 90.400 - φ 90.406
(Standard Size + 0.5) X φ 90.406 - φ 90.412
B φ 90.412 - φ 90.418
1) The group code letters are carved on the surface of the piston crown and in the mating surface of the crankcase.
1, 2, 3 Measuring Points
A. Axial Direction
B. Transverse Direction
a. Location of the No.1 Piston Ring at TDC
b. Location of the Piston BDC
YAD1B4E0 c. Location of the Oil Ring at BDC
Chamfer Angle
YAD1B4F0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-100 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4G0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-101
Chamfering Procedure
1. Chamfer angle : 75 °
YAD1B4F0
YAD1B4H0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-102 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B4J0
Notice: Do not exceed 0.4 mm for the milling of the mating surface of crankcase and cylinder head.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-103
Universal Tool
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-104 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
SPECIFICATIONS
FASTENER TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-105
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-106 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B1W0 YAD1B2Y0
YAD1B0W0 YAD1B0Y0
YAD1B0X0 YAD1B580
YAD1B570 YAD1B1L0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B2-107
601 589 03 14 00
602 589 00 40 00
Crankshaft Front Seal
Engine Lock
Installer
YAD1B790 YAD1B720
YAD1B4K0 YAD1B560
615 589 01 33 00
DW110 - 090
Crankshaft Sprocket
Connecting Hose
Puller
YAD1B2M0 YAD1B0Z0
601 589 03 43 00
DW110 - 100
Crankshaft Rear Seal
Valve Tappet Remover
Installer
YAD1B730 YAD1B1A0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B2-108 M161 ENGINE MECHANICAL
111 589 03 15 00
Holding Pin
YAD1B4R0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1B3
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ...............................1B3-2 Valve Stem Seals............................................ 1B3-98
Valve Device .................................................... 1B3-2 Valve Guides ................................................ 1B3-102
Component Locator .......................................... 1B3-4 Valve Seat Rings .......................................... 1B3-105
Cylinder Head ................................................... 1B3-4 Camshaft ...................................................... 1B3-112
Cylinder Block .................................................. 1B3-6 Timing Chain ................................................ 1B3-118
Engine Component ........................................... 1B3-8 Chain Tensioner ............................................ 1B3-122
Repair Instructions .......................................... 1B3-10 Lubrication System .......................................... 1B3-124
On-Vehicle Service ........................................... 1B3-10 Oil Filter ........................................................ 1B3-124
Engine Assembly ..............................................1B3-10 Oil Spray Nozzle........................................... 1B3-126
Poly V-Belt and Tensioning Device .................... 1B3-19 Oil Pump ....................................................... 1B3-127
Poly V-Belt ...................................................... 1B3-19 Unit Repair ..................................................... 1B3-129
Tensioning Device .......................................... 1B3-23 Milling of Prechamber Sealing Surface ......... 1B3-129
Crankcase and Cylinder Head ........................... 1B3-26 TDC(TDC Sensor Bracket) Setting ................ 1B3-133
Cylinder Head ................................................. 1B3-26 Machining of Flywheel .................................. 1B3-135
Prechamber .................................................... 1B3-46 Hydraulic Valve Clearance Compensation
Element Check .......................................... 1B3-136
Oil Pan ............................................................ 1B3-48
Valve Springs Check .................................... 1B3-138
Timing Case Cover ......................................... 1B3-49
Check and Machining of Valves ................... 1B3-139
Crankshaft Assembly ........................................ 1B3-56
Machining of Valve Seat ............................... 1B3-144
Vibration Damper and Hub ............................. 1B3-56
Camshaft Timing Test ................................... 1B3-149
Flywheel and Crankshaft End Cover ............... 1B3-62
Cylinder Head Pressure Leakage Test ......... 1B3-151
Crankshaft Ball Bearing .................................. 1B3-66
Facing Cylinder Head Mating Surface .......... 1B3-152
Crankshaft ...................................................... 1B3-67
Replacement of Crankcase Core Plug .......... 1B3-154
Crankshaft Sprocket ....................................... 1B3-76
Facing Crankcase Contacting Surface .......... 1B3-156
Piston .............................................................1B3-81
Cylinder Bore Measurement ......................... 1B3-157
Flywheel Ring Gear ......................................... 1B3-87
Specifications ................................................ 1B3-158
Timing Device and Valve ................................... 1B3-90
Fastener Tightening Specifications ............... 1B3-158
Valve Tappets ................................................ 1B3-90
Valve Spring (Cylinder Head Removed) ......... 1B3-92 Special Tools and Equipment ...................... 1B3-160
Valve Spring (Cylinder Head Installed) ...........1B3-95 Special Tools Table ...................................... 1B3-160
1B3-2 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BA30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-6 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK
YAD1BA50
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-7
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-4 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CYLINDER HEAD
YAD1BA40
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-5
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-8 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE COMPONENT
YAD1BA60
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-9
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-10 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
YAD1BA70
1. Engine Assembly
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-11
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
YAD1BA80
YAD1BA90
YAD1B020
YAD1BAA0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-12 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BAB0
YAD1BAC0
YAD1BAD0
YAD1BAE0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-13
;;
;; YAD1BAF0
;;
Installation Notice
;;
(27 - 62 lb-in)
YAD1BAG0
;;
;; YAD1BAH0
YAD1BAJ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-14 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BAK0
YAD1BAL0
YAD1BAM0
YAD1BAN0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-15
YAD1BAP0
YAD1BAQ0
20. Remove the fuel lines from the fuel filter and cover
the filter with plug.
YAD1BAR0
YAD1BAS0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-16 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BAT0
YAD1BAU0
YAD1BAV0
YAD1BAW0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-17
YAD1BAX0
YAD1BAY0
YAD1BAZ0
YAD1BB00
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-18 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BB10
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-19
YAD1BB20
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-20 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BB30
YAD1BB40
YAD1BB50
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-21
YAD1BB60
YAD1B380
3. Pointed rips.
4. Belt cord visible in the base of rips.
YAD1B390
YAD1B400
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-22 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1B410
YAD1B420
YAD1B430
YAD1B440
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-23
TENSIONING DEVICE
Preceding Work: Removal of cooling fan
YAD1BLJ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-24 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BB30
YAD1BB40
4. Remove the bolt (9) and then remove the belt pulley
(8).
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 10 N•m (89 lb-in)
YAD1BB70
5. Remove the bolt (1, 18) and take off the damper
(2).
Installation Notice
YAD1BB80
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-25
6. Pull off the tensioning lever (4) from guide rail pin.
7. Remove the spring (17).
Notice: Insert spring (17) with color coding (blue/
violet) facing up.
YAD1BB90
YAD1BBA0
9. Pry off the closing cover (16) and remove the fit
bolt (15).
Installation Notice
YAD1BBB0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-26 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BBC0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-27
1 Bolt.................................. 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)+90° 10 Cylinder Head Bolt ............................ See Table
2 Washer 11 Plug
3 Camshaft Drive Sproket ......................... Relace 12 Engine Coolant Temperature
4 Camshaft 13 Thermo Valve Sensor
5 Bolt.......................................... 10 N•m (89 lb-in) 14 Cylinder Block
6 Threaded Ring ...................... 130 N•m (96 lb-ft) 15 Gasket................................................... Replace
7 Prechamber 16 Cylinder Head
8 Bolt.......................................... 25 N•m (18 lb-ft) 17 Sliding Rail
9 Camshaft Bearing Cap
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-28 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Cylinder Head Bolts (12-sided socket head) 1st Step 10 N•m (89 lb-in)
(Engine cold) 2nd Step 35 N•m (26 lb-ft)
3rd Step 180°
M8 Cylinder Head Bolts 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
YAD1BBD0
YAD1BBE0
The twelve-sided socket head bolts are tightened with
each stages of torque and torque angle.
It is not necessary to retighten the cylinder head bolts
at the 1000~1500 km inspection or after 1000~1500
km of repairs.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-29
Tools Required
116 589 02 34 00 Threaded Pin
116 589 03 07 00 T Type Socket Wrench
116 589 20 33 00 Sliding Hammer
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
603 589 00 40 00 Counter Holder
Removal Procedure
1. Completely drain the coolant from the radiator and
cylinder block.
2. Remove the cooling fan shroud.
YAD1BBF0 3. Hold the fan with counter holder 603 589 00 40 00
and remove the bolt and then remove the cooling
fan.
YAD1BBG0
YAD1BB30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-30 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BB40
YAD1BBH0
YAD1BBJ0
YAD1BBK0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-31
YAD1BBL0
13. Remove the fuel injection line (1) from the fuel
injection nozzle (12).
YAD1BBM0
14. Remove the fuel injection line from the fuel injection
pump.
YAD1BBN0
YAD1BBP0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-32 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BBQ0
YAD1BBT0
YAD1BBR0
YAD1BBS0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-33
YAD1BBU0
YAD1BBV0
22. Remove the heater pipe bracket from the oil filter.
23. Pry off the clamp and push the heater feed pipe
forward and then pull out the pipe.
YAD1BBW0
YAD1BBX0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-34 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BBY0
YAD1BBZ0
YAD1BC00
YAD1BC10
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-35
YAD1BC20
YAD1BC30
YAD1BC40
YAD1BC50
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-36 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BC60
YAD1BC70
YAD1BC80
36. Remove the bearing caps and then pull out the
camshaft(20) upward.
Notice: Be careful not to miss the locking washer.
YAD1BC90
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-37
YAD1BCA0
YAD1BCB0
YAD1BCC0
YAD1BCD0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-38 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Installation Procedure
1. Replace the cylinder head gasket.
YAD1BCE0
YAD1BCF0
YAD1BBE0
YAD1BCG0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-39
YAD1BCH0
YAD1BBD0
YAD1BCK0
YAD1BCL0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-40 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BBX0
YAD1BBY0
11. Install the sliding rail (24) and insert the sliding
rail pins (25, 26) using the sliding hammer 116
589 20 33 00 (36) and threaded pin 116 589 02 34
00 (37).
Notice: Apply sealing compound on the each
collar of the sliding rail pins.
YAD1BCA0
YAD1BCM0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-41
14. Coat the camshaft with oil and install the camshaft
on the cylinder head to be TDC mark(arrow)
upward.
15. Measure the axial end play of the camshaft.
Installation Notice
End Play 0.06 ~ 0.21 mm
YAD1BCN0
YAD1BCP0
YAD1BCQ0
YAD1BC30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-42 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BCR0
YAD1BC10
YAD1BC70
YAD1BCS0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-43
YAD1BCT0
YAD1BC60
YAD1BC40
24. Insert the nozzle washer into the hole to face round
part downward.
25. Install the fuel injection nozzle.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 40 N•m (30 lb-ft)
YAD1BCU0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-44 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BBU0
YAD1BCV0
YAD1BBV0
YAD1BCW0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-45
YAD1BCX0
YAD1BCY0
YAD1BBN0
YAD1BCZ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-46 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BB30
YAD1BBG0
40. Hold the cooling fan with the counter holder 603
589 00 40 00 and tighten the bolt.
YAD1BBF0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-47
PRECHAMBER
Preceding work: Removal of glow plug
Removal of fuel injection nozzle
Tools Required
603 589 00 09 00 Serration Wrench
667 589 03 63 00 Sliding Hammer
Removal Procedure
1. Using the serration wrench 603 589 00 09 00 (4),
remove the threaded ring (1).
YAD1BD00
YAD1BD10
YAD1BD20
YAD1BD30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-48 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Installation Procedure
Notice: In case the prechambers are reused,
inspect the prechambers thoroughly, if the ball
pin by heat and fire is broken, it can not be used.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-49
OIL PAN
YAD1BD50
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-50 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BD60
1 Bolt ...........................................10 N•m (89 lb-in) 13 Bolt ........................................... 32 N•m (24 lb-ft)
2 Cylinder Head Cover 14 Timing Case Cover
3 Gasket.................................................... Replace 15 Bolt ........................................... 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
4 Socket Bolt .............................. 25 N•m (18 lb-ft) 16 Generator Bracket
5 Fuel Filter 17 Bolt ........................................... 45 N•m (33 lb-ft)
6 Square Nut 18 Bolt ........................................... 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
7 Oil Pan 19 Bolt ...........................................10 N•m (89 lb-in)
8 Socket Bolt ..............................10 N•m (89 lb-in) 20 Closing Cover
9 Bolt .................................. M6 : 10 N•m (89 lb-in) 21 Socket Bolt .............................. 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
......................................... M8 : 23 N•m (17 lb-ft) 22 Guide Pulley
10 Power Steering Pump 23 Bolt ............................................. 9 N•m (80 lb-in)
11 Bolt 24 Guide Pulley Bracket
12 Belt Pulley 25 Nut ............................................ 23N•m (17 lb-ft)
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-51
Tools Required
116 589 03 07 00 T Type Socket Wrench
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the fan clutch and cooling fan belt pulley.
2. Drain the engine oil completely.
3. Remove the crankshaft pulley.
4. Loosen the bolt (1) and then remove the cylinder
head cover (2) and gasket.
5. Remove the vacuum pump.
YAD1BCV0
YAD1BD70
YAD1BD80
9. Remove the nut and pull out the bolt and then
remove the power steering pump.
YAD1BD90
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-52 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BDA0
YAD1BDB0
YAD1BDC0
YAD1BDD0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-53
15. Remove the oil pan bolts (8, 9) in the area of the
timing case cover (14).
16. Slightly loosen the remaining oil pan bolts.
YAD1BDE0
17. Remove the timing case cover (19) bolts and then
remove the timing case cover (14).
Notice: Be careful not to damage the cylinder
head gasket or oil pan gasket.
YAD1BDF0
Installation Procedure
1. Thoroughly clean the sealing surface and apply
sealant.
YAD1BDG0
Bolts arrangement
1. M6 x 60
2. M6 x 70
3. M6 x 40
YAD1BDH0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-54 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BDC0
YAD1BDJ0
YAD1BDK0
YAD1BDL0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-55
YAD1BDM0
YAD1BDN0
YAD1BDP0
YAD1BD80
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-56 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
15. Install the guide pulley (22) and fit the closing
cover (20).
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
YAD1BD70
17. Install the cooling fan belt pulley and fan clutch.
18. Install the belt tensioning device and then install
the belt.
19. Install the cooling fan.
20. Fill the engine oil and check oil leaks by running
the engine.
YAD1BCV0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-57
CRANKSHAFT ASSEMBLY
VIBRATION DAMPER AND HUB
Preceding Work: Removal of the cooling fan
Removal of poly V-belt
YAD1BDQ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-58 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-59
Tools Required
103 589 00 33 00 Puller
601 589 03 14 00 Sleeve
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the starter motor and install the engine
lock 602 589 00 40 00 into the flywheel ring gear.
2. Remove the poly V-belt.
3. Remove the cooling fan.
Notice: Keep the fan in vertical position.
YAD1BC40
YAD1BDR0
YAD1BDS0
YAD1BDT0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-60 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BDU0
YAD1BDV0
10. Pull out the radial seal (1) and be careful not to
damage the sealing surface of timing case cover.
YAD1BDW0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-61
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hub.
Notice: Exactly align the woodruff key and the
groove of hub (arrow).
YAD1BDX0
YAD1BDY0
YAD1BDZ0
YAD1BE00
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-62 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BE10
YAD1BE20
YAD1BE30
;;;;
;;;;
;;;;
A Standard Radial Seal
YAD1BE40 B Repair Radial Seal
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-63
YAD1BE50
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-64 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
601 589 03 43 00 Oil Seal Assembler
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
Removal Procedure
1. Install the engine lock 602 589 00 40 00.
2. Remove the 12-sided stretch bolts.
Notice: Remove the flywheel and drive plate, if
equipped with automatic transmission.
YAD1BE60
YAD1BE70
YAD1BE80
YAD1BE90
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-65
Installation Procedure
1. Throughly clean the sealing surface of end cover
and apply Loctite 573.
2. Clean the groove of radial seal.
3. Apply Loctite 573 on the bolts and install the end
cover.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 10 N•m (89 lb-in)
YAD1BEA0
YAD1BEB0
YAD1BEC0
;;; ;;;;
;;;;
not run in any groove which the standard radial
seal may have left on the crankshaft flange.
;;; ;;;;
;;; ;;;;;
;;;;;
;;; ;;;;;
A Standard Radial Seal
YAD1BED0 B Repair Radial Seal
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-66 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BEE0
YAD1BEF0
;;;;
;
yyyy ;;
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;
yyyyy
;;;;
;
yyyy ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;
;;;;
;
yyyy ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;
;;;;
yyyy
; ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;; YAD1BEG0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-67
YAD1BEH0
Tools Required
000 589 25 33 00 Internal Extractor
000 589 33 33 00 Counter Support
YAD1BEJ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-68 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
CRANKSHAFT
Preceding Work: Removal of the end cover
Removal of the piston
Removal of the crankshaft sprocket
YAD1BEK0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-69
YAD1BEL0
Notice: The gaps between the bearing shell and bore and between the bearing shell and journal are different
each other. Refer to service data.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-70 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Bearing Clearances
Crankshaft bearing Thrust bearing
Radial clearances New 0.027 - 0.051 mm 0.026 - 0.068 mm
Limit Max. 0.070 mm Max. 0.080 mm
Axial clearances New 0.100 - 0.254 mm -
Limit Max. 0.300 mm -
Notice:
• Measure crankshaft axial clearance and adjust with proper thrust Bearing.
• The same thickness of washer must be installed on both sides of the fit bearing.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-71
Marking of basic bearing bore in lower parting surface Color code of relevant crankshaft bearing shell
1 punch mark or blue Blue or white-blue
2 punch marks or yellow Yellow or white-yellow
3 punch marks or red Red or white-red
Marking of bearing journals on crank webs Color code of relevant crankshaft bearing shell
Blue or white-blue Blue or white-blue
Yellow or white-blue Yellow or white-yellow
Red or white-blue Red or white-red
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-72 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools required
001 589 53 21 00 Dial Gauge
363 589 02 21 00 Dial Gauge Holder
366 589 00 21 05 Extension
YAD1BEN0
YAD1BEP0
YAD1BEQ0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-73
YAD1BES0
YAD1BET0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-74 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BEU0
YAD1BEV0
YAD1BEW0
18. Coat the upper thrust bearing (4) with oil and insert
into the crankcase so that the oil grooves are facing
the crank webs (arrow).
YAD1BEX0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-75
19. Coat the lower thrust bearing (7) with oil and insert
into the crankshaft bearing cap so that the oil
grooves are facing the crank webs (arrow).
Notice: The retaining lugs should be positioned
in the grooves (arrow).
YAD1BEY0
YAD1BEZ0
20. Coat the new crankshaft with engine oil and place
it on the crankcase.
21. Install the crankshaft bearing caps according to
marking and tighten the bolts.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 55 N•m (41 lb-ft)+ 90°
YAD1BF00
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-76 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BF20
YAD1BF30
Radial Clearance ‘L’ 0.026 - 0.068 mm
32. Fill oil and run the engine and then check the oil
pressure and oil level.
Notice: Install the original oil filter element and
then change the engine oil and oil filter element
after 1,000 - 1,500 km.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-77
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
Preceding Work: Removal of oil pan
Removal of timing case cover
YAD1BF40
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-78 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Special Tools
102 589 05 33 00 Puller
116 589 07 15 00 Drift
Removal Procedure
1. Pull out the tensioning lever (19) together with the
spring (17) and guide rail (16) far enough until the
tensioning lever has passed the oil pump chain
(9) and is resting against the crankshaft (13).
YAD1BF50
YAD1BF60
YAD1BF70
YAD1BF80
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-79
YAD1BF90
YAD1BC20
YAD1BFA0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-80 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Installation Procedure
1. Put the same alignment mark on the new
crankshaft sprocket as in the old sprocket.
Notice: Check the timing chain, camshaft
sprocket, injection pump timing sprocket, oil pump
chain and oil pump sprocket for wear and replace
if necessary.
YAD1BFB0
YAD1BFC0
YAD1BF90
YAD1BC20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-81
YAD1BCS0
YAD1BFD0
YAD1BFE0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-82 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
PISTON
Preceding Work: Removal of the cylinder head
Removal of the oil pump
YAD1BFF0
Notice: There are two kinds of connecting rods (for machining) and they are different in weight approx. 15g.
When replacing the connecting rod, measure its weight and ensure that a engine has the same weight of connecting
rods. If not, there would be a unbalancing of engine.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-83
Service Data
Thread M9 x 1
Stretch shaft (C) diameter (new) 7.4 mm
Minimum stretch shaft diameter (C) 7.1 mm
Length (L) (new) 52 mm
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-84 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
000 589 04 14 00 Tensoning Strap
001 589 53 21 00 Dial Gauge
363 589 02 21 00 Dial Gauge Holder
Removal Procedure
1. Remove combustion residues from the cylinder
bores.
2. Remove the connecting rod bolts (12) and then
remove the connecting rod bearing caps (11).
YAD1BFG0
YAD1BFH0
YAD1BFJ0
5. Remove the snap ring (4) and pull out the piston
pin (5).
6. Separate the piston and connecting rod.
YAD1BFK0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-85
Installation Procedure
1. Fit the piston onto the connecting rod so that the
arrow (15) and the locking slot (16) are facing in
direction of the vehicle.
YAD1BFL0
2. Coat the piston pin (15) with engine oil and insert
it by hand.
Notice: Do not heat up the piston.
YAD1BFM0
YAD1BFN0
YAD1B2V0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-86 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BFQ0
YAD1BFR0
YAD1BFS0
YAD1BFT0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-87
12. Coat the bolts (12) with oil and then tighten the
bolts.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 35 N•m (26 lb-ft)+ 90°
YAD1BFU0
YAD1BFV0
YAD1BFW0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-88 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BFX0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-89
Tools Required
001 589 53 21 00 Dial Gauge
363 589 02 21 00 Dial Gauge Holder
Replacement Procedure
1. Drill a hole into the ring gear (1) (arrow) and snap
with a chisel.
2. Thoroughly clean the collar surfaces of ring gear.
YAD1BFY0
YAD1BFZ0
YAD1BG00
5. Install the new ring gear (1) onto the flywheel (2)
by using a drift.
YAD1BG10
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-90 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BG20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-91
YAD1BG30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-92 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
102 589 03 40 00 Magnetic Bar
Replacement Procedure
1. Pull out the valve tappet (1) using magnetic bar
102 589 03 40 00.
YAD1BG40
YAD1BG50
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-93
YAD1BG60
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-94 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
102 589 03 40 00 Magnetic Bar
116 589 06 63 00 Magnetic Finger
601 589 01 59 00 Assembling Board
601 589 02 59 00 Supporting Bridge
667 589 00 31 00 Press Lever
YAD1BG80
YAD1BG90
YAD1BGA0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-95
YAD1BGB0
YAD1BGC0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-96 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGD0
Notice: Remove the valve springs only when the piston is at TDC.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-97
Tools Required
102 589 03 40 00 Magnetic Bar
116 589 06 63 00 Magnetic Finger
603 589 01 40 00 Holding Wheel
667 589 00 31 00 Press Lever
667 589 02 63 00 Supproting Bar
YAD1BGE0
YAD1BGF0
YAD1BGG0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-98 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGH0
YAD1BGG0
YAD1BGE0
13. Coat the valve tappet with oil and install it with
magnetic bar 102 589 03 40 00.
YAD1BG40
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-99
YAD1BGJ0
Notice: Remove the valve stem seals when the pistion is positioned at TDC.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-100 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
102 589 03 40 00 Magnetic Bar
104 589 00 37 00 Pliers
116 589 06 63 00 Magnetic Finger
601 589 02 43 00 Drift
603 589 01 40 00 Holding Wheel
667 589 00 31 00 Press Lever
667 589 02 63 00 Supporting Bar
YAD1BGK0 YAD1BGL0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-101
Replacement Procedure
1. Remove the valve tappet (1) with magnetic bar
102 589 03 40 00.
Notice: Place the valve tappets upside down
(open end upward).
YAD1BG40
YAD1BGM0
YAD1BGE0
YAD1BGG0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-102 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGH0
YAD1BGN0
8. Insert the cap (12) onto the valve (6) and install
the new valve stem seal (5) with drift 601 589 02
43 00 and then remover the cap.
YAD1BGP0
YAD1BGG0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-102 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGH0
YAD1BGN0
8. Insert the cap (12) onto the valve (6) and install
the new valve stem seal (5) with drift 601 589 02
43 00 and then remover the cap.
YAD1BGP0
YAD1BGG0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-103
VALVE GUIDES
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head
Removal of valve spring
Removal of valve
YAD1BGQ0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-104 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGR0
Tools Required
000 589 10 53 00 Reamer (for Exhaust)
000 589 10 68 00 Cylinder Brush
000 589 21 53 00 Reamer (for Intake)
102 589 00 23 00 GO / NO GO Gauge (for Intake)
103 589 02 15 00 Drift (for Exhaust)
103 589 03 15 00 Drift (for Intake)
115 589 34 63 00 Mounting Device
117 589 03 23 00 GO / NO GO Gauge (for Exhaust)
346 589 00 63 00 Super Cooling Box
601 589 05 15 00 Drift (for Intake)
601 589 06 15 00 Drift (for Exhaust)
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-105
Checking
1. Thoroughly clean the valve guide bore using a
cylinder brush 000 589 10 68 00.
YAD1BGS0
YAD1BGT0
Replacement Procedure
1. Drive out the valve guide (2) by using a drift
(Intake: 103 589 03 15 00, Exhaust: 103 589 02 15
00) (5).
Notice: The valve guide must be driven out
upward of the cylinder head.
YAD1BGU0
YAD1BGV0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-106 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGX0
YAD1BGY0
6. Cool down the new valve guide (2) into the super
cooling box 346 589 00 63 00 with liquid nitrogen.
Notice: Do not touch the cooled valve guide by
hand.
YAD1BGZ0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-107
YAD1BH00
YAD1BH10
YAD1BH20
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-108 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BH30
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-109
Commercial Tools
Cylinder Head Clamping Device Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Type Ventilknecht K2000
Order No. 221 00 100
Valve Seat Turning Tool Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Type VDS 1A
Order No. 236 03 308
Ring Seat Turning Tool Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Type RDS 1
Order No. 219 00 100
Pneumatic Removal / Installation Device Hunger
(Drift : 8 mm, 9 mm, 14 mm) D-8000 München 70
Type PVM 1
Tensioning Head Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Order No. 250 15 250
Cutting Tool for Recessing Grooves Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Order No. 217 93 601
Test Set for Valves Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Order No. 216 69 210
Internal Dial Gauge (Range : 25 - 60 mm) Mahr
D-7300 Esslingen
Order No. 844
External Micrometer (Range : 25 - 60 mm) Mahr
D-7300 Esslingen
Order No. 40 S
Electrically Heated Water Tank Otto Dürr
D-7123 Sachsenherm - Ochsenbach
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-110 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
115 589 34 63 00 Mounting Device
345 589 00 63 00 Super Cooling Box
Removal Procedure
1. Measure dimension ‘A’.
Limit 142.5 mm
YAD1BH40
YAD1BH50
YAD1BH60
YAD1BH70
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-111
YAD1BH80
YAD1BHA0
Overlap U = 0.120 mm
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-112 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BGY0
16. Cool down new valve seat ring (2) into the cooling
box 345 589 00 63 00 with liquid nitrogen.
Notice: Do not touch the cooled valve seat rings
with hand.
YAD1BHC0
YAD1BHD0
YAD1BHE0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-113
CAMSHAFT
Preceding Work: Removal of cylinder head cover
YAD1BHH0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-114 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
602 589 00 40 00 Engine Lock
Removal Procedure
1. Rotate the crankshaft and position the piston of
No.1 cylinder at TDC.
Notice: Do not rotate the crankshaft in the opposite
direction of engine rotation.
YAD1BC10
YAD1BC30
YAD1BC20
YAD1BC40
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-115
YAD1BC70
YAD1BC60
YAD1BC80
YAD1BC90
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-116 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BCM0
Installation Procedure
1. Insert the locking washer.
2. Check the valve tappet and ensure that tappet
moves smoothly.
3. Coat the camshaft with oil and install the camshaft
onto the cylinder head so that the TDC marking
(arrow) is positioned upward vertically.
YAD1BCN0
YAD1BCP0
YAD1BCQ0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-117
YAD1BC30
YAD1BC70
YAD1BCS0
YAD1BHJ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-118 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BC40
YAD1BC10
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-119
TIMING CHAIN
Preceding Work: Removal of glow plug
Removal of chain tensioner
Removal of cooling fan
Removal of cylinder head cover
YAD1BHK0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-120 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
000 589 58 43 00 Chain Assembling Device
Replacement Procedure
1. Cover over the chain box with cleaning rag and
grind off both chain pins (arrow) at a chain link (1)
of the timing chain.
YAD1BHL0
YAD1BHM0
YAD1BHN0
YAD1BHP0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-121
YAD1BHQ0
YAD1BHR0
YAD1BHS0
YAD1BHT0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-122 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
11. Place the fitting tool (8) onto the chain link and
rivet the chain pins one by one.
35 - 40 N•m
Tightening Torque
(20 - 30 lb-ft)
YAD1BHS0
YAD1BHL0
YAD1BC10
YAD1BC30
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-123
CHAIN TENSIONER
YAD1BHU0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-124 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Place the chain tensioner in engine oil up to over the collar on the hexagon head with the thrust pin facing up.
Slowly push down the thrust pin as far as the stop 7~10 times with the aid of a press or a column drill.
YAD1BHV0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-125
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
OIL FILTER
YAD1BHW0
1 Housing Cap ............................ 25 N•m (18 lb-ft) 5 Bolt........................................... 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
2 O-Ring .................................................... Replace 6 Oil Pressure Switch
3 Oil Filter ............... Element replace if necessary 7 Gasket
4 Oil Filter Housing
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-126 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BHX0
YAD1BHY0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-127
YAD1BHZ0
YAD1BJ00
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-128 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
OIL PUMP
Preceding Work: Removal of oil pan
YAD1BJ10
YAD1BJ20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-129
YAD1BJ30
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-130 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
UNIT REPAIR
MILLING OF PRECHAMBER SEALING SURFACE
YAD1BJ40
Notice: The prechamber sealing surface may only be remachined once with the cylinder head fitted. It is essential
to adhere to the specified projection ‘C’ of the prechamber of 7.6 - 8.1mm.
This ensures that the required clearance exists between prechamber and piston crown with the piston in TDC. For
this reason, spacer rings should be inserted on remachined sealing surfaces.
Thickness of spacers 0.3, 0.6, 1.0 mm
If a spacer ring is already fitted, or a marking is made on the cylinder head, the cylinder head must be removed
and size ‘C’ measured if further remachining is necessary on a prechamber sealing surface.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-131
Tools Required
601 589 00 66 00 Counter Sink
607 589 00 23 00 Height Gauge
YAD1BJ60
YAD1BJ70
YAD1BJ80
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-132 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJ90
YAD1BJA0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-133
YAD1BJB0
Notice:
The TDC sensor bracket must be adjusted in case of followings.
• When replacing the TDC sensor bracket.
• When replacing the crankshaft, the hub or the vibration damper.
• When replacing or installing the timing case cover.
• After engine overhauling.
* If the cylinder head is removed, the measuring pin of the dial gauge can be positioned on the piston crown.
This is done by placing the magnetic dial holder on the mating surface of the crankcase.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-134 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
001 589 32 21 00 Dial Gauge
601 589 07 21 00 Measuring Device
667 589 01 21 00 Fixing Device
YAD1BC10
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-135
MACHINING OF FLYWHEEL
YAD1BJE0
1 Flywheel
Machining of Flywheel
;;
yyyy
;;;;
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
Notice: Flywheels which have scorch marks, scoring
or cracks in the clutch surface should be machined by
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
grinding or precision-turning. If the scores or cracks
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
are severe than permissible specifications, replace the
flywheel.
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy
Distance ‘a’ 19.3 - 19.5 mm
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
Distance ‘b’ New 16.6 mm
;;;;
yyyy
;;
;;;;
yyyy Repair up to 15.6 mm
;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
Max. axial runout 0.05 mm
YAD1BJF0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-136 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJG0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-137
Checking
Notice: The noise which continues short time during
short travel (frequent starting of the engine) or engine
starting after a long time storage is normal operating
conditions. So, it does not need to be repaired.
Determine the malfunctions in valve clearance
compensation device with noise through following tests.
If defective, replace as respectively.
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-138 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJJ0
Service Data
At preloaded
Outer diameter Wire diameter Free length
Length Tension (new) Limit
33.1 mm 4.20 mm 50.0 mm 27 mm 680 - 740 N 612 N
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-139
YAD1BJK0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-140 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJL0 YAD1BJM0
Matching Valves
Camshaft Cam Basic Dia. Camshaft Cam Basic Dia.
Valve to be used
W = 38.0 ± 0.2 mm W = 36.6 ± 0.2 mm
Use machined valve,
19.5 - 20.1 mm if needed
Size (x) 19.5 - 20.3 mm
new repair valve
I = 105.5 ± 0.2 mm
Size (x) 20.4 - 21.4 mm 20.2 - 21.2 mm Reuse valve
Use standard size
Size (x) 21.4 - 21.97 mm 21.2 - 21.97 mm valve
I = 106.4 ± 0.2 mm
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-141
Tools Required
001 589 32 21 00 Dial Gauge
Commercial Tool
Valve corn grinding machine
YAD1BJP0
YAD1BJQ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-142 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJR0
YAD1BJS0
YAD1BJT0
YAD1BJU0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-143
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-144 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJV0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-145
Service Data
Item Intake Exhaust
Valve Arrears ‘a’ 0.1 - 0.7 mm 0.1 - 0.7 mm
Valve Seat Width ‘b’ 1.2 - 1.7 mm 1.5 - 2.0 mm
Valve Seat Angle ‘α’ 45° 45°
Valve Seat Free Angle ‘β’ 65° 65°
Permissible Radial Runout 0.03 mm 0.03 mm
Valve Length ‘I’ Standard 106.20 - 106.60 mm 106.20 - 106.60 mm
Repair 105.30 - 105.70 mm 105.30 - 105.70 mm
Matching Valves
Camshaft Cam Basic Dia. Camshaft Cam Basic Dia.
Valve to be Used
w = 38.0 ± 0.2 mm w = 37.6 ± 0.2 mm
Use machined valve,
19.5 - 20.3 mm 19.5 - 20.1 mm if needed
Size (x)
use pair valve
1 = 105.5 ± 0.2 mm
Size (x) 20.4 - 21.4 mm 20.2 - 21.2 mm Reuse valve
Use standard size
Size (x) 21.4 - 21.97 mm 21.2 - 21.97 mm valve
I = 106.4 ± 0.2 mm
Commercial Tools
Cylinder Head Clamping Devie Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Type Ventilknecht K2000
Order No. 221 00 100
Valve Seat Turning Tool Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Type VDS 1A
Order No. 236 03 308
Test Sat for Valves Hunger
D-8000 München 70
Order No. 217 93 601
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-146 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Machining Procedure
Valve machining is required :
- When the valve is leaking.
- When replacing the valve.
- When replacing the valve guide.
- When replacing the valve seat or valve seatring.
YAD1BJW0
YAD1BJX0
YAD1BJY0
YAD1BJZ0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-147
YAD1BJS0
38 ± 0.2 mm
Diameter ‘w’
or 37.6 ± 0.2 mm
YAD1BJT0
YAD1BJU0
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-148 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BJK0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-149
YAD1BK00
Timing
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-150 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tools Required
001 589 53 21 00 Dial Gauge
363 589 02 21 00 Dial Gauge Holder
366 589 00 21 05 Extension
Measurement Procedure
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Rotate the engine in the direction of engine rotation
until the intake valve of no. 1 cylinder is completely
closed. The cam lobe faces up (arrow).
Notice: Do not rotate the engine at the bolt of the
YAD1BK10 crankshaft sprocket. Do not rotate the engine in
the opposite direction of engine rotation. If do,
this will cause serious measuring errors.
YAD1BK20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-151
YAD1BK30
1 Feed Pipe
2 Bolt
3 Return Connection
4 Gasket.................................................................. Replace
5 Coolant Gallery .................................................... Sealing
6 Pressure Measuring Plate ................................... Completely tight to the cylinder head
7 Cylinder Head ......................................................
Immerse with pressure measuring plate into warm water of approx. 60°C (140°F) and pressurize with
compressed air of 2 bar.
Notice: If air bubbles are seen, replace the cylinder head.
Tools Required
115 589 34 63 00 Mounting Device
601 589 00 25 00 Pressure Testing Device
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-152 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BK40
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-153
Measurement Procedure
1. Measure height ‘A’.
Limit 142.5 mm
YAD1BK50
YAD1BJS0
YAD1BK60
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-154 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BK70
Service Data
φ 34 mm
Left
3 EA
φ 34 mm
Right
3 EA
φ 17 mm
Front
1 EA
φ 34 mm
Rear
1 EA
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-155
Tools Required
102 589 00 15 00 Drift
102 589 12 15 00 Drift
Replacement Procedure
1. Completely drain the coolant.
2. Remove any parts which impede access.
(Example : transmission, injection pump)
3. Place the screwdriver to the deepdrawn edge of
the core plug and pull forward and then rotate 90°.
YAD1B3Z0
YAD1B4B0
YAD1BK80
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-156 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BK90
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-157
YAD1BKA0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-158 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
SPECIFICATIONS
FASTENER TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Application N•m Lb-Ft Lb-In
12-Sided Stretch Bolt (Flywheel) 45 + 90° 33 + 90° -
Camshaft Bearing Cap Bolt 25 18 -
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt 25 + 90° 18 + 90° -
Chain Tensioner 80 59 -
Connecting Rod Bearing Cap Bolt 35 + 90° 26+ 90° -
Cooling Fan Belt Pulley Bolt 10 - 89
Cooling Fan Shroud Bolt 3-7 - 27 - 62
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Bolt 55 + 90° 41 + 90° -
Crankshaft Belt Pulley Bolt 23 17 -
Cylinder Head Bolt 1st Step 10 - 89
2nd Step 35 26 -
Torque Angel 90° 90° -
Wait For 10 min 10 min -
Torque Angel 90° 90° -
Cylinder Head Cover Bolt 10 - 89
Damper Bolt 21 15 -
Drain Plug (Cylinder Head) 30 22 -
End Cover Bolt 10 - 89
Engine Mounting Bolt 50 - 75 37 - 55 -
Exhaust Manifold Nut 25 18 -
Fuel Filter Pipe Bolt 25 18 -
Fuel Line (to Injection Pump) 13 10 -
Fuel Pipe (to Injection Nozzle) 18 13 -
Fuel Pipe (to Injection Pump) 18 13 -
Generator Bracket Bolt 25 18 -
Generator Mounting Bolt Upper 25 18 -
Lower 45 33 -
Guide Pulley Bolt 23 17 -
Guide Pulley Bracket Bolt 9 - 80
Hub Bolt 200 + 90° 148 + 90° -
Idle Pulley Bolt 23 17 -
Injection Nozzle 40 30 -
Injection Pump Mounting Bolt 23 17 -
Intake Manifold Nut 25 18 -
Oil Dipstick Tube Bracket Bolt 10 - 89
Oil Filter Housing Bolt 25 18 -
Oil Filter Housing Cap 25 18 -
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-159
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-160 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BKW0 YAD1BKS0
YAD1BLC0 YAD1BKR0
YAD1BL60 YAD1B1W0
YAD1BLD0 YAD1BLG0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-161
001 589 53 21 00
102 589 05 33 00
Dial Gauge
Puller
YAD1BKJ0 YAD1BKU0
102 589 00 15 00
102 589 12 15 00
φ 34) Drift
(φ
φ 17) Drift
(φ
YAD1B3Y0 YAD1B1A0
102 589 00 23 00
103 589 00 33 00
Go/No Go Gauge
Puller
(for Intake)
YAD1BLF0 YAD1BKM0
YAD1BKX0 YAD1BL80
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-162 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
YAD1BL40 YAD1BKF0
YAD1BL70 YAD1BL10
115 589 34 63 00
Mounting Device 116 589 07 15 00
Drift
YAD1BKG0 YAD1BKV0
YAD1BLH0 YAD1B580
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-163
YAD1BLE0 YAD1BKH0
YAD1BL90 YAD1BKD0
363 589 02 21 00
601 589 01 59 00
Dial Gauge Holder
Assembling Board
YAD1BKQ0 YAD1BKY0
601 589 02 43 00
366 589 00 21 05 Drift
Extension
YAD1BKP0 YAD1BL50
SSANGYONG Y200
1B3-164 DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL
601 589 02 59 00
601 589 06 15 00
Supporting Bridge
Drift (for Exhaust)
YAD1BKZ0 YAD1BLB0
YAD1B790 YAD1BKK0
601 589 03 43 00
602 589 00 40 00
Oil Seal Assembler
Engine Lock
YAD1BKN0 YAD1B720
YAD1BLA0 YAD1BKB0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE MECHANICAL 1B3-165
667 589 00 31 00
603 589 00 40 00
Press Lever
Counter Holder
YAD1B4K0 YAD1BL00
YAD1BL20 YAD1BKL0
YAD1BKC0 YAD1BL30
667 589 00 23 00
Height Gauge
YAD1BKE0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1F1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Engine and ECM Problem Check Report ........... 1F1-3 Resonance Flap ................................................1F1-66
Diagnostic Information and Procedure ............. 1F1-4 Stop Lamp Switch ............................................. 1F1-67
Failure Code Diagnosis ...................................... 1F1-4 Engine RPM ..................................................... 1F1-68
Clearing Failure Codes ....................................... 1F1-4 Exhaust System ................................................ 1F1-69
Failure Codes Table ........................................... 1F1-4 Catalytic Converter ...........................................1F1-69
Ignition System ................................................... 1F1-8 Oxygen Sensor ................................................. 1F1-70
Ignition Coil ......................................................1F1-10 Engine Control Module .................................... 1F1-76
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor .....................1F1-12 Serial Data Communication ............................... 1F1-77
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor ....................... 1F1-16 Internal Failure .................................................. 1F1-79
Camshaft Actuator ............................................1F1-20 Electronic Throttle Controller Safety Malfunction . 1F1-80
Knock Sensor (KS) ...........................................1F1-22 Immobilizer ......................................................1F1-82
Spark Plug ....................................................... 1F1-24 Maintenance and Repair ................................. 1F1-83
System Voltage ................................................1F1-28 On-Vehicle Service ........................................... 1F1-83
Ignition Switch .................................................. 1F1-29 Discharging the Pressure in Fuel System .......... 1F1-83
Fuel System ...................................................... 1F1-30 Fuel Pump ........................................................ 1F1-83
Fuel Pump ........................................................ 1F1-32 Fuel Filter .......................................................... 1F1-84
Fuel Injector ......................................................1F1-36 Fuel Tank .......................................................... 1F1-85
Purge Control Valve .......................................... 1F1-40 Fuel Pressure Regulator .................................... 1F1-86
Fuel Rail ...........................................................1F1-42 Fuel Rail and Injector ........................................1F1-87
Fuel Pressure Regulator .................................... 1F1-44 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor .................. 1F1-88
Induction System .............................................. 1F1-46 Throttle Body (Integrated with the Actuator) .......1F1-89
Throttle Valve Actuator ...................................... 1F1-46 Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) Sensor ........................ 1F1-90
Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) Sensor ........................ 1F1-50 Knock Sensor ................................................... 1F1-90
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor ........ 1F1-54 Pedal Position Sensor ....................................... 1F1-91
Accelerator Pedal Module .................................1F1-58 Oxygen Sensor ................................................. 1F1-91
Clutch Switch ................................................... 1F1-61 Purge Control Valve .......................................... 1F1-92
Cooling Fan ......................................................1F1-62 Canister............................................................ 1F1-92
A/C Compressor Relay .....................................1F1-63 Camshaft Position Sensor .................................1F1-92
Cruise Control Switch ........................................1F1-64 Crankshaft Position Sensor ............................... 1F1-93
Traction Control System (TCS) ...........................1F1-65 Engine Control Module ...................................... 1F1-93
1F1-2 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Schematic and Routing Diagrams ................... 1F1-94 Fastener Tightening Specifications .................. 1F1-102
ECM Wiring Diagram Fuel System Specification ............................... 1F1-103
(3.2L DOHC - MSE 3.63D) ............................... 1F1-94 Temperature vs Resistance ............................. 1F1-103
Specifications ................................................. 1F1-101 Special Tools and Equipment ........................ 1F1-104
Engine Data Display Table .............................. 1F1-101 Special Tools Table .........................................1F1-104
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-3
MIL INFORMATION
Condition of MIL o Remains on o Sometimes illuminates o Does not illuminate
DTC inspection o Normal o Malfunction code(s) (code )
(if available) o Freeze Frame data ( )
PROBLEM DESCRIPTION
o Engine Does Not Start o No cranking o No initial combustion o No complete combustion
o Hard to Start o Slow cranking
o Others
o Poor Idling o Incorrect first Idle o Abnormal idle rpm o High (rpm) o Low (rpm)
o Idling Unstable o Others
o Poor Driveability o Hesitation o Back fire o Muffler explosion (after-burning)
o Surging o Knocking o Poor performance o Other
o Engine Stall o Soon after starting o After accelerator pedal depressed
o After accelerator pedal released o During A/C operation
o Shifting from N to D or D to N
o At full steering o Others
o Others
Problem Frequency o Constant o Intermittent (times per day/month) o Once only o Others
Weather o Fine o Cloudy o Rainy o Snowy o Various/Others
Ambient Temperature o Hot o Warm o Cool o Cold (approx.____°F/____°C)
Place o Highway o Suburbs o Inner City o Uphill o Downhill
o Rough Road o Others
Engine Temperature o Cold o Warming Up o Before warming up o After warm-up
o Any temp. o Others
Engine Operation o Starting o Just after starting (min.) o Idling o Racing o Driving
o Constant speed o Acceleration o Deceleration
o A/C switch ON/OFF o Other
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-5
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-6 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-4 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Parameters listed in the table may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument or other
factors. If a failure code is displayed during the “TROUBLE CODE” in scan tool check mode, check the circuit for
the code listed in the table below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the “See Page” for
the re-spective “Failure Code” in the below table.
Failure codes should be cleared after repairs have been completed.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-7
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-8 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
IGNITION SYSTEM
This ignition system does not use a conventional These systems use the EST signal from the ECM to
distributor and coil. It uses a crankshaft position control the EST. The ECM uses the following
sensor input to the Engine Control Module (ECM). The information:
ECM then determines Electronic Spark Timing (EST) • Engine load (mass air flow sensor).
and triggers the electronic ignition system ignition coil.
• Engine temperature.
This type of distributorless ignition system uses a
‘‘waste spark” method of spark distribution. Each • Intake air temperature.
cylinder is paired with the cylinder that is opposite it • Crankshaft position.
(1-6 or 2-5 or 3-4). The spark occurs simultaneously in • Engine speed (rpm).
the cylinder coming upon the compression stroke and
in the cylinder coming up on the exhaust stroke. The
cylinder on the exhaust stroke requires very little of
the available energy tofire the spark plug. The
remaining energy is available to the spark plug in the
cylinder on the compression stroke.
YAD1F080
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-10 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
IGNITION COIL
YAD1F090
The Electronic Ignition (EI) system ignition coil is located on the cylinder head cover. The double ended coils
receive the signal for the Engine Control Module (ECM) which controls the spark advance.
Each EI system ignition coil provides the high voltage to two spark plugs simultaneously;
T1/1: cylinder 2 and 5
T1/2: cylinder 3 and 4
T1/3: cylinder 1 and 6
The EI system ignition coil is not serviceable and must be replaced as an assembly.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-11
YAD1F100
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No ignition voltage Malfunction of ignition circuit • Inspection the ECM pin 70 (71 and72)
output Primary current values or about short circuit or open with bad
64 (No. 1 ignition coil) secondary short circuit contact
• Inspection the power source to ignition
Circuit Description
The Electronic Ignition (EI) system uses a waste spark method of spark distribution. The Crankshaft Position
(CKP) sensor sends reference pulses to the ECM. The ECM then triggers the EI system ignition coils. Once the
ECM triggers the EI system ignition coils both of the connected spark plugs fire at the same time. One cylinder
is on its compression stroke at the same time that the other is on the exhaust stroke, resulting in lower energy
needed to fire the spark plugin the cylinder on its exhaust stroke.
This leaves there remainder of the high voltage to be used to fire the spark plug in the cylinder on its compression
stroke.
Since the CKP sensor is in a fixed position, timing adjustments are not possible or needed.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-12 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F110
This Electronic Ignition (EI) system uses inductive or pick up type magnetic Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
The CKP sensor is located in the opposite side of the crankshaft pulley and triggers the pick-up wheel teeth
which is equipped 60 - 2 teeth with a gap of 2 teeth at 360 degree spacing. This sensor protrudes throughits
mount to within 1.1 ± 0.14 mm.
The output of the sensor is a sinusoidal signal. Each tooth of the pick-up 60 - 2 wheel generates a positive half
wave.
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses this sensor signal to generate timed ignition and injection pulses that it
sends to the ignition coils and to the fuel injectors.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-13
YAD1F120
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Crankshaft position Even through cam position • Monitoring the actual rpm through or
17 sensor signal failure recognition is normal, no scan tool
(no engine revolution crankshaft position signal
signal) recognition • Inspection the ECM pin 100, 99 about
short circuit with bad contact
Crankshaft position When more than applicable
sensor signal failure revolution values or implau- • Inspection the CKP sensor
18
(rpm > max. value) sible to 60-2 teeth scan tool • Inspection the air gap between sensor
and drive plate
Crankshaft position When implausible recognition • Inspection the drive plate (teeth condi-
sensor signal failure of cam and crank angle signal tion)
20 (gap recognition failure) or intermittent sensing the
signal or error count of • Inspection the ECM
undetected gap.
Crankshaft position When faulty crank angle
67 sensor adaptation sensor adaption
failure
Circuit Description
The 58X reference signal is produced by the CKP sensor. During one crankshaft revolution, 58 crankshaft pulses
will be produced. The ECM uses the 58X reference signal to calculate engine rpm and CKP. The ECM constantly
monitors the number of pulses on the 58X reference circuit and compares them to the number of Camshaft
Position (CMP) signal pulses being received. If the ECM receives and incorrect number of pulses on the 58X
reference circuit, this failure code will set.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Resistance Inspection
1. Disconnect the coupling “E” of ECM while the ignition switch is in “OFF” position.
2. Measure the resistance between the coupling terminal pin No. 99 and No. 100 using a multimeter.
Specified Value 1,050 ~ 1,400 Ω
Notice: Measure the insulator resistance of the CKP sensor if out of the specified value.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-14 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F130
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-16 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F140
The Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor sends a CMP signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM). The ECM uses
this signal as a “synchronized pulse” to trigger the injectors in the proper sequence. The ECM uses the CMP
signal to indicate the position of the #1 piston during its power stroke. This allows the ECM to calculate true
sequential fuel injection mode of operation.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-17
YAD1F150
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Camshaft position When no cam recognition • Inspection the source voltage of CMP
sensor signal : No. 1 signal during TN 24 counts sensor
19 cylinder recognition more.
failure (maintain the constant low or • Inspection the ECM pin 106, 104 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
high level)
Camshaft position When synchronization fault of • Inspection the CMP sensor
sensor signal : No. 1 cylinder 1 • Inspection the damage of sensor or
58 cylinder synchronization (TDC recognition) sprocket
failure
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The CMP sensor sends a cam position signal to the ECM. If the cam position signal is lost while the engine is
running, the fuel injection system shifts to a calculated sequential fuel injection mode based on the last fuel
injection pulse, and the engine continuous to run.
Camshaft Position Sensor Signal Voltage Inspection
1. Measure the voltage between the ECM terminal No. 11 and No. 106 while the engine speed is at idle.
Specified Value 1.2 ~ 1.7 v
Notice: The signal voltage will be changed in the range of 1.2 ~ 1.7 v.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-18 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F160
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-20 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
CAMSHAFT ACTUATOR
YAD1F170
1 Bolt 4 Armature
2 Camshaft Actuator 5 Roll Pin
3 Bolt 6 Nut
When the engine is running, the camshaft actuator rotates the intake camshaft hydraulically and mechanically
relative to the camshaft sprocket by 32° crank angle to the “advanced” position and back to the “retard”
position.
The camshaft actuator is actuated electro-mechanically by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The positioning time of apporx. 1 second is dependent on the engine oil pressure at the camshaft actuator and on
the oil viscosity and oil temperature, respectively.
The camshaft indicator on the camshaft sprocket provides the camshaft rotational speed to the position sensor
as an input parameter for the engine ignition control unit.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-21
YAD1F150
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Camshaft actuator short When malfunction of cam • Monitoring the actual operational status
circuit to battery phasing control through scan tool
226
• Inspection the ECM pin 73 about short
circuit or open
Camshaft actuator short • Inspection the power source short circuit
circuit to ground or or open to cam actuator
227 open
• Inspection the magnet and hardware
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-22 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F180
The Knock Sensor (KS) detects abnormal knocking in the engine. The two KS are mounted in the engine block
near the cylinders. The sensors produce an output voltage which increases with the severity of the knock. This
signal is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM) via a shielded cable. The ECM then adjusts the ignition timing
to reduce the spark knock.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-23
YAD1F190
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 1 knock sensor When recognition in more than • Inspection the ECM pin 118, 117about
signal failure control gain threshold at short circuit or open with bad contact
normal operational condition of
56 other system during over 75 • Inspection the KS 1 malfunction
and 3,000 rpm running area • Inspection the ECM
(cylinder 1, 2, 3)
• Inspection the ECM pin 115, 114 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
No. 2 knock sensor When recognition in more than
signal failure control gain threshold at • Inspection the KS 2 malfunction
normal operational condition of • Inspection the ECM
57 other system during over 75
and 3,000 rpm running area
(cylinder 4, 5, 6)
Circuit Description
The KS system is used to detect engine detonation, allowing the ECM to retard the ignition control spark timing
based on the KS signal being received. The KS signal’s amplitude and frequency depend upon the amount of
knock being experienced. The ECM monitors the KS signal and can diagnose the KS sensor and circuitry.
Knock Sensor Resistance Inspection
1. Disconnect the coupling from ECM while the ignition switch is in “OFF” position.
2. Measure the resistance between the coupling terminal pin No. 118 and No. 117 and terminal pin No. 115 and
No. 114 using a multimeter.
Specified Value >10 MΩ
Notice: Replace the KS if the measured values is out of the specified values. Check the connector and wire
connection between ECM and the KS if the measured values are normal.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-24 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
SPARK PLUG
YAD1F200
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-25
YAD1F210
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Random / Multiple When detection misfire of • Inspection the ignition system
Misfire multiple cylinder for source of
over the emission • Inspection the injection system
threshold or catalyst damage • Inspection the fuel pressure
• Inspection the compression pressure
• Inspection the valve timing or clearance
68
• Inspection the air flow sensor
• Inspection the crankshaft position sensor
and air gap
• Inspection the engine wiring system
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM)
Circuit Description
The ECM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft positions to detect if the engine is misfiring. The ECM looks for
a quick drop in crankshaft speed. Misfire multiple cylinder is monitored by engine roughness measuring. The
actual roughness value is compared with the actual (emission and catalyst damage) threshold.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-26 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-28 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
SYSTEM VOLTAGE
YAD1F220
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
System voltage too low Malfunction in recognition of • Monitoring the actual battery voltages
system source voltage. Less through the scan tool
than minimum 8 volts in
2,000 rpm below, or less than • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 12, 11, 10, 5 about short
10 volts in 2,000 rpm above.
08 circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the over voltage protection
relay
• Inspection the battery
• Inspection ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-29
IGNITION SWITCH
YAD1F230
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Starter signal When not detection of starter • Inspection the Engine Control Module
recognition failure signal (ECM) pin 2 circuit short or open with
71 bad contact
• Inspection ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-30 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL SYSTEM
The function of the fuel metering system is to deliver the amount of fuel delivered in the starting mode by
the correct amount of fuel to the engine under all changing how long the fuel injector is turned on and
operating conditions. off. This is done by ‘‘pulsing” the fuel injectors for
The fuel is delivered to the engine by the individual very short times.
fuel injectors mounted into the intake manifold near Run Mode
each cylinder.
The run mode has two conditions called ‘‘open loop”
The main fuel control sensors are the Mass Air Flow and ‘‘closed loop”.
(MAF) sensor and the oxygen (O2) sensors.
The MAF sensor monitors the mass flow of the air being
Open Loop
drawn into the engine. An electrically heated element When the engine is first started and it is above 690 rpm,
is mounted in the intake air stream, where it is cooled the system goes into “open loop” operation. In “open
by the flow of incoming air. Engine Control Module loop”, the ECM ignores the signal from the O2S and
(ECM) modulates the flow of heating current to maintain calculates the air/fuel ratio based on inputs from the
the temperature differential between the heated film ECT sensor and the MAF sensor. The ECM stays in
and the intake air at a constant level. The amount of “open loop” until the following conditions are met:
heating current required to maintain the temperature • The O2 has a varying voltage output, showing that
thus provides an index for the mass air flow. This it is hot enough to operate properly.
concept automatically compensates for variations in
air density, as this is one of the factors that determines
• The ECT sensor is above a specified temperature
(22.5 °C).
the amount of warmth that the surrounding air absorbs
from the heated element. MAF sensor is located • A specific amount of time has elapsed after starting
between the air filter and the throttle valve. the engine.
Under high fuel demands, the MAF sensor reads a Closed Loop
high mass flow condition, such as wide open throttle. The specific values for the above conditions vary with
The ECM uses this information to enrich the mixture, different engines and are stored in the Electronically
thus increasing the fuel injector on—time, to provide Erasable programmable Read-Only Memory (EEPROM).
the correct amount of fuel. When decelerating, the mass When these conditions are met, the system goes into
flow decreases. This mass flow change is sensed by “closed loop” operation. In “closed loop”, the ECM
the MAF sensor and read by the ECM, which then calculates the air/fuel ratio (fuel injector on-time) based
decreases the fuel injector on—time due to the low fuel on the signals from the O2 sensors. This allows the
demand conditions. air/fuel ratio to stay very close to 14.7 to 1.
The O2 sensors are located in the exhaust pipe before
Acceleration Mode
catalytic converter. The O2 sensors indicate to the ECM
the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas, and the ECM The ECM responds to rapid changes in throttle position
changes the air/fuel ratio to the engine by controlling and airflow and provides extra fuel.
the fuel injectors. The best air/fuel ratio to minimize Deceleration Mode
exhaust emissions is 14.7 to 1, which allows the
The ECM responds to changes in throttle position and
catalytic converter to operate most efficiently. Because
airflow and reduces the amount of fuel. When
of the constant measuring and adjusting of the air/fuel
deceleration is very fast, the ECM can cut off fuel
ratio, the fuel injection system is called a “closed loop”
completely for short periods of time.
system.
The ECM uses voltage inputs from several sensors to Battery Voltage Correction Mode
determine how much fuel to provide to the engine. The When battery voltage is low, the ECM can compensate
fuel is delivered under one of several conditions, called for a weak spark delivered by the ignition module by
‘‘modes”. using the following methods:
Starting Mode • Increasing the fuel injector pulse width.
When the ignition is turned ON, the ECM turns the fuel • Increasing the idle speed rpm.
pump relay on for 1 second. The fuel pump then builds • Increasing the ignition dwell time.
fuel pressure. The ECM also checks the Engine Coolant
Fuel Cut-Off Mode
Temperature (ECT) sensor and the Throttle Position (TP)
sensor and determines the proper air/fuel ratio for No fuel is delivered by the fuel injectors when the
starting the engine. This ranges from1.5 to 1 at ignition is off. This prevents dieseling or engine run-
-36 ° C (-33 °F) coolant temperature to 14.7 to 1 at on. Also, the fuel is not delivered if there are no reference
94 °C (201 °F) coolant temperature. The ECM controls pulses received from the CKP sensor. This prevents
flooding.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-32 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL PUMP
YAD1F240
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-33
YAD1F250
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
34
Fuel pump relay short When short circuit to power • Inspection the Engine Control Module
circuit to battery source (ECM) pin 33 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
Fuel pump relay short When short circuit to ground
35 circuit to ground or or open open with bad contact • Inspection the fuel pump relay
open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECMwill activate the pump relay and run the in-tank fuel pump. The
fuel pump will operate as long as the engine is cranking or running and the ECMis receiving ignition reference
pulses.
If there are no reference pulses, the ECM will shut off the fuel pump within 2 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned ON, engine stopped or engine stalled.
Fuel Pump Relay Inspection
Measure the voltage between the ECM terminal No. 33 and ground.
Ignition Switch : ON 0 V (for1 ~ 2 sec.)
Cranking 0V
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-34 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Notice: Check the fuel filter and fuel line when the fuel delivery is not within specified value.
Specified Value 5 ~9 A
Notice: Replace the fuel pump relay if the measured value is over 9 A.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-36 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL INJECTOR
YAD1F260
The Multipoint Fuel Injection (MFI) assembly is a solenoid-operated device controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM) that meters pressurized fuel to an each individual cylinder. The injector sprays the fuel, in precise
quantities at a point in time determined by the ECM, directly to ward the cylinder intake valve. ECM energizes the
fuel injector solenoid to lift the needle valve and to flow the fuel through the orifice. This injector’s discharge
orifice is calibrated to meet the effective fuel atomization necessary for both ensuring the maximum homogeneity
in the air-fuel mixture and holding the condensation along the walls of the intake tract to a minimum.
Fuel enters the top feed injector from above and flows through its vertical axis. The lower end extends into the
intake valve. Fuel from the tip is directed at the intake valve, causing it to become further atomized and vaporized
before entering the combustion chamber.
A fuel injector which is stuck partially open would cause a loss of fuel pressure after the engineis shut down.
Also, an extended crank time would be noticed on some engines. Dieseling could also occur because some fuel
could be delivered to the engine after the ignition is turned off.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-37
YAD1F270
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 1 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #1 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
72
Injector #1 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
No. 1 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 63 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
73
open • Inspection the injector
Injector #1 short circuit to
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
No. 2 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #2 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
74
Injector #2 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
No. 2 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 61 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
75
open • Inspection the injector
Injector #2 short circuit to
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
No. 3 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #3 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
76
Injector #3 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-38 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 3 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 66 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
77 open
Injector #3 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
No. 4 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #4 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
78
Injector #4 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
No. 4 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 62 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
79 open • Inspection the injector
Injector #4 short circuit to
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
No. 5 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #5 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
192
Injector #5 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
No. 5 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 65 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
193 open
Injector #5 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
No. 6 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #6 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
194
Injector #6 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power • Inspection the ECM
No. 6 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 64 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
195 open
Injector #6 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-39
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-40 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F300
The fuel vaporization control system is in stalled to inhibit the fuel vaporized gas from discharging into the
atmosphere.
The fuel vaporized gas that is accumulated in the canister abstracts through the purge control valve purification
during the engine combustion (except the decreasing mode) and coolant temperature of over
80 °C. For this reason, the Engine Control Module (ECM) transacts the engine speed, air inflow quantity, coolant
temperature, and intake temperature.
The purge control valve is activated by the ECM frequency according with the engine rotating speed to adjust the
purification rate. The purification rate is determined by the continuous valve opening interval.
The purge control valve is activated by the ECM for the following conditions:
• Coolant temperature of over 80 °C
• Engine speed of over 1,000 rpm
• 2 minutes after starting
• When the fuel cut-off mode is not activated
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-41
YAD1F310
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
40
Purge control valve When short circuit to power • Inspection the ECM pin 34 about short
short circuit to battery source circuit or open with bad contact.
Purge control valve When short circuit to ground • Inspection the source power of valve
41 short circuit to ground or open circuit or open with
or open bad contact • Inspection the purge control solenoid
vale
Purge control circuit When malfunction of purge
54 malfunction control : not work vale • Inspection the ECM
Test
1. Maintain the normal temperature and idling state by
operating the engine.
2. Connect the ECM terminal No. 11 and No. 34 and
check for normal operation through the output waves
using oscilloscope.
Notice: Test during purge control valve operation
after the minimum of 1 minute after the engine
turned on.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-42 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL RAIL
YAD1F320
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-43
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-44 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F350
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-45
YAD1F390
YAD1F400
A Fuel pressure
B Intake Manifold Negative Pressure
LL Idling
TL Partial load
VL Full load
YAD1F380
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-46 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
INDUCTION SYSTEM
THROTTLE VALVE ACTUATOR
YAD1F410
The throttle actuator is actuated by the Engine Control Consequently, the throttle valve opening is a constant
Module(ECM) according to the position of the 10-12 °approximately.
accelerator pedal position. At no load, this produces an engine speed of about
It has two potentiometers which signal the position of 1,800 rpm
the throttle valve to the ECM to enable it to recognize
Driving
the various engine load states.
When driving (part/full throttle), the servo motor controls
Ignition “Off” the throttle valve in line with the various load states
In the de-energized states the throttle valve position and according to the input signals from the pedal value
is determined to be spring capsule. sensor according to the input signals from the pedal
value sensor according to the position of the
Ignition “On” accelerator pedal.
When the ignition S/W on the servo motor in the throttle The function of the EA (electronic accelerator) in the
actuator is operated by the ECM. The throttle valve ECM determines the opening angle of the throttle valve
adopts a position in line with the coolant temperature. through the throttle actuator. Further functions are;
Closed position • Idle speed control
In the closed throttle position, the servo motor controls • Cruise control
engine speed by operating the throttle valve further
• Reducing engine torque for ASR/ABS operation
(greater mixture) or closing it further (reduced mixture),
depending on coolant temperature and engine load. • Electronic accelerator emergency running
When this is done, the throttle valve can be closed • Storing faults
further by the servo motor overcoming the force of the • Data transfer through CAN
spring capsule (mechanical end stop). If the actuator
is deenergized, the throttle valve is resting against
the spring capsule.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-47
YAD1F420
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
104
Throttle position sensor TPS 1 short circuit to ground • Monitoring the actual values through
1 low voltage or open
• Inspection the ECM pin 84, 85, 87, 112,
Throttle position sensor TPS 1 short circuit to power 67, 68 about short circuit or open with
105
1 high voltage bad contact
108
Throttle position sensor TPS 2 short circuit to ground • Inspection the throttle valve actuator
2 low voltage or open
• Inspection the ECM
Throttle position sensor TPS 2 short circuit to power
109
2 high voltage
Throttle actuator When actuator adaption
116 learning control failure fluctuation or not meet the
condition scan tool
Throttle valve return When return spring defective
119 spring failure of actuator with bad contact
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-48 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Throttle position sensor When difference between TPS • Monitoring the actual values through
1 not plausible with 1 and TPS 2 scan tool
126
Throttle position sensor • Inspection the ECM pin 84, 85, 87, 112,
2 67, 68 about short circuit or open with
bad contact
127 High permanent throttle When failure of wiring harness
signal or actuator • Inspection the throttle valve actuator
Mass air flow sensor When difference between MAF • Inspection the ECM
185 and throttle position and TPS signal
sensor failure
Circuit Description
The ECM supplies a 5 volt reference signal and a ground to the TP sensor. The TP sensor sends a voltage signal
back to the ECM relative to the throttle plate opening. The voltage signal will vary from approximately 0.3 ~ 0.9
volts at closed throttle, to over 4.0 ~ 4.6 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
The TP sensors serve for engine load control according to the drive pedal command. Load adjustments independent
of the drive pedal command can be implemented; such functions are, for instance, idle control, speed control,
drive slip control, load shock damping, and similar functions.
When the actuator current fails, the throttle valve is returned to emergency operating position by a spring. The
throttle valve position, thereby the actuator drive position check back is provided by two potentiometers. The
motor positions the throttle valve against the return spring force. Motor and return spring are two separate energy
sources. Each of Them is able to position the throttle valve in emergency position alone. Throttle valve position
check back and monitoring is provided by two actual value potentiometers connected to the engine control
electronics.
Throttle Actuator Inspection
1. Turn the ignition switch to “ON” position.
2. Measure the TPS 1 signal voltage at the ECM pin No. 87 and TPS 2 signal voltage at the ECM pin No. 85.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-50 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F430
1 Housing 4 Connector
2 Protector Net 5 Hot Film Air Mass Sensor
3 Electronic Housing 6 Measuring Port
The Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) sensor with recognition of flow direction related to pulsating flow is designed for
recording load on Engine Control Module (ECM) by measuring the output voltage proportional to the reference
voltage of the ECM.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Mass Air Flow (MAF) is a thermal flow meter whose sensor element with its temperature sensors and heating area
is exposed to the MAF to be measured. A heating area located in the center of a thin membrane is controlled to
an over-temperature by a heating resistor and a temperature sensor of this membrane. And the value of over-
temperature depends on the temperature of the in-flowing air.
Two temperature sensors on upstream and downstream of the heating area show the same temperature without
incoming flow. With incoming flow, upstream part is cooled down but downstream temperature retains its temperature
more or less due to the air heated up in the heating area. This temperature difference in quantity and direction
depends on the direction of the incoming flow.
ECM modulates the flow of heating current to maintain the temperature differential between the heated film and
the intake air at a constant level. The amount of heating current required to maintain the temperature thus provides
an index for the MAF. This concept automatically compensates for variations in air density, as this is one of the
factors that determines the amount of warmth that the surrounding air absorbs from the heated element. MAF
sensor is located between the air filter and the throttle valve.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-51
Under high fuel demands, the MAF sensor reads a high mass flow condition, such as Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
The ECM uses this information to enrich the mixture, thus increasing the fuel injector on-time, to provide the
correct amount of fuel. When decelerating, the mass flow decreases. This mass flow change is sensed by the
MAF sensor and read by the ECM, which then decreases the fuel injector on-time due to the low fuel demand
conditions.
To facilitate the installation of the HFM in the intake passage, lubricating agents may be used. However, when
lubricants are used care must be taken to ensure that they do not enter the flow passage and cannot be sucked
in with the air flow.
The following tables show the relationship between MAF and output voltage.
Mass Air Flow (kg/h) Voltage (V) Mass Air Flow (kg/h) Voltage (V)
0 0.95 ~ 1.05 250 3.51
10 1.28 370 3.93
15 1.41 480 4.23
30 1.71 640 4.56
60 2.16 800 4.82
120 2.76
Temp. (°C) Ω)
R min.(Ω Ω)
R nom. (Ω Ω)
R max. (Ω
-40 35140 39260 43760
-20 12660 13850 15120
0 5119 5499 5829
20 2290 2420 2551
40 1096 1166 1238
60 565 609 654
80 312 340 370
100 184 202 222
120 114 127 141
130 91 102 114
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-52 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F440
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
03
Intake air temperature IAT sensor short circuit to • Monitoring the actual air temperature
sensor low voltage ground or open through scan tool
04
Intake air temperature IAT sensor short circuit to • Inspection the ECM pin 80, 79 about
sensor high voltage power short circuit or open with bad contact
Intake air temperature Malfunction in recognition of • Inspection the IAT sensor (integrated in
05 sensor plausibility IAT HFM sensor)
When functional problem • Inspection the ECM
Mass air flow sensor Malfunction in recognition of • Monitoring the actual air mass flow
09 plausibility MAF through scan tool
When air mass not plausible • Inspection the ECM pin 81, 105 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
10 Mass air flow sensor MAF sensor short circuit to
low voltage ground or open • Inspection the MAF sensor (integrated 11
in HFM sensor)
Mass air flow sensor MAF sensor short circuit to
11 high voltage power • Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The heated element on the MAF is a platinum film resistor (heater). It is located on a ceramic plate together with
the other elements in the bridge circuit. The temperature sensitive resistor (flow sensor) also included in the
bridge. The separation of heater and flow sensor facilitates design of the control circuitry. Saw cuts are employed
to ensure thermal decoupling between the heating element and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. The
complete control circuitry is located on a single layer. The voltage at the heater provides the index for the mass
air flow. The MAF’s electronic circuitry then converts the voltage to a level suitable for processing in the ECM.
This device does not need a burn off process to maintain its measuring precision over an extended period. In
recognition of the fact that most deposits collect on the sensor element’s leading edge, the essential thermal
transfer elements are located downstream on the ceramic layer. The sensor element is also design to ensure that
deposits will not influence the flow pattern around the sensor.
The IAT sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM supplies 5 volt reference and
a ground to the sensor. When the air is cold, the resistance is high; therefore the IAT signal voltage will be high.
If the intake air is warm, resistance is low; therefore the IAT signal voltage will be low.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-53
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable or MAF
sensor in itself. Perform the 5 volt power supply inspection procedures.
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cableor ECM
coupling.
5. Measure the voltage between the ECM pin No. 105 and MAF sensor connecter terminal No. 4.
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cableor ECM
coupling.
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable or Over
Voltage Protection Relay (OVPR).
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-54 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F450
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor detects coolant temperature and supplies information to the ECM. It is
composed of metal housing with two NTC resistor, 4 pin connector. The ECM provides a 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor through a dropping resistor. When the engine is cold, the ECT sensor provides high resistance, which the
ECM detects as a high signal voltage. As the engine warms up, the sensor resistance becomes lower, and the
signal voltage drops. At normal engine operating temperature, the ECT signal will measure about 1.5 to 2.0 volts.
The ECM uses information about coolant temperature to make the necessary calculations for:
• Fuel delivery
• Ignition control
• Knock sensor system
• Idle speed
• Torque converter clutch application
• Canister purge
• Cooling fan operation
• Others
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-55
Ω)
Temperature (°C) Resistance (Ω Voltage (V)
-40 48,550 4.90
-30 27,000 4.82
-20 15,570 4.70
-10 9,450 4.52
0 5,890 4.43
10 3,790 3.96
20 2,500 3.57
30 1,692 3.14
40 1,170 2.70
YAD1F460
50 826 2.26
60 594 1.86
70 434 1.51
80 322 1.22
90 243 0.98
100 185 0.78
110 143 0.63
120 111.6 0.50
130 88 0.40
140 71.2 0.33
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-56 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F470
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Engine coolant ECT sensor short circuit to • Monitoring the actual coolant temperature
00 temperature sensor low ground or open through scan tool
voltage
• Inspection the ECM pin 78, 79 about
Engine coolant ECT sensor short circuit to short circuit or open with bad contact
01 temperature sensor high power
voltage • Inspection the ECT sensor
Circuit Description
The ECT sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM supplies a voltage on the
signal circuit to the sensor. When the engine coolant is cold, the resistance is high; therefore the ECT signal
voltage will be high
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Inspection
1. Turn the ignition switch to “ON” position.
2. Measure the voltage between the ECM pin No. 78 and No. 79.
Temperature (°C) Specified Value (V)
20 3.57
80 1.22
100 0.78
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-57
Temperature (°C) Ω)
Specified Value (Ω
20 2,500
80 322
100 185
Notice: Replace wiring and coolant temperature sensor if out of specified value.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-58 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F480
The Acceleration Pedal Position (APP) sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor is
actually two individual APP sensors and one housing. This sensor works with the Throttle Position (TP) sensor to
provide input to the Engine Control Module (ECM) regarding driver requested accelerator pedal and throttle angle
at the throttle body.
When the APP sensor is defected:
When the APP1 or APP 2 sensor is defected condition, the engine is still running at idle condition but, the
accelerator pedal reaction is not response correctly and also, the engine rpm will be reacted to 4,000 rpm slowly.
If the APP 1 sensor is out of order, the APP 2 sensor will be conducted with signal as a default signal but, the
throttle valve opening is limited 60% and delayed opening speed.
When the TP sensor or servo motor is defected:
When the TP 1, 2 sensor or servo motor is defected condition, the throttle valve will be closed to the spring
capsule by spring force, at this condition, the throttle valve will open 10° ~ 20°and engine rpm will be controlled
by ECM with opening (On/Off) time of injector. The engine rpm will be maintaining 900 rpm (at idle) to 1,800
according to the engine load.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-59
YAD1F490
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Acceleration pedal When malfunction of APP • Monitoring the actual values through
122 position sensor signal sensor scan tool
failure
• Inspection the ECM pin 31, 47, 32, 48,
Acceleration pedal APP 1 sensor short circuit to 59, 51 about short circuit or open with
160 position 1 sensor low ground or open
voltage • Inspection the APP sensor
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-60 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Circuit Description
The ECM supplies a 5 or 2.5 volt reference signal and a ground to the APP sensor 1or 2. The ECM calculates on
these signal lines. The APP sensor output changes as the accelerator pedal is moved. The output of the APP
1and APP2 sensor are low, about 0.4 ~ 0.7 volts and 0.2 ~ 0.35 volts respectively at the closed throttle position.
As pushing the accelerator pedal, the output increases so that the output voltages will be about 4.3 ~ 4.8 volts
and 2.1 ~ 2.4 volts individually when accelerating fully with the kick down, at Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
Acceleration Pedal Position Sensor 1 Inspection
1. Turn the ignition switch to “ON” position.
2. Measure the signal voltage between the ECM pin No. 47andNo. 31while operating the accelerator pedal as
following conditions.
• Not depress the pedal (closed throttle position)
• Fully depress the pedal (full throttle with kick down)
Condition of Throttle Valve Specified Value (V)
Closed Throttle Valve 0.3 ~ 0.7
Fully Depressed Throttle Valve 4.3 ~ 4.8
Notice: If measured value is not within the specified value, check the pedal valve sensor and the supply
voltage to APP 1 sensor.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-61
CLUTCH SWITCH
YAD1F500
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Clutch switch defective When malfunction of clutch • Inspection the Engine Control Module
switch (ECM) pin 43 about shout circuit or open
62
• Inspection the clutch switch
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-62 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
COOLING FAN
YAD1F510
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Cooling fan (HI) relay Cooling fan short circuit to • Inspection the Engine Control Module
44 short circuit to power power (ECM) pin 35 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
Cooling fan (HI) relay Cooling fan short circuit to • Inspection the power source
short circuit to ground ground or open with bad
45 or open contact • Inspection the cooling fan
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
Ignition voltage is supplied directly to the cooling fan relay coil. The ECM controls the relay by grounding the control
circuit. When the ECM is commanding a command ON, the voltage of the control circuit should be low (near 0 volt).
When the ECM is commanding the control circuit should be high (near battery voltage). If the fault detection circuit
senses a voltage other than what is expected, the fault line status will change causing the fault code to set.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-63
YAD1F520
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
A/C compressor relay When malfunction of A/C • Monitoring the actual operation through
228 short circuit to battery compressor control scan tool
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
A/c compressor relay (ECM) pin 44 about short circuit or open
short circuit to ground with bad contact
229 or open
• Inspection the relay short circuit or open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
When the ECM detects that A/C has been requested, the ECM will activated the A/C clutch relay. When the relay
has been activated, voltage should be present at both the A/C clutch relay and A/C switch circuit at ECM.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-64 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F530
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Cruise control “OFF” Cruise control system • Monitoring the actual recognition status
129 due to message counter message counter fault and vehicle speed signal through scan
failure tool
Vehicle speed signal When malfunction of • Inspection the Engine Control Module
130 failure auto-cruise system (ECM) pin 52 53 54 55 57 about short
Implausible condition of circuit or open with bad contact
Vehicle speed signal
131 vehicle speed signal.
failure • Inspection the CAN and ABS
132
Cruise control lever Cruise control lever • Inspection the cruise control lever switch
failure defective
• Inspection the ECM
Cruise control Cruise control system
133 acceleration failure Implausible condition of
acceleration signal
Circuit Description
Cruise control is an automatic speed control system that maintain a desired driving speed without using the
accelerator pedal. The vehicle speed must be greater than 40 km/h to engage cruise control.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-65
YAD1F540
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
150
TCS input signal short TCS short circuit to power • Inspection the Engine Control Module
circuit to battery (ECM) pin 45 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
TCS input signal short TCS short circuit to ground or
151 circuit to ground or open • Inspection the TCS lamp of I/P cluster.
open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
Battery voltage is supplied to the TCS warning lamp with the ignition in ON and START. The warning lamp can be
activated only by the Electrical Brake Control Module (EBCM) internally supplying ground to terminal 21. If the
TCS input circuit is open or short, this failure code will be set.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-66 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
RESONANCE FLAP
YAD1F150
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Resonance flap short Resonance flap short circuit to • Monitoring the actual operational status
circuit to battery power and vehicle speed signal through scan
198 tool
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 97 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
Resonance flap short Resonance flap short circuit to
circuit to ground or ground or open • Inspection the power source short circuit
or open to resonance flap
open
199
• Inspection the resonance flap solenoid
and hardware
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
A pneumatically actuated resonance flap is located on the intake manifold, and will be opened and closed by
load, which operates resonance flap according to engine and controlled by ECM and rpm.
Resonance flap is closed at idle/partial load (less than 3,800/rpm). The switch valve will be adjusted by ECM and
resonance flap will be closed. By increasing air flow passage through dividing intake air flow toward both air
collection housing. This leads to a significant increase in the torque in the lower speed range.
Resonance flap is open at full load (over 3,800/rpm). The switch valve will not be adjusted by ECM and resonance
flap will be open. The collected air in the air collection housing will not be divided and intake air passage will be
shorten.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-67
YAD1F550
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Stop lamp switch failure When malfunction of stop • Monitoring the actual operational status
lamp switch - implausible and vehicle speed signal through scan
condition of stop lamp signal tool
input
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
135 (ECM) pin 49 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
• Inspection the contact condition of stop
lamp switch
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The stop lamp switch is normally opened. When the ignition switch ON and brake ON, the battery voltage is
supplied to the ECM. A scan tool should display ON when brake pedal is depressed and should read OFF with
brake pedal released.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-68 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
ENGINE RPM
YAD1F560
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Engine rpm output When short circuit to battery • Inspection the cluster panel board circuit
32 circuit short circuit to
battery • Inspection the ECM
Engine rpm output When short circuit to ground • Monitoring the actual rpm in cluster
33 circuit short circuit to or open • Inspection the Engine Control Module
ground or open (ECM) pin 60 about short circuit or open
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-69
EXHAUST SYSTEM
CATALYTIC CONVERTER These catalysts in the 3-way catalytic converter are
the rare metals platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh).
The purpose of the catalytic converter is to convert
The catalytic converter consists essentially of three
the three pollutants of carbon monoxide(CO),
main elements. The exhaust gases flow through the
hydrocarbons (HC) and oxides of nitrogen (NOx)
catalytic converter and, in so doing, coming into
contained in the exhaust of gasoline engines, into the
contact with rare metals (Pt and Rh).
harmless compounds of water (H2O), carbon dioxide
(CO2) and nitrogen (N2). The following chemical reaction are produced.
The catalytic converter contains a catalyst, a word CO + O 2 → CO 2
coming from the Greek and which designates the HC + O 2 → CO 2 + H 2O
element essential for catalyst which triggers chemical NO x → N 2 + O 2
reactions without itself being consumed.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-70 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
OXYGEN SENSOR
YAD1F570
The oxygen sensor is unique among the engine control When the exhaust gas is rich (below 14.7:1), the voltage
sensors because is acts like a battery and is able to output is high, above450mv. When the exhaust gas is
generate its own low voltage signal. It is located the lean (above 14.7:1 air/fuel ratio), the sensor’s voltage
exhaust system and monitors the amount of oxygen in output is low, below 450 mv.
the exhaust stream and provides feedback to the The ECM uses oxygen sensor information for:
Engine Control Module (ECM).
• Open loop / closed loop criteria
The electrically heated oxygen sensor warms up quickly
and remains hot, even at idle when the exhaust manifold • Ideal air / fuel ratio
may cool down.
The ECM applies a reference voltage of 450 mv to the
oxygen sensor, the ECM compares this reference
voltage with the voltage generated by oxygen sensor.
The amount of voltage the oxygen sensor generates is
proportionate to the difference between the amount of
oxygen in the outside air and the exhaust gases. The
atmosphere contains about 21% oxygen. The exhaust
from a rich air/fuel ratio contains almost no oxygen.
With a large difference between the amounts of oxygen
containing the two surface, the sensor generates less
voltage.
YAD1F580
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-71
YAD1F590
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-72 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F600
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Oxygen sensor high When recognition the output • Monitoring the actual output signal
voltage that more than nominal through scan tool
80 threshold, malfunction of
sensing voltage. • Inspection the ECM pin 16, 17 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
Oxygen sensor low When recognition the output
voltage that more than nominal • Inspection the oxygen sensor
89 threshold, malfunction of • Inspection the ECM
sensing voltage.
Oxygen sensor no When recognition the output
82 activity detected that not active the sensor etc.
Oxygen sensor heater When recognition the heating • Inspection the heating circuit of oxygen
sensor
87 short circuit to ground voltages than less than set
or open values (less than 2v) • Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-73
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Bank 1 system short When recognition the value • Inspection the intake air leakage
term fuel trim less than nominal control
adaptation below lean threshold, it means that when • Inspection the injection quantities with
injector block or leakage
81 threshold big deviation in control range
of adaptation values through • Inspection the exhaust leakage
fuel and air mixture formation
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
In order to control emissions, a catalytic converter is used to covert harmful emissions into harmless water vapor
and carbon dioxide. The ECM has the ability to monitor this process by using a oxygen sensor. The oxygen
sensor produces and output signal which indicates the storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the
catalyst’s ability to convert exhaust emission effectively. If the oxygen sensor pig tail wiring, connector, or
terminal is damaged. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to
function properly, it must have a clean air reference provided to it. This clean air reference is obtained by way of
the oxygen sensor wire(s). Any attempt to repair the wires, connector, or terminal and degrade the oxygen sensor
performance.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-74 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable, oxygen
sensor or ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-76 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F610
1 Cover 5 Pin
2 Plate Vehicle Side : No. 13-60
3 Connector Engine Side : No. 73-120
4 Flat Pin A Vehicle Side Connector : Black
Vehicle Side : No. 1-12 B Engine Side Connector : Gray
Engine Side : No. 61-72
The Engine Control Module (ECM), located inside the right side kick panel, is the control center of the fuel
injection system. It constantly looks at the information from various sensors and controls the systems that affect
the vehicle’s performance. Engine rpm and air mass are used to measure the air intake quantity resulting in fuel
injection metering.
The ECM also performs the diagnostic functions of the system. It can recognize operational problems, store
failure code(s) which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in making repairs.
There are no serviceable parts in the ECM. The calibrations are stored in the ECM in the Programmable Read
Only Memory (PROM).
The ECM supplies either 5 or 12 volts to power the sensors or switches. This is done through resistance in the
ECM which are so high in value that a test light will not come ON when connected to the circuit. In some cases,
even an ordinary shop voltmeter will not give and accurate reading because its resistance is too low. You must
use a digital voltmeter with a 10 Mohm input impedance to get accurate voltage readings. The ECM controls
output circuits such as the ignition coils, the fuel injectors, the fuel pump relay, the intake manifold resonance
flap, the camshaft actuator, the canister purge valve, etc., by controlling the ground circuit.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-77
YAD1F620
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ASR unit with CAN
failure: ASR/MSR missing or implausibility for connection
ASR/MSR unit or not
23 initialized condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS unit with CAN
failure: ABS missing or implausibility for connection
ABS unit or not initialized
24
condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the TCM unit with CAN
failure: TCU (A/T only) missing or implausibility for connection
26 TCU unit or not initialized
condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-78 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the TOD unit with CAN
failure: TOD (E32 only) missing or implausibility for connection
TOD unit or not initialized
27 condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS/ABD unit with CAN
failure: ID 200h not missing or implausibility for connection
plausible ABS/ABD unit or not initialized
29
condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS/ABD unit with CAN
failure: ID 208h not missing or implausibility for connection
30 plausible ABS/ABD unit or not
initialized condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the each control unit with CAN
failure: communication missing or implausibility for connection
initialization failure each unit
31
(ABS, ASR, TCM, TOD etc.) • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
or not initialized condition
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the MSR unit with CAN
failure: MSR data missing or implausibility for connection
transmission not MSR unit or not initialized
59 plausible condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ASR unit with CAN
failure: ASR data missing or implausibility for connection
transmission not ASR unit or not initialized
60 plausible condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The provision for communicating with the ECM is the Data Link Connector (DLC). It is located in the instrument
panel fuse block. The DLC is used to connect the scan tool. Battery power and ground is supplied for the scan
tool through the DLC. CAN line is used to communicate with the other module such as the Transmission Control
Module (TCM) and Transfer Case Control Unit (TCCU).
Keyword 2000 Serial Data Communications
Each bit of information can have one of two lengths: long or short. This allows vehicle wiring to be reduced by
transmitting and receiving multiple signals over a singles wire. The message carried on KWP 2000 data streams
are also prioritized. If two messages attempt to establish communications on the data line at the same time, only
the message with higher priority will must wait.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-79
INTERNAL FAILURE
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Transmission coding When faulty of variant coding • Inspection the coding condition through
failure of transmission scan tool
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
21 (ECM)
• Inspection the CAN line
• Inspection the TCM
ECM failure (RAM) When malfunction of random • Inspection the ECM
136 access memory - ECM internal
error
Uncoded/ unprogramed When malfunction of ECM • Fulfill the ECM variant coding
142 ECM coding-required ECM
encoding
137 ECM failure (EPROM) When malfunction of ECM • Inspection the ECM
internal
ECM failure (EEPROM/
143 Flash - EPPOM
checksum failure)
ECM failure (coding ID
144 checksum failure)
ECM failure (coding
145 checksum failure)
ECM failure
146 (programming
checksum failure)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-80 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
110
Throttle actuator System internal failure • Inspection the Engine Control Module
learning data fault (ECM)
Exceed fuel-cut safety
117 time
Cruise control
120 interruption memory
failure
138 Call Monitoring
Servo motor control
139 output interruption
memory failure
140 Servo motor open/short
ECM failure
186 (incompatible CPU)
ECM failure (CPUs
187 communication failure)
ECM failure (CPU 2
188
configuration failure)
ECM failure (CPU 2
189 fault)
ECM failure (CPU run
190 time failure between
CPUs)
ECM failure (CPU 2
231 cruise control message
counter failure)
Over deceleration limit
232 (CPU 2)
Over acceleration limit
233
(CPU 2)
Cruise control lever dual
234 operation (CPU 2)
Cruise control lever
235 safety terminal failure
(CPU 2)
Unusual pedal position
236 variation (CPU 2)
Unusual throttle position
237
variation (CPU 2)
Unusual throttle
controller monitoring
238 data comparison fault
(CPU 2)
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-81
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Unusual accelerator System internal failure • Inspection the Engine Control Module
pedal position sensor
239 comparison fault
(CPU 2)
Throttle potentiometer
240 comparison fault
(CPU 2)
Unusual CPU
241
communication (CPU 2)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-82 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
IMMOBILIZER
YAD1F630
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Communication with When missing the • D Inspection the Engine Control Module
transponder missing transponder signal (ECM) pin 13, 14 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the power source or ground
25 short circuit or open of immobilizer unit
• Inspection the transponder condition
(broken etc.)
• Inspection the ECM
Unprogramed ECM with When malfunction of • Fulfill the immobilizer pairing
immobilizer immobilizer
Circuit Description
Immobilizer is a device disabling vehicle ignition unless a specific key is used and designed to help prevent
vehicle theft.
Immobilizer is comprised of two devices, a key with encoded transponder and ECM with the same encoding of
the transponder. When a key is inserted into the hole to start vehicle and turned to ON, the ECM reads and
decodes the transponder code and, if the same, starts the engine, it is called immobilizer. It means immobilizer
system disables starting by stopping fuel supply if the code in the transponder does not match the code stored
in ECM each other.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-83
KAA1F430
KAA1F440
FUEL PUMP
Tools Required
661 589 00 46 00 Fuel Tank Cap Wrench
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To avoid
fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury or fire,
it is necessary to relieve the fuel system pressure
before disconnecting the fuel lines.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-84 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F550
FUEL FILTER
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To avoid
fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury or fire,
it is necessary to relieve the fuel system pressure
before disconnecting the fuel lines.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-85
FUEL TANK
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To avoid
fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury or fire,
it is necessary to relieve the fuel system pressure
before disconnecting the fuel lines.
YAA1F170
10. Disconnect the fuel filler hose and air vent hose
from the fuel tank.
11. Support the fuel tank.
12. Remove the fuel tank retaining nuts.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 38 N•m (28 lb-ft)
YAA1F160
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-86 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F180
KAA1F430
KAA1F440
KAA1F130
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-87
KAA1F060
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
KAA1F070
11. Remove the two left and two right bolts and one
center bolt of the fuel rail assembly from the intake
manifold.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
KAA1F080
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-88 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Relieve the coolant system pressure.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
Notice: Take care when handling the engine
coolant temperature sensor. Damage to the sensor
will affect the proper operation of the fuel injection
YAA1F150 system.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-89
KAA1F230
KAA1F240
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-90 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
KNOCK SENSOR
Removal and installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the knock sensor electrical connector
from the intake manifold bracket.
3. Remove the knock sensor mounting bolt from the
knock sensor installed on the cylinder block.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
KAA1F180
4. Remove the knock sensor.
5. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-91
OXYGEN SENSOR
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Notice: The oxygen sensor uses a permanently
attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail should
not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage
or removal of the pigtail or the connector could
affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor. Do
not drop the oxygen sensor.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-92 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
CANISTER
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: Canister and vacuum hoses contain fuel
vapors. Do not smoke in the area or permit an open
flame.
YAD1F660
YAD1F670
KAA1F170
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-93
KAA1F200
4. Pull out the ECM from the bracket.
5. Disconnect the vehicle side coupling.
6. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-94 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
ECM WIRING DIAGRAM (3.2L DOHC - 1 OF 7) (MSE 3.63D) SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS
YAD1F010
SSANGYONG Y200
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F030
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F050
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F070
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-101
SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE DATA DISPLAY TABLE
Parameter Unit Value
Engine Coolant Temp. °C greater than 95 °C after warm up
-40 ~ 130 °C (varies with ambient
Intake Air Temp. °C
temp. or engine mode)
Engine RPM rpm 700 ± 50 (P/N), 600 ± 50 (D)
Regular RPM rpm 700 ± 50 (P/N), 600 ± 50 (D)
Engine Load % 18 ~ 25 %
Mass Air Flow Meter Kg/h 16 ~ 25 Kg/h
0 °TA (up to 100 °TA at t he wi de
Throttle Position Angle °TA open throttle)
Spark Advance °CA °CA (6 ~ 9 °CA)
Indicated Engine Torque Nm Varies with engine condition
Injection Time ms 3 ~5 ms
Battery Voltage V 13.5 ~ 14.1 v (engine running)
Front Axle Speed Km/h 0 ~ 265 Km/h
Rear Axle Speed Km/h 0 ~ 265 Km/h
Accel. Pedal Position 1 V 0.4 ~ 4.8 V
Accel. Pedal Position 2 V 0.2 ~ 2.4 V
Throttle Position 1 V 0.3 ~ 4.6 V
Throttle Position 2 V 0.3 ~ 4.6 V
Fuel Integrator 0.8 ~ 1.2
Oxygen Sensor mv 100 ~ 900 mv
A/C S/W Condition 1=ON/0=OFF -
Full Load State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Shift Gear State (A/T) 1=ON/0=OFF -
A/C Control State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Clutch Switch (M/T) 1=ON/0=OFF -
Cam Actuator State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Knocking Control 1=ON/0=OFF -
Protect Mission 1=ON/0=OFF -
Purge Control Valve 1=ON/0=OFF -
Lambda Function 1=ON/0=OFF -
Catalyst Heating 1=ON/0=OFF -
Overrun Fuel Cut 1=ON/0=OFF -
Ful l Fuel Cut 1=ON/0=OFF -
Brake Switch 1=ON/0=OFF -
Cruise Control Status 1=ON/0=OFF -
*Condition : Warmed up, idle, P/N or neutral
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-102 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
M162 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F1-103
FUEL SYSTEM SPECIFICATION This type of fuel can reduce vehicle performance and
damage components of the fuel system.
Use Only Unleaded Fuel Rated at 89 Octane
Caution: Use of methanol may damage the fuel sys-
or Higher tem.
Fuel quality and additives contained in fuel have a
significant effect on power output, drivability, and life Vehicle Fueling from Drums or Storage
of theengine. Containers
Fuel with too low an octane number can cause engine For safety reasons (particularly when using noncom-
knock. mercial fueling systems) fuel containers, pumps and
Caution: Use of fuel with an octane number lower hoses must be properly earthed.
than 89 may damage engine and exhaust system. Static electricity build up can occur under certain atmo-
spheric and fuel flow conditions if unearthed hoses,
Notice: To prevent accidental use of leaded fuel, the par-ticularly plastic, are fitted to the fuel-dispensing
nozzles for leaded fuel are larger, and will not fit the pump.
fuel filler neck of your vehicle.
It is therefore recommended that earthed pumps with
Do Not Use Methanol integrally earthed hoses be used, and that storage
containers be properly earthed during all
Fuels containing methanol (wood alcohol) should not noncommercial fueling operations.
be used in vehicle.
TEMPERATURE VS RESISTANCE
ECT sensor IAT sensor
°C °F
ohms (Ω)
Temperature vs Resistance Values (Approximate)
130 266 88 102
120 248 111.6 127
110 230 143 159
100 212 202 202
90 194 261 261
80 176 340 340
70 158 452 452
60 140 609 609
50 122 835 835
40 113 1166 1166
30 86 1662 1662
20 68 2420 2420
10 50 3604 3604
0 32 5499 5499
-10 14 8609 8609
-20 -4 13850 13850
-30 -22 22960 22960
-40 -40 39260 39260
SSANGYONG Y200
1F1-104 M162 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F890 KAA1F490
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1F2
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Engine and ECM Problem Check Report ........... 1F2-3 Exhaust System ................................................ 1F2-69
Diagnostic Information and Procedure ............. 1F2-4 Catalytic Converter ...........................................1F2-69
Failure Code Diagnosis ...................................... 1F2-4 Oxygen Sensor ................................................. 1F2-70
Clearing Failure Codes ....................................... 1F2-4 Engine Control Module .................................... 1F2-76
Failure Codes Table ........................................... 1F2-4 Serial Data Communication ............................... 1F2-78
Ignition System ................................................... 1F2-8 Internal Failure .................................................. 1F2-80
Ignition Coil ...................................................... 1F2-10 Electronic Throttle Controller Safety
Malfunction .................................................... 1F2-82
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor .................... 1F2-12
Immobilizer ......................................................1F2-84
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor ....................... 1F2-16
Camshaft Actuator ............................................ 1F2-20 Maintenance and Repair ................................. 1F2-85
Knock Sensor (KS) ...........................................1F2-22 On-Vehicle Service ........................................... 1F2-85
Spark Plug ....................................................... 1F2-24 Discharging the Pressure in Fuel System .......... 1F2-85
System Voltage ................................................1F2-28 Fuel Pump ........................................................ 1F2-85
Ignition Switch .................................................. 1F2-29 Fuel Filter .......................................................... 1F2-86
Fuel System ...................................................... 1F2-30 Fuel Tank .......................................................... 1F2-87
Fuel Pump ........................................................ 1F2-32 Fuel Pressure Regulator .................................... 1F2-88
Fuel Injector...................................................... 1F2-36 Fuel Rail and Injector ........................................1F2-89
Purge Control Valve .......................................... 1F2-40 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor .................. 1F2-90
Fuel Rail ........................................................... 1F2-42 Throttle Body (Integrated with the 91
Actuator) ....................................................... 1F2-91
Fuel Pressure Regulator .................................... 1F2-44
Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) Sensor ........................ 1F2-92
Induction System .............................................. 1F2-46
Knock Sensor ................................................... 1F2-92
Throttle Valve Actuator ...................................... 1F2-46
Pedal Position Sensor ....................................... 1F2-93
Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) Sensor ........................ 1F2-50
Oxygen Sensor ................................................. 1F2-93
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor ........ 1F2-54
Purge Control Valve .......................................... 1F2-94
Accelerator Pedal Module .................................1F2-58
Canister............................................................ 1F2-94
Cooling Fan ...................................................... 1F2-62
Camshaft Position Sensor .................................1F2-94
A/C Compressor Relay .....................................1F2-63
Crankshaft Position Sensor ............................... 1F2-95
Cruise Control Switch ........................................1F2-64
Engine Control Module ...................................... 1F2-95
Traction Control System (TCS) ...........................1F2-65
Schematic and Routing Diagrams ................... 1F2-96
Stop Lamp Switch............................................. 1F2-66
ECM Wiring Diagram
Engine RPM ..................................................... 1F2-67 (2.3L DOHC - MSE 3.53D) ..............................1F2-96
1F2-2 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-3
MIL INFORMATION
Condition of MIL o Remains on o Sometimes illuminates o Does not illuminate
DTC inspection o Normal o Malfunction code(s) (code )
(if available) o Freeze frame data ( )
PROBLEM DESCRIPTION
o Engine Does Not Start o No cranking o No initial combustion o No complete combustion
o Hard to Start o Slow cranking
o Others
o Poor Idling o Incorrect first Idle o Abnormal idle rpm o High (rpm) o Low (rpm)
o Idling Unstable o Others
o Poor Driveability o Hesitation o Back fire o Muffler explosion (after-burning)
o Surging o Knocking o Poor performance o Other
o Engine Stall o Soon after starting o After accelerator pedal depressed
o After accelerator pedal released o During A/C operation
o Shifting from N to D or D to N
o At full steering o Others
o Others
Problem Frequency o Constant o Intermittent (times per day/month) o Once only o Others
Weather o Fine o Cloudy o Rainy o Snowy o Various/Others
Ambient Temperature o Hot o Warm o Cool o Cold (approx.____°F/____°C)
Place o Highway o Suburbs o Inner City o Uphill o Downhill
o Rough Road o Others
Engine Temperature o Cold o Warming Up o Before warming up o After warm-up
o Any temp. o Others
Engine Operation o Starting o Just after starting (min.) o Idling o Racing o Driving
o Constant speed o Acceleration o Deceleration
o A/C switch ON/OFF o Other
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-4 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Parameters listed in the table may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument or other
factors. If a failure code is displayed during the “TROUBLE CODE” in scan tool check mode, check the circuit for
the code listed in the table below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the “See Page” for
the respective “Failure Code” in the below table.
Failure codes should be cleared after repairs have been completed.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-5
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-6 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-7
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-8 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
IGNITION SYSTEM
This ignition system does not use a conventional the available energy to fire the spark plug. The remaining
distributor and coil. It uses a crankshaft position sensor energy is available to the spark plug in the cylinder on
input to the Engine Control Module (ECM). The ECM the compression stroke.
then determines Electronic Spark Timing (EST) and These systems use the EST signal from the ECM to
triggers the electronic ignition system ignition coil. control the EST. The ECM uses the following
This type of distributorless ignition system uses a information:
‘‘waste spark” method of spark distribution. Each • Engine load (mass air flow sensor).
cylinder is paired with the cylinder that is opposite it
(2-3 or 1-4). The spark occurs simultaneously in the • Engine temperature.
cylinder coming up on the compression stroke and in • Intake air temperature.
the cylinder coming up on the exhaust stroke. The • Crankshaft position.
cylinder on the exhaust stroke requires very little of • Engine speed (rpm).
YAA1F910
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-10 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
IGNITION COIL
YAA1F920
The Electronic Ignition (EI) system ignition coil is located on the cylinder head cover. The double ended coils
receive the signal for the Engine Control Module (ECM) which controls the spark advance.
Each EI system ignition coil provides the high voltage to two spark plugs simultaneously;
T1/1: cylinder 1 and 4
T1/2: cylinder 2 and 3
The EI system ignition coil is not serviceable and must be replaced as an assembly.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-11
YAD1F0E0
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
• Inspection the ECM pin 71 and 72 about
No ignition voltage short circuit or open with bad contact
64 output • Inspection the power source to ignition
(No. 1 ignition coil) coil
Malfunction of ignition circuit
Primary current values or • Inspection the ignition coil, high tension
cords etc.
secondary short circuit
No ignition voltage • Inspection the spark plug (wet, cracks,
65 output wear, improper gap, burned electrodes,
(No. 2 ignition coil) heavy deposit)
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The Electronic Ignition (EI) system uses a waste spark method of spark distribution. The Crankshaft Position
(CKP) sensor sends reference pulses to the ECM. The ECM then triggers the EI system ignition coils. Once the
ECM triggers the EI system ignition coils both of the connected spark plugs fire at the same time. One cylinder
is on its compression stroke at the same time that the other is on the exhaust stroke, resulting in lower energy
needed to fire the spark plug in the cylinder on its exhaust stroke.
This leaves the remainder of the high voltage to be used to fire the spark plug in the cylinder on its compression
stroke.
Since the CKP sensor is in a fixed position, timing adjustments are not possible or needed.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-12 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F940
This Electronic Ignition (EI) system uses inductive or pick up type magnetic Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
The CKP sensor is located in the opposite side of the crankshaft pulley and triggers the pick-up wheel teeth
which is equipped 60-2 teeth with agap of 2 teeth at 360 degree spacing. This sensor protrudes through its mount
to within 1.1 ± 0.14 mm.
The output of the sensor is a sinusoidal signal. Each tooth of the pick-up 60-2 wheel generates a positive half
wave.
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses this sensor signal to generate timed ignition and injection pulses that it
sends to the ignition coils and to the fuel injectors.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-13
YAD1F120
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Crankshaft position Even through cam position
sensor signal failure recognition is normal, no
17
(no engine revolution crankshaft position signal
signal) recognition • Monitoring the actual rpm through or
scan tool
When more than applicable
Crankshaft position • Inspection the ECM pin 100, 99 about
revolution values or
18 sensor signal failure short circuit with bad contact
implausible to 60-2 teeth.
(rpm > max. value)
• Inspection the CKP sensor
When implausible recogni- • Inspection the air gap between sensor
Crankshaft position tion of cam and crank angle and drive plate
20 sensor signal failure signal or intermittent sens-
(gap recognition failure) ing the signal or error count • Inspection the drive plate (teeth condi-
of undetected gap. tion)
Circuit Description
The 58X reference signal is produced by the CKP sensor. During one crankshaft revolution, 58 crankshaft pulses
will be produced. The ECM uses the 58X reference signal to calculate engine rpm and CKP. The ECM constantly
monitors the number of pulses on the 58X reference circuit and compares them to the number of Camshaft
Position (CMP) signal pulses being received. If the ECM receives and incorrect number of pulses on the 58X
reference circuit, this failure code will set.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Resistance Inspection
1. Disconnect the coupling “E” of ECM while the ignition switch is in “OFF” position.
2. Measure the resistance between the coupling terminal pin No. 99 and No. 100 using a multimeter.
Specified Value 1,050 ~ 1,400 Ω
Notice: Measure the insulator resistance of the CKP sensor if out of the specified value.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-14 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F130
a Voltage
b Identifying the No. 1-2 Missing Teeth
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-16 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F950
The Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor sends a CMP signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM). The ECM uses
this signal as a “synchronized pulse” to trigger the injectors in the proper sequence. The ECM uses the CMP
signal to indicate the position of the #1 piston during its power stroke. This allows the ECM to calculate true
sequential fuel injection mode of operation.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-17
YAD1F150
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Camshaft position When no cam recognition • Inspection the source voltage of CMP
sensor signal : No. 1 signal during TN 24 counts sensor
19 cylinder recognition more.
failure (maintain the constant low or • Inspection the ECM pin 106, 104 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
high level)
Camshaft position When synchronization fault • Inspection the CMP sensor
sensor signal : No. 1 of cylinder 1 • Inspection the damage of sensor or
58 cylinder synchronization (TDC recognition) sprocket
failure
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The CMP sensor sends a cam position signal to the ECM. If the cam position signal is lost while the engine is
running, the fuel injection system shifts to a calculated sequential fuel injection mode based on the last fuel
injection pulse, and the engine continuous to run.
Camshaft Position Sensor Signal Voltage Inspection
1. Measure the voltage between the ECM terminal No. 11 and No. 106 while the engine speed is at idle.
Notice: The signal voltage will be changed in the range of 1.2 ~ 1.7 v.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-18 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F160
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-20 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
CAMSHAFT ACTUATOR
YAA1F970
1 Bolt 4 Armature
2 Camshaft Actuator 5 Roll Pin
3 Bolt 6 Nut
When the engine is running, the camshaft actuator rotates the intake camshaft hydraulically and mechanically
relative to the camshaft sprocket by 20 ° crank angle to the “advanced” position and back to the “retard”
position.
The camshaft actuator is actuated electro-mechanically by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The positioning time of apporx. 1 second is dependent on the engine oil pressure at the camshaft actuator and on
the oil viscosity and oil temperature, respectively.
The camshaft indicator on the camshaft sprocket provides the camshaft rotational speed to the position sensor
as an input parameter for the engine ignition control unit.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-21
YAD1F150
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Camshaft actuator short When malfunction of cam • Monitoring the actual operational status
circuit to battery phasing control through scan tool
226
• Inspection the ECM pin 73 about short
circuit or open
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, check the cable.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-22 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F180
The Knock Sensor (KS) detects abnormal knocking in the engine. The two KS are mounted in the engine block
near the cylinders. The sensors produce an output voltage which increases with the severity of the knock. This
signal is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM) via a shielded cable. The ECM then adjusts the ignition timing
to reduce the spark knock.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-23
YAD1F0F0
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 1 knock sensor When recognition in more • Inspection the ECM pin 118, 117 about
signal failure than control gain threshold short circuit or open with bad contact
at normal operational
56 condition of other system • Inspection the KS 1 malfunction
during over 75 and • Inspection the ECM
3,000 rpm running area
(cylinder 1, 2, 3, 4)
Circuit Description
The KS system is used to detect engine detonation, allowing the ECM to retard the ignition control spark timing
based on the KS signal being received. The KS signal’s amplitude and frequency depend upon the amount of
knock being experienced. The ECM monitors the KS signal and can diagnose the KS sensor and circuitry.
Knock Sensor Resistance Inspection
1. Disconnect the coupling from ECM while the ignition switch is in “OFF” position.
2. Measure the resistance between the coupling terminal pin No. 118 and No. 117 using a multimeter.
Specified Value >10 MΩ
Notice: Replace the KS if the measured values is out of the specified values. Check the connector and wire
connection between ECM and the KS if the measured values are normal.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-24 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SPARK PLUG
YAA1F990
1 Screw 6 Bolts
2 Adaptor 7 Ignition Coil (T 1/1)
3 Ignition Coil Cable Cover 8 Coupling Plug
4 Spark Plug Connector 9 Spark Plug
5 Ignition Coil Connector 10 Ignition Coil (T 1/2)
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-25
YAD1F0G0
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Random / Multiple When detection misfire of • Inspection the ignition system
Misfire multiple cylinder for source
of over the emission • Inspection the injection system
threshold or catalyst • Inspection the fuel pressure
damage
• Inspection the compression pressure
• Inspection the valve timing or clearance
68
• Inspection the air flow sensor
• Inspection the crankshaft position sensor
and air gap
• Inspection the engine wiring system
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM)
Circuit Description
The ECM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft positions to detect if the engine is misfiring. The ECM looks for
a quick drop in crankshaft speed. Misfire multiple cylinder is monitored by engine roughness measuring. The
actual roughness value is compared with the actual (emission and catalyst damage) threshold.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-26 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Notice: Replace the spark plug cable if the measured values is out of the specified values.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-28 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SYSTEM VOLTAGE
YAD1F220
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
System voltage too low Malfunction in recognition of • Monitoring the actual battery voltages
system source voltage. through the scan tool
Less than minimum 8 volts
in 2,000 rpm below, or less • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 12, 11, 10, 5 about short
than 10 volts in 2,000 rpm
08 circuit or open with bad contact
above.
• Inspection the over voltage protection
relay
• Inspection the battery
• Inspection ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-29
IGNITION SWITCH
YAD1F230
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Starter signal recogni- When not detection of • Inspection the Engine Control Module
tion failure starter signal (ECM) pin 2 circuit short or open with
71 bad contact
• Inspection ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-30 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL SYSTEM
The function of the fuel metering system is to deliver of fuel delivered in the starting mode by changing how
the correct amount of fuel to the engine under all long the fuel injector is turned on and off. This is done
operating conditions. by ‘‘pulsing” the fuel injectors for very short times.
The fuel is delivered to the engine by the individual Run Mode
fuel injectors mounted into the intake manifold near
The run mode has two conditions called ‘‘open loop”
each cylinder.
and ‘‘closed loop”.
The main fuel control sensors are the Mass Air Flow
(MAF) sensor and the oxygen (O2) sensors. Open Loop
The MAF sensor monitors the mass flow of the air being When the engine is first started and it is above 690
drawn into the engine. An electrically heated element rpm, the system goes into “open loop” operation. In
is mounted in the intake air stream, where it is cooled “open loop”, the ECM ignores the signal from the HO2S
by the flow of incoming air. Engine Control Module and calculates the air/fuel ratio based on inputs from
(ECM) modulates the flow of heating current to maintain the ECT sensor and the MAF sensor. The ECM stays
the temperature differential between the heated film in “open loop” until the following conditions are met:
and the intake air at a constant level. The amount of • The O2 has a varying voltage output, showing that
heating current required to maintain the temperature it is hot enough to operate properly.
thus provides an index for the mass air flow. This
concept automatically compensates for variations in
• The ECT sensor is above a specified temperature
(22.5 °C).
air density, as this is one of the factors that determines
the amount of warmth that the surrounding air absorbs • A specific amount of time has elapsed after starting
from the heated element. MAF sensor is located the engine.
between the air filter and the throttle valve. Closed Loop
Under high fuel demands, the MAF sensor reads a The specific values for the above conditions vary with
high mass flow condition, such as wide open throttle. different engines and are stored in the Electronically
The ECM uses this information to enrich the mixture, Erasable Programmable Read-Only Memory (EEPROM).
thus increasing the fuel injector on-time, to provide When these conditions are met, the system goes into
the correct amount of fuel. When decelerating, the mass “closed loop” operation. In “closed loop”, the ECM
flow decreases. This mass flow change is sensed by calculates the air/fuel ratio (fuel injector on- time)
the MAF sensor and read by the ECM, which then based on the signals from the O2 sensors. This allows
decreases the fuel injector on-time due to the low fuel the air/fuel ratio to stay very close to 14.7 to 1.
demand conditions.
Acceleration Mode
The O2 sensors are located in the exhaust pipe before
catalytic converter. The O2 sensors indicate to the ECM The ECM responds to rapid changes in throttle position
the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas, and the ECM and airflow and provides extra fuel.
changes the air/fuel ratio to the engine by controlling Deceleration Mode
the fuel injectors. The best air/fuel ratio to minimize
The ECM responds to changes in throttle position and
exhaust emissions is 14.7 to 1, which allows the
airflow and reduces the amount of fuel. When
catalytic converter to operate most efficiently. Because
deceleration is very fast, the ECM can cut off fuel
of the constant measuring and adjusting of the air/fuel
completely for short periods of time.
ratio, the fuel injection system is called a “closed loop”
system. Battery Voltage Correction Mode
The ECM uses voltage inputs from several sensors to When battery voltage is low, the ECM can compensate
determine how much fuel to provide to the engine. The for a weak spark delivered by the ignition module by
fuel is delivered under one of several conditions, called using the following methods:
“modes”. • Increasing the fuel injector pulse width.
Starting Mode • Increasing the idle speed rpm.
When the ignition is turned ON, the ECM turns the fuel • Increasing the ignition dwell time.
pump relay on for 1 second. The fuel pump then builds
Fuel Cut-Off Mode
fuel pressure. The ECM also checks the Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT) sensor and the Throttle Position (TP) No fuel is delivered by the fuel injectors when the
sensor and determines the proper air/fuel ratio for ignition is off. This prevents dieseling or engine run-
starting the engine. This ranges from1.5 to 1 at -36 °C on. Also, the fuel is not delivered if there are no reference
(-33 °F) coolant temperature to 14.7 to 1 at 94 °C (201 pulses received from the CKP sensor. This prevents
°F) coolant temperature. The ECM controls the amount flooding.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-32 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL PUMP
YAD1F240
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-33
YAD1F250
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
34 Fuel pump relay short When short circuit to power • Inspection the Engine Control Module
circuit to battery source (ECM) pin 33 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
Fuel pump relay short When short circuit to ground
35 circuit to ground or or open • Inspection the fuel pump relay
open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM will activate the pump relay and run the in-tank fuel pump. The
fuel pump will operate as long as the engine is cranking or running and the ECM is receiving ignition reference
pulses.
If there are no reference pulses, the ECM will shut off the fuel pump within 2 seconds after the ignitions witch is
turned ON, engine stopped or engine stalled.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-34 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Notice: Check the fuel filter and fuel line when the fuel delivery is not within specified value.
Notice: Replace the fuel pump relay if the measured value is over 9 A.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-36 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL INJECTOR
YAA1F0C0
1 O-Ring 4 O-Ring
2 Injector 5 Fuel Rail
3 Injector Bracket
The Multipoint Fuel Injection (MFI) assembly is a solenoid-operated device controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM) that meters pressurized fuel to an each individual cylinder. The injector sprays the fuel, in precise
quantities at a point in time determined by the ECM, directly towad the cylinder intake valve. ECM energizes the
fuel injector solenoid to lift the needle valve and to flow the fuel through the orifice. This injector’s discharge
orificeis calibrated to meet the effective fuel atomization necessary for both ensuring the maximum homogeneity
in the air-fuel mixture and holding the condensation along the walls of the intake tract to a minimum.
Fuel enters the top feed injector from above and flows through its vertical axis. The lower end extends into the
intake valve. Fuel from the tip is directed at the intake valve, causing it to become further atomized and vaporized
before entering the combustion chamber.
A fuel injector which is stuck partially open would cause a loss of fuel pressure after the engine is shut down.
Also, an extended crank time would be noticed on some engines. Dieseling could also occur because some fuel
could be delivered to the engine after the ignition is turned off.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-37
YAD1F0H0
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 1 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #1 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
72
Injector #1 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power
• Inspection the ECM
No. 1 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 63 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
73 open
Injector #1 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open
• Inspection the ECM
No. 2 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #2 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
74
Injector #2 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power
• Inspection the ECM
No. 2 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 64 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
75 open
Injector #2 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open
• Inspection the ECM
No. 3 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #3 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
76
Injector #3 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-38 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
No. 3 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 65 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
77 open
Injector #3 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open
• Inspection the ECM
No. 4 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the power to injector #4 or
circuit to battery circuit bad contact
78
Injector #4 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
power
• Inspection the ECM
No. 4 injector short When malfunction of injector • Inspection the ECM pin 66 about short
circuit to ground or circuit circuit or open with bad contact
79 open
Injector #4 short circuit to • Inspection the injector
ground or open
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-39
Cranking 8.0 ms
Engine Idle 3 ~ 5 ms
Wide Open Throttle 14 ms
(WOT)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-40 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F440
The fuel vaporization control system is installed to inhibit the fuel vaporized gas from discharging into the
atmosphere. The fuel vaporized gas that is accumulated in the canister abstracts through the purge control valve
purification during the engine combustion (except the decreasing mode) and coolant temperature of over 80 °C.
For this reason, the Engine Control Module (ECM) transacts the engine speed, air inflow quantity, coolant
temperature, and intake temperature.
The purge control valve is activated by the ECM frequency according with the engine rotating speed to adjust the
purification rate. The purification rate is determined by the continuous valve opening interval.
The purge control valve is activated by the ECM for the following conditions:
• Coolant temperature of over 80 °C
• Engine speed of over 1,000 rpm
• 2 minutes after starting
• When the fuel cut-off mode is not activated
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-41
YAD1F310
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
40
Purge control valve When short circuit to power • Inspection the ECM pin 34 about short
short circuit to battery source circuit or open with bad contact
Purge control valve When short circuit to ground • Inspection the source power of valve
41 short circuit to ground or open
or open • Inspection the purge control solenoid
vale
54 Purge control circuit When malfunction of purge
malfunction control : not work • Inspection the ECM
Test
1. Maintain the normal temperature and idling state
by operating the engine.
2. Connect the ECM terminal No. 11 and No. 34 and
check for normal operation through the output waves
using oscilloscope.
Notice: Test during purge control valve operation
after the minimum of 1 minute after the engine
turned on.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-42 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL RAIL
YAA1F0E0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-43
Pressure change
Fuel pressure • Fuel leakage at the injector
drops slowly
• Faulty fuel pressure
regulator’s diaphragm
and O-ring
YAA1F0K0
Fuel pressure • Faulty check valve in
drops rapidly the fuel pump
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-44 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F0F0
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-45
YAD1F390
YAD1F400
A. Fuel pressure
B. Intake Manifold Negative Pressure
LL. Idling
TL. Partial load
VL. Full load
YAD1F380
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-46 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
INDUCTION SYSTEM
THROTTLE VALVE ACTUATOR
YAA1F540
The throttle actuator is actuated by the Engine Control the spring capsule.
Module (ECM) according to the position of the Consequently, the throttle valve opening is a constant
accelerator pedal position. 10-12 °approximately.
It has two potentiometers which signal the position of At no load, this produces an engine speed of about
the throttle valve to the ECM to enable it to recognize 1,800 rpm
the various engine load states.
Driving
Ignition “Off”
When driving (part/full throttle), the servo motor controls
In the de-energized states the throttle valve position the throttle valve in line with the various load states
is determined to be spring capsule. and according to the input signals from the pedal value
Ignition “On” sensor according to the input signals from the pedal
value sensor according to the position of the
When the ignition S/W on the servo motor in the throttle
accelerator pedal.
actuator is operated by the ECM. The throttle valve
adopts a position in line with the coolant temperature. The function of the EA (electronic accelerator) in the
ECM determines the opening angle of the throttle valve
Closed position through the throttle actuator. Further functions are;
In the closed throttle position, the servo motor controls • Idle speed control
engine speed by operating the throttle valve further
(greater mixture) or closing it further (reduced mixture),
• Cruise control
depending on coolant temperature and engine load. • Reducing engine torque for ASR/ABS operation
When this is done, the throttle valve can be closed • Electronic accelerator emergency running
further by the servo motor overcoming the force of the • Storing faults
spring capsule (mechanical end stop). If the actuator
• Data transfer through CAN
is de-energized, the throttle valve is resting against
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-47
YAD1F420
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
104
Throttle position sensor TPS 1 short circuit to ground • Monitoring the actual values through
1 low voltage or open scan tool
105
Throttle position sensor TPS 1 short circuit to power • Inspection the ECM pin 84, 85, 87, 112,
1 high voltage 67, 68 about short circuit or open with
bad contact
Throttle position sensor TPS 2 short circuit to ground
108
2 low voltage or open • Inspection the throttle valve actuator
109
Throttle position sensor TPS 2 short circuit to power • Inspection the ECM
2 high voltage
Throttle actuator When actuat or adaption
116 learning control failure fluctuation or not meet the
condition
Throttle valve return When return spring
119
spring failure defective of actuator
Throttle act uator failure When supply voltage of the
121 actuat or short circuit to
power
Different mass air flow When shut down of out put
123 sensor signal with driver
throttle position sensor
Both throttle position When defective of both
125
sensor failure potentiometers
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-48 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Throttle position sensor When difference between • Monitoring the actual values through
126 1 not plausible with TPS 1 and TPS 2 scan tool
Throttle position sensor 2
• Inspection the ECM pin 84, 85, 87, 112,
High permanent throttle When failure of wiring 67, 68 about short circuit or open with
127 signal harness or actuator bad contact
Mass air flow sensor When difference between • Inspection the throttle valve actuator
185 and throttle position MAF and TPS signal
sensor failure • Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The ECM supplies a 5 volt reference signal and a ground to the TP sensor. The TP sensor sends a voltage signal
back to the ECM relative to the throttle plate opening. The volt age signal will vary from approximately 0.3 ~ 0.9
volts at closed throttle, to over 4.0 ~ 4.6 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
The TP sensors serve for engine load control according to the drive pedal command. Load adjustments independent
of the drive pedal command can be implemented; such functions are, for instance, idle control, speed control,
drive slip control, load shock damping, and similar functions .
When the actuator current fails , the throttle valve is returned to emergency operating position by a spring. The
throttle valve position, there by the actuator drive position check back is provided by two potentiometers. The
motor positions the throttle valve against the return spring force. Motor and return spring are two separate energy
sources . Each of them is able to position the throttle valve in emergency position alone. Throttle valve position
check back and monitoring is provided by two actual value potentiometers connected to the engine control
electronics.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-50 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F430
1 Housing 4 Connector
2 Protector Net 5 Hot Film Air Mass Sensor
3 Electronic Housing 6 Measuring Port
The Hot Film Air Mass (HFM) sensor with recognition of flow direction related to pulsating flow is designed for
recording load on Engine Control Module (ECM) by measuring the output voltage proportional to the reference
voltage of the ECM.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Mass Air Flow (MAF) is a thermal flow meter whose sensor element with its temperature sensors and heating area
is exposed to the MAF to be measured. A heating area located in the center of a thin membraneis controlled to an
over temperature by a heating resistor and a temperature sensor of this membrane. And the value of over-
temperature depends on the temperature of the in-flowing air.
Two temperature sensors on upstream and downstream of the heating area show the same temperature without
incoming flow. With incoming flow, upstream part is cooled down but downstream temperature retains its temperature
more or less due to the air heated up in the heating area. This temperature difference in quantity and direction
depends on the direction of the incoming flow.
ECM modulates the flow of heating current to maintain the temperature differential between the heated film and
the intake air at a constant level. The amount of heating current required to maintain the temperature thus provides
an index for the MAF. This concept automatically compensates for variations in air density, as this is one of the
factors that determines the amount of warmth that the surrounding air absorbs from the heated element. MAF
sensor is located between the air filter and the throttle valve.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-51
Under high fuel demands, the MAF sensor reads a high mass flow condition, such as Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
The ECM uses this information to enrich the mixture, thus increasing the fuel injector on-time, to provide the
correct amount of fuel. When decelerating, the mass flow decreases. This mass flow change is sensed by the
MAF sensor and read by the ECM, which then decreases the fuel injector on-time due to the low fuel demand
conditions.
To facilitate the installation of the HFM in the intake passage, lubricating agents may be used. However, when
lubricants are used care must be taken to ensure that they do not enter the flow passage and cannot be sucked
in with the air flow.
The following tables show the relationship between MAF and output voltage.
Mass Air Flow (kg/h) Voltage (V) Mass Air Flow (kg/h) Voltage (V)
0 0.95 ~ 1.05 250 3.51
10 1.28 370 3.93
15 1.41 480 4.23
30 1.71 640 4.56
60 2.16 800 4.82
120 2.76
Temp. (°C) Ω)
R min.(Ω Ω)
R nom. (Ω Ω)
R max. (Ω
-40 35140 39260 43760
-20 12660 13850 15120
0 5119 5499 5829
20 2290 2420 2551
40 1096 1166 1238
60 565 609 654
80 312 340 370
100 184 202 222
120 114 127 141
130 91 102 114
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-52 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F440
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
03
Intake air temperature IAT sensor short circuit to • Monitoring the actual air temperature
sensor low voltage ground or open through scan tool
04
Intake air temperature IAT sensor short circuit to • Inspection the ECM pin 80, 79 about
sensor high voltage power short circuit or open with bad contact
Intake air temperature Malfunction in recognition of • Inspection the IAT sensor (integrated in
05 sensor plausibility IAT HFM sensor)
When functional problem • Inspection the ECM
Mass air flow sensor Malfunction in recognition of • Monitoring the actual air mass flow
09 plausibility MAF through scan tool
When air mass not plausible • Inspection the ECM pin 81, 105 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
Mass air flow sensor MAF sensor short circuit to
10
low voltage ground or open • Inspection the MAF sensor (integrated in
HFM sensor)
Mass air flow sensor MAF sensor short circuit to
11
high voltage power • Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The heated element on the MAF is a platinum film resistor (heater). It is located on a ceramic plate together with
the other elements in the bridge circuit. The temperature sensitive resistor (flow sensor) also included in the
bridge. The separation of heater and flow sensor facilitates design of the control circuitry. Saw cuts are employed
to ensure thermal decoupling between the heating element and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. The
complete control circuitry is located on a single layer. The voltage at the heater provides the index for the mass
air flow. The MAF’s electronic circuitry then converts the voltage to a level suitable for processing in the ECM.
This device does not need a burn off process to maintain its measuring precision over an extended period. In
recognition of the fact that most deposits collect on the sensor element’s leading edge, the essential thermal
transfer elements are located downstream on the ceramic layer. The sensor element is also design to ensure that
deposits will not influence the flow pattern around the sensor.
The IAT sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM supplies 5 volt reference and
a ground to the sensor. When the air is cold, the resistance is high; therefore the IAT signal voltage will be high.
If the intake air is warm, resistance is low; therefore the IAT signal voltage will be low.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-53
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable or MAF
sensor in itself. Perform the 5 volt power supply inspection procedures.
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cableor ECM
coupling.
5. Measure the voltage between the ECM pin No. 105 and MAF sensor connecter terminal No. 4.
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cableor ECM
coupling.
Specified Value 11 ~ 14 V
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable or Over
Voltage Protection Relay (OVPR).
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-54 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F590
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor detects coolant temperature and supplies information to the ECM. It is
composed of metal housing with two NTC resistor, 4 pin connector. The ECM provides a 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor through a dropping resistor. When the engine is cold, the ECT sensor provides high resistance, which the
ECM detects as a high signal voltage. As the engine warms up, the sensor resistance becomes lower, and the
signal voltage drops. At normal engine operating temperature, the ECT signal will measure about 1.5 to 2.0 volts.
The ECM uses information about coolant temperature to make the necessary calculations for:
• Fuel delivery
• Ignition control
• Knock sensor system
• Idle speed
• Torque converter clutch application
• Canister purge
• Cooling fan operation
• Others
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-55
Ω)
Temperature (°C) Resistance (Ω Voltage (V)
-40 48,550 4.90
-30 27,000 4.82
-20 15,570 4.70
-10 9,450 4.52
0 5,890 4.43
10 3,790 3.96
20 2,500 3.57
30 1,692 3.14
40 1,170 2.70
YAD1F460
50 826 2.26
60 594 1.86
70 434 1.51
80 322 1.22
90 243 0.98
100 185 0.78
110 143 0.63
120 111.6 0.50
130 88 0.40
140 71.2 0.33
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-56 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F470
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Engine coolant ECT sensor short circuit to • Monitoring the actual coolant temperature
00 temperature sensor low ground or open through scan t ool
voltage
• Inspection the ECM pin 78, 79 about
Engine coolant ECT sensor short circuit to short circuit or open with bad contact
01 temperature sensor high power
voltage • Inspection the ECT sensor
Circuit Description
The ECT sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM supplies a voltage on the
signal circuit to the sensor. When the engine coolant is cold, the resistance is high; therefore the ECT signal
voltage will be high
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Inspection
1. Turn the ignition switch to “ON” position.
2. Measure the voltage between the ECM pin No. 78 and No. 79.
Temperature (°C) Specified Value (V)
20 3.57
80 1.22
100 0.78
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-57
Notice: Replace wiring and coolant temperature sensor if out of specified value.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-58 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F480
The Acceleration Pedal Position (APP) sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor is
actually two individual APP sensors and one housing. This sensor works with theThrottle Position (TP) sensor to
provide input to the Engine Control Module (ECM) regarding driver requested accelerator pedal and throttle angle
at the throttle body.
When the APP sensor is defected:
When the APP 1 or APP 2 sensor is defected condition, the engineis still running at idle condition but, the
accelerator pedal reaction is not response correctly and also, the engine rpm will be reacted to 4,000 rpm slowly.
If the APP 1 sensor is out of order, the APP 2 sensor will be conducted with signal as adefault signal but, the
throttle valve opening is limited 60% and delayed opening speed.
When the TP sensor or servo motor is defected:
When the TP 1, 2 sensor or servomotor is defected condition, the throttle valve will be closed to the spring
capsule by spring force, at this condition, the throttle valve will open 10° ~ 20° and engine rpm will be controlled
by ECM will opening (On/Off) time of injector. The engine rpm will be maintaining 900 rpm (at idle) to 1,800
according to the engine load.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-59
YAD1F490
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Acceleration pedal When malfunction of APP • Monitoring the actual values through
122 position sensor signal sensor scan tool
failure
• Inspection the ECM pin 31, 47, 32, 48,
Acceleration pedal APP 1 sensor short circuit to 59, 51 about short circuit or open with
160 position 1 sensor low ground or open bad contact
voltage
• Inspection the APP sensor
Acceleration pedal APP 1 sensor short circuit to
161 position sensor 1 high power • Inspection the ECM
voltage
Acceleration pedal APP 2 sensor short circuit to
162 position sensor 2 low ground or open
voltage
Acceleration pedal APP 2 sensor short circuit to
163 position sensor 2 high power
voltage
Accelerator pedal When difference between
position sensor 1 not APP 1 sensor and APP 2
164 plausible with sensor
accelerator pedal
position sensor 2
Both setpoint When defective of both APP
167 accelerator pedal sensor
position sensor defective
Circuit Description
The ECM supplies a 5 or 2.5 volt reference signal and a ground to the APP sensor 1 or 2. The ECM calculates on
these signal lines. The APP sensor output changes as the accelerator pedal is moved. The output of the APP 1
and APP 2 sensor are low, about 0.4 ~ 0.7 volts and 0.2 ~ 0.35 volts respectively at the closed throttle position.
As pushing the accelerator pedal, the output increases so that the output voltages will be about 4.3 ~ 4.8 volts
and 2.1 ~ 2.4 volts individually when accelerating fully with the kick down, at Wide Open Throttle (WOT).
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-60 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Notice: If measured value is not within the specified value, check the pedal valve sensor and the supply
voltage to APP 1 sensor.
Notice: If measured value is not within the specified value, check the pedal valve sensor and the supply
voltage to APP sensor 2.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-62 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
COOLING FAN
YAD1F510
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
44
Cooling fan (HI ) relay Cooling fan short circuit to • Inspection the Engine Control Module
short circuit to power power (ECM) pin 35 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
Cooling fan (HI ) relay Cooling fan short circuit to
short circuit to ground ground or open • Inspection the power source
45 or open
• Inspection the cooling fan
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
Ignition voltage is supplied directly to the cooling fan relay coil. The ECM controls the relay by grounding the
control circuit. When the ECM is commanding a command ON, the voltage of the control circuit should be low
(near 0 volt).
When the ECM is commanding the control circuit should be high (near battery voltage). If the fault detection circuit
senses a voltage other than what is expected, the fault line status will change causing the fault code to set.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-63
YAD1F520
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
228
A/C compressor relay When malfunction of A/C • Monitoring the actual operation through
short circuit to battery compressor control scan tool
A/c compressor relay • Inspection the Engine Control Module
short circuit to ground (ECM) pin 44 about short circuit or open
or open with bad contact
229
• Inspection the relay short circuit or open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
When the ECM detects that A/C has been requested, the ECM will activated the A/C clutch relay. When the relay
has been activated, voltage should be present at both the A/C clutch relay and A/C switch circuit at ECM.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-64 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F530
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Cruise control “OFF” Cruise control system • Monitoring the actual recognition status
129 due to message counter message counter fault and vehicle speed signal through scan
failure tool
130
Vehicle speed signal When malfunction of • Inspection the Engine Control Module
failure auto-cruise system (ECM) pin 52, 53, 54, 55, 57 about short
Implausible condition of circuit or open with bad contact
Vehicle speed signal
131 vehicle speed signal.
failure • Inspection the CAN and ABS
132
Cruise control lever Cruise control lever defective • Inspection the cruise control lever switch
failure
• Inspection the ECM
Cruise control system
Cruise control
133 Implausible condition of
acceleration failure
acceleration signal
Cruise control Cruise control system
134 deceleration failure Implausible condition of
deceleration signal
Circuit Description
Cruise control is an automatic speed control system that maintain adesired driving speed with out using the
accelerator pedal. The vehicle speed must be greater than 40 km/h to engage cruise control.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-65
YAD1F540
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
150 TCS input signal short TCS short circuit to power • Inspection the Engine Control Module
circuit to battery (ECM) pin 45 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
TCS input signal short TCS short circuit to ground
151 circuit to ground or or open • Inspection the TCS lamp of I/P cluster.
open
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
Battery voltage is supplied to the TCS warning lamp with the ignition in ON and START. The warning lamp can be
activated only by the Electrical Brake Control Module (EBCM) internally supplying ground to terminal 21. If the
TCS input circuit is open or short, this failure code will be set.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-66 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F550
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
135
Stop lamp switch failure When malfunction of stop • Monitoring the actual operational status
lamp switch-implausible and vehicle speed signal through scan
condition of stop lamp tool
signal input
• Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 49 about short circuit or open
with bad contact
• Inspection the contact condition of stop
lamp switch
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The stop lamp switch is normally opened. When the ignition switch ON and brake ON, the battery voltage is
supplied to the ECM. A scan tool should display ON when brake pedal is depressed and should read OFF with
brake pedal released.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-67
ENGINE RPM
YAD1F560
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Engine rpm output When short circuit to battery • Monitoring the actual rpm in cluster
32 circuit short circuit to
battery • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 60 about short circuit or open
Engine rpm output When short circuit to ground
33 circuit short circuit to or open • Inspection the cluster panel board circuit
ground or open • Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-68 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
CATALYTIC CONVERTER These catalysts in the 3-way catalytic converter are
the rare metals platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh).
The purpose of the catalytic converter is to convert
The catalytic converter consists essentially of three
the three pollutants of carbon monoxide (CO),
main elements. The exhaust gases flow through the
hydrocarbons (HC) and oxides of nitrogen (NOx)
catalytic converter and, in so doing, coming into
contained in the exhaust of gasoline engines, into the
contact with rare metals (Pt and Rh).
harmless compounds of water (H2O), carbon dioxide
(CO2) and nitrogen (N2). The following chemical reaction are produced.
The catalytic converter contains acatalyst, a word CO + O 2 → CO2
coming from the Greek and which designates the HC + O2 → CO2 + H 2O
element essential for catalyst which triggers chemical NO x → N 2 + O2
reactions without itself being consumed.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-70 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
OXYGEN SENSOR
YAD1F570
The oxygen sensor is unique amongthe engine control When the exhaust gas is rich (below 14.7:1), the voltage
sensors because is acts like a battery and is able to output is high, above 450 mv. When the exhaust gas
generate its own low voltage signal. It is located the is lean (above 14.7:1 air/fuel ratio), the sensor’s
exhaust system and monitors the amount of oxygen in voltage output is low, below 450 mv.
the exhaust stream and provides feedback to the The ECM uses oxygen sensor information for:
Engine Control Module (ECM).
• Open loop / closed loop criteria
The electrically heated oxygen sensor warms up quickly
and remains hot, even at idle when the exhaust manifold • Ideal air / fuel ratio
may cool down.
The ECM applies a reference voltage of 450 mv to the
oxygen sensor, the ECM compares this reference
voltage with the voltage generated by oxygen sensor.
The amount of voltage the oxygen sensor generates is
proportionate to the difference between the amount of
oxygen in the outside air and the exhaust gases. The
atmosphere contains about 21% oxygen. The exhaust
from a rich air/fuel ratio contains almost no oxygen.
With a large difference betweenthe amounts of oxygen
containing the two surface, the sensor generates less
voltage.
YAD1F580
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-71
YAD1F590
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-72 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F600
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Oxygen sensor high When recognition the output • Monitoring the actual output signal
voltage that more than nominal through scan tool
80 threshold, malfunction of
sensing voltage. • Inspection the ECM pin 16, 17 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
Oxygen sensor low When recognition the output
voltage that more than nominal • Inspection the oxygen sensor
89
threshold, malfunction of • Inspection the ECM
sensing voltage.
Oxygen sensor no When recognition the output
82
activity detected that not active the sensor etc.
Oxygen sensor not lean When recognition the output
83 after overrun fuel that no lean signal after
shut-off overrun fuel shut-off
Oxygen sensor slow When slow response of sensor
84
response signal
85
Oxygen sensor heater When recognition the heating • Monitoring the heating status through
failure circuit scan tool
Oxygen sensor heater When recognition the heating • Inspection the ECM pin 9 about short
short circuit to battery currents that more or less than circuit or open with bad contact
86 set values (less than 0.2 A or
more than 2 A) • Inspection the heating power source
Oxygen sensor heater When recognition the heating • Inspection the heating circuit of oxygen
sensor
87 short circuit to ground voltages than less than set
or open values (less than 2 v) • Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-73
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Bank 1 system short When recognition the value • Inspection the intake air leakage
term fuel trim less than nominal control
adaptation below lean threshold, it means that when • Inspection the injection quantities with
81 injector block or leakage
threshold big deviation in control range
of adaptation values through • Inspection the exhaust leakage
fuel and air mixture formation
• Inspection the ECM
Bank 1 system short When recognition the value
term fuel trim more than nominal control
adaptation above rich threshold, it means that when
93 threshold big deviation in control range
of adaptation values through
fuel and air mixture formation
Bank 1 system short When recognition the short
96 term fuel trim at rich term fuel trim that more than
stop nominal threshold
Bank 1 system short When recognition the short
97 term fuel trim at lean term fuel trim that less than
stop nominal threshold
Bank 1 system idle When recognition the long
98 adaptationfailure term fuel trim exceeds rich
(above rich threshold) threshold
Bank 1 system idle When recognition the long
99 adaptation failure term fuel trim exceeds lean
(below rich threshold) threshold
Bank 1 system learning When recognition the long
100 control failure term fuel trim exceeds rich
(rich, low load) threshold
Bank 1 system learning When recognition the long
101 control failure term fuel trim exceeds lean
(lean, low load) threshold
Bank 1 system learning When recognition the long
102 control failure term fuel trim exceeds rich
(rich, high load) threshold
Bank 1 system learning When recognition the long
103 control failure term fuel trim exceeds lean
(rich, low load) threshold
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-74 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
Circuit Description
In order to control emissions, a catalytic converter is used to covert harmful emissions into harmless water vapor and
carbon dioxide. The ECM has the ability to monitor this process by using a oxygen sensor. The oxygen sensor
produces and output signal which indicates the storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the catalyst’s
ability to convert exhaust emission effectively. If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged.
Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly, it must have
a clean air reference provided to it. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wire(s). Any
attempt to repair the wires, connector, or terminal and degrade the oxygen sensor performance.
Oxygen Sensor Signal Voltage Inspection
1. Maintain the engine speed is at idle while the coolant temperature is over 80 °C.
2. Measure the oxygen sensor signal voltage between the ECM terminal No. 16 and No. 17.
Specified Value 0.2 ~ 1.0 V
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible causemay bein cable, oxygen
sensor or ECM
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable, oxygen
sensor or ECM
Notice: If the measured value is not within the specified value, the possible cause may be in cable, oxygen
sensor or ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-76 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F610
1 Cover 5 Pin
2 Plate Vehicle Side : No. 13-60
3 Connector Engine Side : No. 73-120
4 Plat Pin A Vehicle Side Connector : Black
Vehicle Side : No. 1-12 B Engine Side Connector : Gray
Engine Side : No. 61-72
The Engine Control Module (ECM), located inside the right side kick panel, is the control center of the fuel
injection system. It constantly looks at the information fromvarious sensors and controls the systems that affect
the vehicle’s performance. Engine rpm and air mass are used to measure the air intake quantity resulting in fuel
injection metering. The ECM also performs the diagnostic functions of the system. It can recognize operational
problems, store failure code(s) which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in making repairs.
There are no serviceable parts in the ECM. The calibrations are stored in the ECM in the Programmable Read
Only Memory (PROM).
The ECM supplies either 5 or 12 volts to power the sensors or switches. This is done through resistance in the
ECM which are so high in value that a test light will not come ON when connected to the circuit. In some cases,
even an ordinary shop voltmeter will not give and accurate reading because its resistance is too low. You must
use a digital voltmeter with a 10 Mohm input impedance to get accurate voltage readings. The ECM controls
output circuits such as the ignition coils, the fuel injectors, the fuel pump relay, the camshaft actuator, the
canister purge valve, etc., by controlling the ground circuit.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-78 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1F620
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ASR unit with CAN
failure: ASR/MSR missing or implausibility for connection
ASR/MSR unit or not
23 initialized condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS unit with CAN
failure: ABS missing or implausibility for connection
ABS unit or not initialized
24 • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
condition
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the TCM unit with CAN
failure: TCU (A/T only) missing or implausibility for connection
TCU unit or not initialized
26
condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-79
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS/ABD unit with CAN
failure: ID 200h not missing or implausibility for connection
plausible ABS/ABD unit or not initialized
29 condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ABS/ABD unit with CAN
failure: ID 208h not missing or implausibility for connection
plausible ABS/ABD unit or not initialized
30 condition • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the each control unit with CAN
failure: communication missing or implausibility for connection
initialization failure each unit (ABS, ASR, TCM,
31
TOD etc.) or not initialized • Inspection the ECM pin 38, 37 about
short circuit or open with bad contact
condition
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the MSR unit with CAN
failure: MSR data missing or implausibility for connection
transmission not MSR unit or not initialized
59 plausible condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
CAN communication When CAN signal message • Inspection the ASR unit with CAN
failure: ASR data missing or implausibility for connection
transmission not ASR unit or not initialized
60 plausible condition • Inspection the Engine Control Module
(ECM) pin 38, 37 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the ECM
Circuit Description
The provision for communicating with the ECM is the Data Link Connector (DLC). It is located in the instrument
panel fuse block. The DLC is used to connect the scan tool. Battery power and ground is supplied for the scan
tool through the DLC. CAN line is used to communicate with the other module such as the Transmission Control
Module (TCM) and Transfer Case Control Unit (TCCU).
Keyword 2000 Serial Data Communications
Each bit of information can have one of two lengths: long or short. This allows vehicle wiring to be reduced by
transmitting and receiving multiple signals over a singles wire. The message carried on KWP 2000 data streams
are also prioritized. If two messages attempt to establish communications on the data line at the same time, only
the message with higher priority will must wait.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-80 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
INTERNAL FAILURE
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Transmission coding When faulty of variant coding • Inspection the coding condition through
failure of transmission scan tool
21 • InspectiontheEngine ControlModule
(ECM)
• Inspection the CAN line
• Inspection the TCM
ECM failure (RAM) When malfunction of random • Inspection the ECM
136 access memory - ECM
internal error
Uncoded/ unprogramed When malfunction of ECM • Fulfill the ECM variant coding
142 ECM coding-required ECM
encoding
137 ECM failure (EPROM) When malfunction of ECM • Inspection the ECM
internal
ECM failure (EEPROM/
143 Flash-EPPOM
checksum failure)
ECM failure (coding ID
144
checksum failure)
ECM failure (coding
145
checksum failure)
ECM failure (program-
146 ming checksum failure)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-82 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
110
Throttle actuator System internal failure • Inspection the Engine Control Module
learning data fault (ECM)
Exceed fuel-cut safety
117 time
Cruise control
120 interruption memory
failure
138 Call Monitoring
Servo motor control
139 output interruption
memory failure
140 Servo motor open/short
ECM failure
186
(incompatible CPU)
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-83
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Unusual accelerator System internal failure • Inspection the Engine Control Module
pedal position sensor (ECM)
239
comparison fault
(CPU 2)
Throttle potentiometer
240 comparison fault
(CPU 2)
Unusual CPU
241 communication (CPU 2)
Unusual CPU
242
configuration (CPU 2)
A/D converter failure
243
(CPU 2)
Accelerator pedal
position sensor setpoint
244 fault between CPU 1
and CPU 2
Position controller
245 setpoint fault between
CPU 1 and CPU 2
MSR setpoint fault
246 between CPU 1 and
CPU 2
Idle control setpoint
247 fault between CPU 1
and CPU 2
A/D converter overflow
248
(CPU 2)
249 ROM fault (CPU 2)
250 RAM fault (CPU 2)
Cycle monitor fault
251
(CPU 2)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-84 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
IMMOBILIZER
YAD1F630
Failure
Description Trouble Area Maintenance Hint
Code
Communication with When missing the transpon- • Inspection the Engine Control Module
transponder missing der signal (ECM) pin 13, 14 about short circuit or
open with bad contact
• Inspection the power source or ground
25 short circuit or open of immobilizer unit
• Inspection the transponder condition
(broken etc.)
• Inspection the ECM
Unprogramed ECM with When malfunction of • Fulfill the immobilizer pairing
immobilizer immobilizer
141 Required immobilizer
encoding, no paired
condition of immobilizer even
through start trial
Circuit Description
Immobilizer is a device disabling vehicle ignition unless a specific key is used and designed to help prevent
vehicle theft.
Immobilizer is comprised of two devices, a key with encoded transponder and ECM with the same encoding of
the transponder. When a key is inserted into the hole to start vehicle and turned to ON, the ECM reads and
decodes the transponder code and, if the same, starts the engine, it is called immobilizer. It means immobilizer
system disables starting by stopping fuel supply if the code in the transponder does not match the code stored
in ECM each other.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-85
YAA1F700
YAA1F710
FUEL PUMP
Tools Required
661 589 00 46 00 Fuel Tank Cap Wrench
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To avoid
fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury or fire,
it is necessary to relieve the fuel system pressure
before disconnecting the fuel lines.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-86 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F550
FUEL FILTER
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To
avoid fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury
or fire, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before disconnecting the fuel lines.
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-87
FUEL TANK
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: The fuel system is under pressure. To avoid
fuel spillage and the risk of personal injury or fire,
it is necessary to relieve the fuel system pressure
before disconnecting the fuel lines.
YAA1F170
YAA1F160
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-88 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F180
YAA1F700
YAA1F720
YAA1F730
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-89
YAA1F740
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
YAA1F750
11. Remove the two left and two right bolts and one
center bolt of the fuel rail assembly from the intake
manifold.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
YAA1F760
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-90 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-91
KAC1F250
KFC1F240
YAA1F790
KAA1D240
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-92 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
KNOCK SENSOR
Removal and installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the knock sensor electrical connector
from the intake manifold bracket.
3. Remove the knock sensor mounting bolt from the
knock sensor installed on the cylinder block.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 25 N•m (18 lb-ft)
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-93
OXYGEN SENSOR
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Notice: The oxygen sensor uses a permanently
attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail should
not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage
or removal of the pigtail or the connector could
affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor. Do
not drop the oxygen sensor.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-94 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
CANISTER
Removal and Installation Procedure
Caution: Canister and vacuum hoses contain fuel
vapors. Do not smoke in the area or permit an open
flame.
YAD1F660
YAD1F670
YAA1F810
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-95
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-96 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
ECM WIRING DIAGRAM (2.3L DOHC - 1 OF 7) (MSE 3.53D) SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS
YAD1F010
SSANGYONG Y200
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F030
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F0B0
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD1F0D0
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-103
SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE DATA DISPLAY TABLE
Parameter Unit Value
Engine Coolant Temp. °C greater than 95 °C after warm up
-40 ~ 130 °C (varies with ambient
Intake Air Temp. °C
temp. or engine mode)
Engine RPM rpm 700 ± 50 (P/N), 600 ± 50 (D)
Regular RPM rpm 700 ± 50 (P/N), 600 ± 50 (D)
Engine Load % 18 ~ 25 %
Mass Air Flow Meter Kg/h 16 ~ 25 Kg/h
0 °TA (up to 100 °TA at the wide
Throttle Position Angle °TA open throttle)
Spark Advance °CA °CA (6 ~ 9 °CA)
Indicated Engine Torque Nm Varies with engine condition
Injection Time ms 3 ~ 5 ms
Battery Voltage V 13.5 ~ 14.1 V (engine running)
Front Axle Speed Km/h 0 ~ 265 Km/h
Rear Axle Speed Km/h 0 ~ 265 Km/h
Accel. Pedal Position 1 V 0.4 ~ 4.8 V
Accel. Pedal Position 2 V 0.2 ~ 2.4 V
Throttle Position 1 V 0.3 ~ 4.6 V
Throttle Position 2 V 0.3 ~ 4.6 V
Fuel Integrator 0.8 ~ 1.2
Oxygen Sensor mv 100 ~ 900 mv
A/C S/W Condition 1=ON/0=OFF -
Full Load State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Shift Gear State (A/T) 1=ON/0=OFF -
A/C Control State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Clutch Switch (M/T) 1=ON/0=OFF -
Cam Actuator State 1=ON/0=OFF -
Knocking Control 1=ON/0=OFF -
Protect Mission 1=ON/0=OFF -
Purge Control Valve 1=ON/0=OFF -
Lambda Function 1=ON/0=OFF -
Catalyst Heating 1=ON/0=OFF -
Overrun Fuel Cut 1=ON/0=OFF -
Full Fuel Cut 1=ON/0=OFF -
Brake Switch 1=ON/0=OFF -
Cruise Control Status 1=ON/0=OFF -
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-104 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
M161 ENGINE CONTROLS 1F2-105
FUEL SYSTEM SPECIFICATION This type of fuel can reduce vehicle performance and
damage components of the fuel system.
Use Only Unleaded Fuel Rated at 89 Octane
Caution: Use of methanol may damage the fuel sys-
or Higher tem.
Fuel quality and additives contained in fuel have a
significant effect on power output, drivability, and life Vehicle Fueling from Drums or Storage
of the engine. Containers
Fuel with too low an octane number can cause engine For safety reasons (particularly when using noncom-
knock. mercial fueling systems) fuel containers, pumps and
Caution: Use of fuel with an octane number lower hoses must be properly earthed.
than 89 may damage engine and exhaust system. Static electricity build up can occur under certain atmo-
spheric and fuel flow conditions if unearthed hoses,
Notice: To prevent accidental use of leaded fuel, the particularly plastic, are fitted to the fuel-dispensing
nozzles for leaded fuel are larger, and will not fit the pump.
fuel filler neck of your vehicle. It is therefore recommended that earthed pumps with
integrally earthed hoses be used, and that storage
Do Not Use Methanol containers be properly earthed during all
Fuels containing methanol (wood alcohol) should not noncommercial fueling operations.
be used in vehicle.
TEMPERATURE VS RESISTANCE
ECT sensor IAT sensor
°C °F
ohms (Ω)
Temperature vs Resistance Values (Approximate)
130 266 88 102
120 248 111.6 127
110 230 143 159
100 212 202 202
90 194 261 261
80 176 340 340
70 158 452 452
60 140 609 609
50 122 835 835
40 113 1166 1166
30 86 1662 1662
20 68 2420 2420
10 50 3604 3604
0 32 5499 5499
-10 14 8609 8609
-20 -4 13850 13850
-30 -22 22960 22960
-40 -40 39260 39260
SSANGYONG Y200
1F2-106 M161 ENGINE CONTROLS
YAA1F890 KAA1F490
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 1F3
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Caution: Disconnect the negative battery cable before removing or installing any electrical unit or when a
tool or equipment could easily come in contact with exposed electrical terminals. Disconnecting this cable
will help prevent personal injury and damage to the vehicle. The ignition must also be in LOCK unless
otherwise noted.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................. 1F3-2 Repair Instructions ............................................ 1F3-41
Fuel System ...................................................... 1F3-2 On-Vehicle Service ........................................... 1F3-41
Governor ........................................................... 1F3-4 Vacuum Pump .................................................. 1F3-41
Absolute Metering Manifold Pressure Vacuum Unit Replacement ................................ 1F3-43
Compensator (ALDA) .....................................1F3-10 Fuel Pump ........................................................ 1F3-44
Pneumatic Idle Speed Increase (PLA) ............... 1F3-11 Injection Nozzles ..............................................1F3-46
Pneumatic Shut-Off Device (PNAB) ................... 1F3-12 Injection Nozzle Repair .....................................1F3-48
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve .............1F3-13 Injection Timing Device Assembly .................... 1F3-51
Component Locator ......................................... 1F3-15 Injection Timing Device .....................................1F3-56
Fuel Injection Pump .......................................... 1F3-15 Fuel Injection Pump .......................................... 1F3-58
Vacuum Pump (Sectional View) .........................1F3-16 Fuel Tank .......................................................... 1F3-64
Diagnostic Information And Procedure ........... 1F3-17 Specifications ................................................... 1F3-66
Vacuum Control System Test ............................ 1F3-17 General Specifications ......................................1F3-66
Vacuum Shut-Off Leak Test ............................... 1F3-21 Fastener Tightening Specifications .................... 1F3-67
Idle Speed Adjustment .....................................1F3-23 Schematic and Routing Diagrams ................... 1F3-68
Fuel Pump Test ................................................. 1F3-25 EGR System................................................... 1F3-68
Injection Nozzle Test ........................................1F3-28 Special Tools and Equipment .......................... 1F3-69
Checking and Adjusting Start Of Delivery .......... 1F3-31 Special Tools Table ...........................................1F3-69
1F3-2 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAA0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-3
P Injection Pump
E Self - Driven
S End Flange Mounting
5 Number of Cylinders (5EA)
M Pump Size (Flange Stroke)
M - 7 mm
A - 8 mm
M, W - 8 mm, 10 mm
YAD1FAB0
P - 10 mm, 11 mm, 12 mm
Z - 12 mm
O - 15 mm
55 Element Diameter
C Modification Letter
320 Assembly Number
R Direction of Rotation (clockwise)
S167 Special Version
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-4 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAC0
a Idle Range (Working Range of the Idle Spring) S Start Setting With Accelerator Pedal fully
b Extended Idle Range at No-Load and Minimum Depressed (Cold-Start)
Part Load (Working Range of the Idle Spring S ’ Start Setting With Accelerator Pedal Released
and the Auxiliary Idle Spring) (Hot/ Warm Start)
c Uncontrolled Range L Low-Idle-Speed Setting
d Torque-Control Range (Working Range of the O High-Idle-Speed Setting
Torque-Control Spring) n1u Low Idle Speed
e Torque-Control Travel n1o High Idle Speed
f Speed-Regulation Range (Working Range of the nvo Maximum Full-Load Speed
Governor Spring) n1 Speed at Start of Torque Control
g Full-Load Speed Regulation to the High Idle n2 Speed at End of Torque Control
Speed
h Start of the Auxiliary Idle-Spring Shutoff
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-5
Speed-sensing mechanism stage 1 (low idle) The flyweights (22) are fastened directly to the injection-
The force path starts at flyweights (22) and travels pump camshaft and when they move outward,
through sliding sleeve (20) and guide lever (9) to idle governor sliding sleeve (20) is moved axially. The
spring (12) and auxiliary idle spring (14). Both springs sliding sleeve does not move except in the idle, full-
are leaf springs. load torque-control, and speed-regulation breakaway
ranges. The fuel delivery quantity needed for the
Speed-sensing machanism, stage 2 required engine torque is selected by the actuator-
(until full-load speed regulation) mechanism control lever.
After completion of idle-speed sleeve travel, the force The guide lever (9) is movably connected at pivot point
path is from governor sliding sleeve (20) through B with the governor sliding sleeve. In addition, guide
torque-control spring retainer (18) and tensioning lever lever and tensioning lever (16) also pivot at point A.
(16) to governor spring (17).
YAD1FAD0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-6 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAE0
Cold-start setting (only the components concerned in the governing process shown.)
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-7
YAD1FAF0
Idle-speed setting.
(only the components concerned in the governing process are shown)
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-8 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAG0
Full-load setting
(only the components concerned in the governing process are shown)
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-9
Stopping the engine As a result, the diaphragm of the vacuum unit is pulled
When Stop (shutoff) lever (1) is moved by hand, stop against the compression spring.
lever (3) shifts control rack (4) to the Stop (shutoff) The vacuum unit (6) is connected with a stop lever
position. The fuel supply is interrupted and the engine (2r). This lever pivots around the fulcrum “D” pulling
stops. A pneumatic shutoff device can also be used the control rod of the injection pump into the “stop
for engine switchoff. position”. The bypass spring of the fulcrum lever is
overcome in this process. Via the emergency stop lever
Switching off (2s) the control rod can likewise be pulled into “stop
The vacuum unit (6) is connected to vacuum from the position” on the outside of the governor.
vacuum pump via the glow starter switch of the vehicle.
YAD1FAM0
a Start
b Stop
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-10 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAJ0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-11
PNEUMATIC IDLE SPEED the aneroid capsule’s diaphragm which in turn shifts
a sliding bolt to change the pretension on the idle
INCREASE (PLA) spring. The control rack now moves towards “increased
Application fuel quantity” via the governor linkage and the control
rack.
The injected fuel quantity needed by a diesel engine
at idle decreases along with increasing engine Operation
temperature. Coolant temparature <0°c
When the engine is cold, the temperature-dependent The thermovalve is open. The vacuum of approx. 700
idle-speed increase fitted to the RSF governor raises mbar reaches the vacuum unit idle speed increase via
the idle speed accordingly, there by improving the the thermovalve. The idle speed is increased by approx
engine’s warm-up behaviour. It also prevents the cold 100/min. The choke in the ventilation filter causes a
engine stalling when additional loads are switched, pressure loss of approx 100 mbar.
such as power-assisted steering, air-conditioner, etc.
The PLA ceases to function above a certain temperature. Coolant temperature >0°c
The thermovalve is closed. Atmospheric pressure
Design and Function reaches the vacuum unit through the choke in the
Depending upon temperature, pressure is applied to ventilation filter. The speed increase is cancelled.
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-12 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
PNEUMATIC SHUT-OFF DEVICE This device can only be installed on vehicle which are
equipped with a vacuum pump.
(PNAB)
To shut off the engine, the key in the steering lock is
turned to “stop”. This applies vacuum to the shut-off
device diaphragm which pulls the control rack to the
stop setting.
YAD1FAK0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-13
YAD1FAM0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-14 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-15
COMPONENT LOCATOR
FUEL INJECTION PUMP
YAD1FAN0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-16 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FAP0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-17
YAD1FAQ0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-18 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Tools Required
001 589 73 21 00 Vacuum Pump
201 589 13 21 00 Vacuum Tester
667 589 00 21 00 TDC pulse generator
Commercial Tools
Tester Connection
YAD1FAR0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-19
Vacuum >
= 500 mbar?
YES NO
YES NO
YAD1FAT0
Stop the engine and seal the air admission line with
plug (arrow). Connect the vacuum pump to line to
thermovalve and pressurize the line with vacuum.
YES NO
YES NO
Faulty thermovalve
YAD1FAV0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-20 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YES NO
Go to test step 2.
Test step 2
Connect vacuum pump (14) with Y adapter to PLA
vacuum unit (5). Run the engine at idle speed.
YES NO
Faulty thermovalve.
Defective filter with
YAD1FAS0 restriction.
YES NO
YAD1FAW0 OK
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-21
YAD1FAX0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-22 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Tools Required
201 589 13 21 00 Vacuum Tester
1. After fully warming up the engine, turn the ignition
switch to ‘LOCK’ position.
2. Disconnect the suction (7) line from vacuum pump.
3. Connect the vacuum teater 201 589 13 21 00 (8)
to suction line (7) and apply vacuum of 400 + 50
mbar.
Permissible loss of 6 mbar / min
vacuum
If a vacuum drop is more than sperified value,
YAD1FAY0
check the engine shut-off valve or vacuum unit.
YAD1FB00
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-23
Commercial Tool
Tools Required
001 589 73 21 00 Vacuum Pump
667 589 00 73 21 TDC Pulse Generator
Adjustment Procedure
1. Connect the digital tester (1) and TDC pulse
generator 667 589 02 21 00 (11).
2. Run the engine and warm up the coolant to
60~80°C.
YAD1FB10
YAD1FDV0
YAD1FB20
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-24 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FB30
YAD1FB40
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-25
YAD1FB50
2. Insert the plastic hose (5) and put the end into the
measuring beaker (6).
YAD1FB60
YAD1FB70
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-26 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FB80
1 Fuel Filter Housing 5 Tester ............................ At Idle Speed > 0.3 bar
2 Fuel Line ......................................... At Full Load > 0.5 bar
3 Seal ........................................................ Replace 6 Fuel Injection Pump
4 Bolt ........................................... 13 N•m (10 lb-ft) 7 Fuel Pump
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-27
Tools Required
617 589 04 21 00 Tester
YAD1FB90
YAD1FBW0
YAD1FBA0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-28 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FBB0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-29
Tools Required
000 589 14 27 00 Fuel Injection Nozzle Tester
Notice: When testing the injection nozzle, do not place
your hand into the spray of a nozzle. The spray will
penetrate deep into the skin and destroy the tissue.
YAD1FBD0
• Poor
The spray pattern shows split, too wide and
stringy.
(Repair the fuel injection nozzle)
YAD1FBE0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-30 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
6. Leak test
YAD1FBC0
Slowly operate the hand lever at the tester until
get a pressure of approx. 90 bar. Maintain this
pressure for more than 20 seconds and within this
period no drop of fuel should build up at the nozzle
tip.
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-31
YAD1FBF0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-32 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FBG0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-33
Tools Required
617 589 08 21 00 Position Sensor
Test Procedure
1. Remove the screw plug (5) and seal (4) and collect
oil in a suitable vessel.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 30 N•m (22 lb-ft)
YAD1FBH0
YAD1FBJ0
YAD1BC10
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-34 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FBF0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-35
YAD1FBK0
Service Data
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-36 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Tools Required
617 589 09 21 00 Rl Adapter
617 589 10 21 00 RI Sensor
667 589 00 21 00 TDC Pulse Generator
Commercial Tools
Item Tools
Digital Tester With Pluse Generator Bosch, MOT 001.03
Hartmann & Braun. EOMT3
Without Pulse Generator Bosch, ETD 019.00
Sun, DIT 9000
ALV, Diesel - Tester 875
Test Procedure
1. Remove the screw plug (7) and seal (8) collect oil
in a suitable vessel.
YAD1FBL0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-37
YAD1FBN0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-38 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Tools Required
617 589 08 21 00 Position Sensor
Adjustment Procedure
1. Position the No. 1 cylinder at ATDC 15°
Notice: Do not rotate the engine in opposite
0 T 10 20 30 40 direction of engine rotation.
YAD1BC10
YAD1FBP0
YAD1FBQ0
YAD1FBR0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-39
YAD1FBS0
Service Data
Tools Required
617 589 09 21 00 Rl Adaptor
617 589 10 21 00 RI Sensor
667 589 00 21 00 TDC Pulse Generator
Commercial Tools
Item Tools
Digital Tester With Pulse Generator Bosch, MOT 001.03
Hartmann & Braun, EOMT3
Without Pulse Generator Bosch, ETD 019.00
Sun, DIT 9000
ALV, Diesel - Tester 875
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-40 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Adjustment Procedure
1. Remove the bolt (3) at the supporting bracket.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
YAD1FBT0
YAD1FBU0
YAD1FBV0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-41
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
VACUUM PUMP
Preceding Work: Removal the poly V-belt
YAD1FBX0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-42 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FBY0
YAD1FBZ0
YAD1FC00
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-43
YAD1FC10
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-44 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL PUMP
YAD1FC20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-45
YAD1FC30
YAD1FC40
YAD1FC50
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-46 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
INJECTION NOZZLES
YAD1FC60
1 Fuel Injection Nozzle . 35 - 40N•m (26 - 30 lb-ft) 4 Nozzle Washer ..................................... Replace
2 Fuel Return Hose 5 Fuel Injection Pipe ................... 18 N•m (13 lb-ft)
3 Plug
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-47
Tools Required
001 589 65 09 00 Serration Wrench
YAD1BFC70
YAD1BFC80
YAD1BCU0
YAD1BFC90
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-48 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FCA0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-49
Tools Required
000 589 00 68 00 Cleaning Set
Repair Procedure
1. Clamp the nozzle holder (1) in a vice and remove
the nozzle tensioning nut (8).
Notice: Use protective jaws for clamping.
YAD1FCB0
YAD1FCC0
YAD1FCD0
YAD1FCE0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-50 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-51
YAD1FCF0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-52 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
Tools Required
116 589 02 34 00 Threaded Bolt
116 589 20 33 00 Sliding Hammer
601 589 00 08 00 Flange
601 589 05 21 00 Locking Screw
667 589 04 63 00 Retaining Plate
YAD1FCG0
YAD1FCH0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-53
0 T 10 20 30 40
YAD1BC10
5. Remove the plug (6) and seal (5) from the fuel
injection pump and collect oil in a suitable vessel.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 30 N•m (22 lb-ft)
YAD1FCJ0
YAD1FCK0
YAD1BC20
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-54 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FCL0
YAD1FCM0
YAD1FCN0
YAD1FCP0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-55
YAD1FCQ0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-56 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FCR0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-57
YAD1FCS0
YAD1FCT0
YAD1FCU0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-58 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FCV0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-59
Tools Required
000 589 77 03 00 Box Wrench Insert
601 589 00 08 00 Flange
601 589 05 21 00 Locking Screw
601 589 05 14 00 Assembly Cage
Removal Procedure
1. Position the no.1 cylinder at 15° ATDC.
Notice: Do not rotate the engine in opposition
direction of engine rotation.
YAD1BC10
YAD1FCW0
YAD1FCX0
YAD1FCY0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-60 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FCZ0
YAD1FD00
12. Remove the bolt (12) and pull off the washer (11).
YAD1FD10
13. Remove the bolt (22) and pull off the square nut
(28).
14. Pull out the fuel injection pump (25) and seal (23).
YAD1FD20
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-61
Installation Procedure
1. Remove the screw plug (27) and seal (26) and
collect oil in a vessel.
YAD1FD30
YAD1FD40
YAD1FD50
0 T 10 20 30 40
YAD1BC10
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-62 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
5. Coat the new seal (23) with engine oil and install
it.
6. Insert the fuel injection pump (25) and tighten the
bolts (22).
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
YAD1FD60
YAD1FD70
YAD1FD80
YAD1FD90
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-63
YAD1FDA0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-64 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
FUEL TANK
YAD1FDB0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-65
YAD1FDC0
YAD1FDD0
YAD1FDE0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-66 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Fuel Distribution Type Individual Injection Type (Same Number of Cylinder and Plunger)
Number of Cylinders 5 Cylinder
Mounting Type End Flange Mounting
Drive Type Inside Chain Connected with Camshaft
Flange Stroke 7 mm
Flange Outside Diameter 5.5 mm
Rack Movement 21 mm
Max. Speed 2,500 rpm
Injected Fuel Quantity / Stroke 35 mm3 / Stroke
Lubrication Type Sump Lubrication Type (Connected with Engine Oil Passage)
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-67
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-68 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
YAD1FDF0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-69
000 589 14 27 00
000 589 00 68 00
Fuel Injection Nozzle
Cleaning Set
Tester
YAD1FDU0 YAD1FDK0
YAD1FDT0 YAD1BKB0
YAD1A190 YAD1BLH0
YAD1B580 YAD1FDG0
SSANGYONG Y200
1F3-70 DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS
601 589 05 21 00
601 589 05 14 00
Locking Sensor
Assembly Cage
YAD1FDS0 YAD1FDQ0
610 589 00 08 00
617 589 00 21 00
Flange
Ri Sensor
YAD1FDP0 YAD1FDN0
617 589 08 21 01
617 589 04 21 00
Micro Switch Setting
Tester
Device
YAD1FDJ0 YAD1FDL0
617 589 08 21 00
617 589 09 21 00
Position Sensor
Ri Adapter
YAD1FDL0 YAD1FDM0
SSANGYONG Y200
DIESEL ENGINE CONTROLS 1F3-71
667 589 04 63 00
667 589 00 21 00
Retaining Plate
TDC Pulse Generator
YAD1FDH0 YAD1FDR0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 2C
FRONT SUSPENSION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 2C-2 Repair Instructions ................................................ 2C-9
Front Suspension ................................................. 2C-2 On-vehicle Service ............................................... 2C-9
Specifications ...................................................... 2C-4 Stabilizer ........................................................... 2C-11
Component Locator ............................................. 2C-5 Shock Absorber Assembly ................................ 2C-12
Front Suspension Assembly ................................. 2C-5 Upper/Lower Arm Assembly .............................. 2C-14
Cross-Sectional View ........................................... 2C-6 Unit Repair .......................................................... 2C-16
Suspension Assembly ......................................... 2C-6 Front Coil Spring ................................................ 2C-16
Shock Absorber ................................................... 2C-7 Hub and Bearing ............................................... 2C-18
Diagnostic Information and Procedures ................ 2C-8 Special Tool and Equipment.............................. 2C-20
Special Tools Table ........................................... 2C-20
2C-2 FRONT SUSPENSION
YAD2C010
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-3
YAD2C040
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-4 FRONT SUSPENSION
SPECIFICATIONS
Application Specification
Suspension System Double Wishbone
Spring Type Coil spring
Shock Absorber Telescopic Double Tube Type(GAS)
Stabilizer Torsion Bar Type
Wheel Alignment Toe-In 2 ± 2 mm
Camber 0° ± 30´ (Both side difference must be below 30´)
Caster 2° 45 ± 30´ (Both side difference must be below 30´)
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-5
COMPONENT LOCATOR
FRONT SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
YAD2E050
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-6 FRONT SUSPENSION
CROSS-SECTIONAL VIEW
SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
YAD2C060
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-7
SHOCK ABSORBER
YAD2C070
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-8 FRONT SUSPENSION
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-9
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
YAD2C080
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-10 FRONT SUSPENSION
1 Nut 15 Nut
2 Nut 16 Bolt
3 Washer 17 Bolt
4 Rubber 18 Bolt
5 Bushing 19 Bushing
6 Upper Spring Sheet 20 Nut
7 Rubber 21 Upper Arm
8 Spring Sheet Rubber 22 Nut
9 Boot 23 Bushing
10 Boot 24 Washer
11 Spring 25 Bolt
12 Shock Absorber 26 Lower Arm
13 Lower Spring Sheet 27 Bushing
14 Yoke 28 Bushing
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-11
STABILIZER
Removal Procedure
YAD2C090
YAD2C100
YAD2C110
Installation Procedure
1. Install the front stabilizer bar to the frame and
tighten manually the stabilizer bar mounting cap
bolt. It allows the bar link to install to it’s original
position.
Installation Notice
60 - 80 N•m
Tightening Torque
(44 - 59 lb-ft)
YAD2C120
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-12 FRONT SUSPENSION
YAD2C130
YAD2C140
YAD2C150
YAD2C160
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-13
YAD2C170
YAD2C180
Installation Procedure
1. Install the coil spring(shock absorber) assembly
and the yoke to the body. And then install the
lower shock absorber into the yoke hole and insert
the upper shock absorber to bolt hole by
tightening the nut manually.
Installation Notice
40 - 60 N•m
Tightening Torque
(30 - 44 lb-ft)
YAD2C190
YAD2C200
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-14 FRONT SUSPENSION
YAD2C210
YAD2C230
YAD2C240
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-15
YAD2C250
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lower arm to the frame bracket and
tighten the mounting bolt and nut as the specified
torque.
Notice :
• Tighten the bolt on the direction from rear side
to front side of the vehicle.
• Fix the bolt center with the bracket indication.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 160 - 170 N•m
YAD2C260
YAD2C270
YAD2C280
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-16 FRONT SUSPENSION
UNIT REPAIR
FRONT COIL SPRING
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the front coil spring assembly.
2. Fix the special tool to the coil spring assembly as
shown and compress the coil spring.
Notice: Install the special tool to the coil spring
tightly not to separate it during work and be careful
to spring end portion should look forward to the
person during compressing the coil spring.
YAD2C290
YAD2C300
YAD2C310
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-17
Installation Procedure
1. Compress the coil spring as the specified torque
and install the related components. And then
tighten the lock nut.
Installation Notice
Length at compression 334 N•m
Tightening torque of 25 - 40 N•m
lock nut (18 - 30 lb-ft)
YAD2C330
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-18 FRONT SUSPENSION
YAD2C340
YAD2C350
YAD2C360
YAD2C370
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT SUSPENSION 2C-19
Notice:
• Install the outer bearing race using the front
outer bearing race installer and handle.
YAD2C380
YAD2C390
SSANGYONG Y200
2C-20 FRONT SUSPENSION
YAD2C400 YAD2C440
YAD2C410 YAD2C450
YAD2C420 YAD2C460
YAD2C430 YAD2C470
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 2D
REAR SUSPENSION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 2D-2 Wheel Bearing End Play ...................................... 2D-7
Rear Suspension ................................................. 2D-2 Wheel Bearing Free load ...................................... 2D-7
Specifications ...................................................... 2D-3 Repair Instructions ................................................ 2D-8
Component Locator ............................................. 2D-4 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 2D-8
Rear Suspension Assembly ................................. 2D-4 Rear Suspension Assembly ................................. 2D-9
Shock Absorber ................................................... 2D-5 Special Tools and Equipment ............................ 2D-16
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 2D-6 Special Tools Table ............................................ 2D-16
Rear Suspension ................................................. 2D-6
2D-2 REAR SUSPENSION
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-3
SPECIFICATIONS
Suspension Type 5 Links (Two Upper Arm, Two Lower Arm, One Lateral Rod)
Spring Type Coil Spring
Stabilizer Type Torsion Bar Type
Shock Absorber Type Telescopic Double Tube Type
Max. Length 495 mm
Min. Length 308 mm
Engine Type GSL 3.2, DSL(A/T) DSL(M/T)
Coil O.D. 13.1 mm 13.0 mm
Coil I.D(A) Ø 114 mm Ø 114 mm
Free-load Height(B) 405.7 mm 386.8 mm
Compression Height(C) 260.0 mm 250.0 mm
O.D(D) Ø 127.1 mm Ø 127.0 mm
YAD2D020 Constant 2.45 ± 5% 2.45 ± 5%
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-4 REAR SUSPENSION
COMPONENT LOCATOR
REAR SUSPANSION ASSEMBLY
YAD2D030
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-5
SHOCK ABSORBER
YAD2D040
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-6 REAR SUSPENSION
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-7
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-8 REAR SUSPENSION
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
YAD2D070
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-9
YAD2D080
YAD2D090
YAD2D100
YAD2D110
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-10 REAR SUSPENSION
YAD2D120
YAD2D130
YAD2D140
YAD2D150
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-11
YAD2D160
10. Remove the upper bolt and nut retaining the axle
and remove the upper arm.
YAD2D170
YAD2D180
YAD2D180
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-12 REAR SUSPENSION
13. Loosen the brake & hose and remove the spring
by pushing to incline the rear axle.
YAD2D190
YAD2D200
Installation Procedure
1. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
2. Be careful to the installation direction of the coil
spring to install the spring correctly.
Notice:
1. Be careful that the diameter of the upper coil
spring is longer than that of the lower’s.
2. Verify that the coil spring should be installed
onto the spring seat of the axle and body(frame)
correctly.
YAD2D210
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-13
Tightening Length : 6 - 9 mm
Tightening Torque : 50 - 65 N•m
Lower side (2)
(37 - 48 lb-ft)
YAD2D220
YAD2D230
YAD2D240
YAD2D250
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-14 REAR SUSPENSION
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 38 N•m (28 lb-ft)
Tightening Length(A) 7 - 12 mm
YAD2D260
YAD2D270
YAD2D280
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR SUSPENSION 2D-15
YAD2D290
SSANGYONG Y200
2D-16 REAR SUSPENSION
YAD2D300 YAD2D310
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 2E
YAD2E010
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-3
Convention for Radial Tire The Relation Between Load and Tire
P 225 / 75 R - 15 102 T
Max Speed :
190 km/h
Load Index :
850 kg
Radial Tire
YAD2E030 YAD2E060
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-4 TIRES AND WHEELS
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
The first responsibility of engineering is to design safe
steering and suspension systems. Each component
must be strong enough to with stand and absorb
extreme punishment. Both the steering system and
the front and the rear suspension must function YAD2E080
geometrically with the body mass.
The steering and suspension systems require that the Camber is the tilting of the top of the tire from the
front wheels self-return and that the tire rolling effort vertical when viewed from the front of the vehicle. When
and the road friction be held to a negligible force in the tires tilt outward, the camber is positive. When the
order to allow the customer to direct the vehicle with tires tilt inward, the camber is negative. The camber
the least effort and the most comfort. angle is measured in degrees from the vertical. Camber
influnces both directional control and tire wear.
A complete wheel alignment check should include
measurements of the rear toe and camber. If the vehicle has too much positive camber, the
outside shoulder of the tire will wear. If the vehicle has
Toe-in too much negative camber, the inside shoulder of the
tire will wear. Camber is measured in degrees and is
not adjustable.
Caster
YAD2E070
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-5
SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Size Aluminum Type 7JJ x 16
Steel Type 6.5JJ x 16
Wheel Nut Tightening Aluminum Wheel 8 - 12 kgf.m
Torque Steel Wheel 11 - 13 kgf.m
Tire Type Radial Tire Radial Tire
Inflation Pressure (psi) P225/75R15 30 psi
P235/70R16 30 psi
P255/65R16 30 psi
Wheel Alignment Toe-in 2 ± 2 mm
Camber 0° ± 30’ (Below 30' the difference between right and left)
Caster 2° 45 ± 30’ (Below 30' the difference between right and left)
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-6 TIRES AND WHEELS
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-7
GENERAL INSPECTION
INSPECTION THE APPEARANCE
YAD2E100 YAD2E110
YAD2E120 YAD2E130
YAD2E140 YAD2E150
YAD2E160 YAD2E110
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-8 TIRES AND WHEELS
YAD2E170 YAD2E180
YAD2E190 YAD2E200
Check pre-load
YAD2E210
Faulty shock absorber Check
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-9
GENERAL INSPECTION
Inspection Tread
Inspect the tread condition on the tire surface and
various damages resulting from the foreign material,
crack, stone or nail etc. If there is any damage in the
tire, repair or replace it.
Tire Wear
• Measure the depth of the tire tread. If the depth
of the tread is below the specified value, replace
the tire.
Limit of the Tread Wear 1.6 mm (0.06 in.)
YAD2E230
YAD2E240
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-10 TIRES AND WHEELS
Balance Weight
10 g 20 g 30 g 40 g 50 g 60 g
0.4 oz 0.7 oz 1.10 oz 1.40 oz 1.80 oz 2.10 oz
YAD2E270
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-11
Rotation Tires
• Front and rear tires perform different jobs and can
wear differently depending on the tires of road
driven, driving condition, etc.
The front tires will wear faster than the rear ones.
To avoid uneven wear of tires and to prolong tire
life, inspect and rotate the tires every 5,000 km
(3,100 miles). After rotating the tires, adjust the tire
inflation pressures and be sure to check wheel nuts
tightness.
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-12 TIRES AND WHEELS
COMPONENT LOCATOR
TIRE AND WHEEL ASSEMBLY
YAD2E290
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-13
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
GENERAL TIRE
1. Remove the wheel cap.
YAD2E300
YAD2E310
YAD2E320
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-14 TIRES AND WHEELS
General Instruction
• Clean the contact surface between the wheel and
the hub.
• Do not apply oil or grease to the nuts and bolts
(cause the wheel to work loose).
3 1
5
• Raise the tires 3 cm off the ground using the
6 jacket.
2 4 • Tighten the wheel nuts diagonally as shown.
SPARE TIRE
Removal Procedure
1. Prepare the spare tire handle and the wheel nut
wrench.
2 Install the handle through the hole at the rear side
of the vehicle.
3 Install the wheel nut wrench at the end of the
handle.
4 Turn the wheel nut wrench counterclockwise until
the spare tire takes down the ground.
YAD2E340
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-15
YAD2E360
YAD2E370
YAD2E380
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-16 TIRES AND WHEELS
YAD2E390
YAD2E400
YAD2E410
MAINTENANCE
1. Check any damage the rim and replace as needed.
Notice:
• Do not repair the rim as welding or soldering.
• Replace the new valve as replaces new tire.
SSANGYONG Y200
TIRES AND WHEELS 2E-17
INSTALLATION
1. Clean the rust, damaged rubber and dust, etc on
the rim’s surface with the brush.
YAD2E420
YAD2E430
YAD2E440
YAD2E450
SSANGYONG Y200
2E-18 TIRES AND WHEELS
Specification of the
2.1 kg•cm2 (30 psi)
tire pressure
YAD2E460
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 3A
FRONT AXLE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ............... 3A-2 Front Axle Shaft .............................................. 3A-11
Front Axle Housing Assembly ......................... 3A-2 Vacuum Line ................................................... 3A-18
Axle Shaft Assembly ........................................ 3A-3 Axle Housing .................................................. 3A-19
Specifications ................................................... 3A-4 Unit Repair ....................................................... 3A-20
Diagnosis Information and Procedures .......... 3A-5 Axle Housing Assembly ................................. 3A-20
Component Locator ......................................... 3A-6 Differential Joint Assembly ............................ 3A-26
Front Axle Shaft ................................................ 3A-6 Wheel Joint Assembly ................................... 3A-28
Front Axle Housing ........................................... 3A-7 Special Tools And Equipment ....................... 3A-30
Vacuum Line ................................................... 3A-10 Special Tools Table ........................................ 3A-30
Maintenance and Repair .................................3A-11
On-Vehicle Service ............................................ 3A-11
3A-2 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A020
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-3
YAD3A030
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-4 FRONT AXLE
SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-5
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-6 FRONT AXLE
COMPONENT LOCATOR
FRONT AXLE SHAFT
YAD3A040
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-7
YAD3A330
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-8 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A380
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-9
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-10 FRONT AXLE
VACUUM LINE
YAD3A300
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-11
YAD3A050
YAD3A060
YAD3A070
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-12 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A080
YAD3A090
YAD3A100
YAD3A110
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-13
YAD3A120
YAD3A130
YAD3A140
YAD3A150
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-14 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A160
YAD3A170
YAD3A180
YAD3A190
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-15
Installation
Clean all the parts. Check O-ring, snap ring for the
wear and damage.
If damaged, replace them with new ones.
1. Inser t the axle shaft to the axle housing. Be sure
to insert the axle shaft to the housing.
Notice: When you insert the axle shaft, be careful
not to damage the boots.
YAD3A170
YAD3A210
YAD3A220
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-16 FRONT AXLE
• Install the front disc and tighten the hub nut &
washer. When you install then, align the hub
nut-washer to the shaft end and tighten the hub
nut as the specified torque. After bending the
groove part of shaft, apply the painting and
grease to the groove part.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 250 - 350 N•m
YAD3A230
YAD3A250
50 - 60 N•m
Tightening torque
(37 - 44 lb-ft)
YAD3A260
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-17
YAD3A270
Installation Notice
35 - 45 N•m
Tightening torque
(26 - 33 lb-ft)
YAD3A280
YAD3A290
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-18 FRONT AXLE
VACUUM LINE
Removal/Installation
1. Be careful not to change the direction of valve
when connecting the check valve(11) with each
hose.
YAD3A310
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-19
AXLE HOUSING
Removal/Installation
1. Remove the propeller shaft from the front axle input
shaft.
Installation Notice
81 - 89 N•m
Tightening Torque
(60 - 66 lb-ft)
YAD3A340
YAD3A360
YAD3A370
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-20 FRONT AXLE
UNIT REPAIR
;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;
AXLE HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Disassembly
;;;;;;;
1. Remove the drain plug and drain the oil and than
reinstall the drain plug.
Installation Notice
YAD3A400
YAD3A410
YAD3A420
YAD3A430
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-21
YAD3A440
YAD3A450
YAD3A460
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-22 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A470
2. Abnormal Contact
YAD3A480 YAD3A490
YAD3A500 YAD3A510
YAD3A520 YAD3A530
YAD3A540 YAD3A550
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-23
Assembly
1. Clean all parts and check the followings.
• Check the ring gear, drive pinion for wear and
damage. If damaged, replace it as a set.
• Check the bearing for sticks, wear, noise and
turning resistance.
• Check the side gear, pinion, pinion shaft and
thrust washer for wear and damage.
• Check the differential carrier for crack and wear
(bearing contact surface). Check the gear case
for crack.
YAD3A560
YAD3A570
YAD3A580
YAD3A590
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-24 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A600
YAD3A610
YAD3A620
YAD3A630
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-25
YAD3A640
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-26 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A650
YAD3A660
YAD3A670
YAD3A680
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-27
Inspection
1. Check the shaft spline for the wear and damage.
2. Check the leakage by the boot crack, tears.
3. Check the bending of shaft.
Notice: if the defect happens in one shaft, because
the other is damaged, exchange the both.
YAD3A690
Assembly
1. Assembly should follow the dismantlement in the
reverse order.
2. Apply the specified grease to the joint housing.
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-28 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A710
YAD3A720
YAD3A730
Assembly
1. Assembly should follow the disassembly
procedure in the reverse order.
2. Install the joint assembly.
• Put the joint assembly in drive axle shaft to
spread out the circlip opening slightly.
1 Insert (-) driver into the circlip opening to spread
out the circlip.
2 Put the joint assembly in circlip home with the
circlip spread out.
YAD3A740
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT AXLE 3A-29
YAD3A750
YAD3A760
SSANGYONG Y200
3A-30 FRONT AXLE
YAD3A770 YAD3A780
YAD3A790
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 3C
PROPELLER SHAFT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ..................... 3C-2 Maintenance and Repair ..................................... 3C-6
Specifications ...................................................... 3C-2 On-Vehicle Service ................................................. 3C-6
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 3C-3 Propeller Shaft Assembly ..................................... 3C-6
Component Locator ............................................ 3C-4 Unit Repair ............................................................ 3C-9
Cross Sectional View ........................................... 3C-4 Propeller Shaft ..................................................... 3C-9
Propeller Shaft Assembly ..................................... 3C-5
3C-2 PROPELLER SHAFT
YAD3C010
SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
PROPELLER SHAFT 3C-3
SSANGYONG Y200
3C-4 PROPELLER SHAFT
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CROSS SECTIONAL VIEW
YAD3C020
SSANGYONG Y200
PROPELLER SHAFT 3C-5
YAD3C030
SSANGYONG Y200
3C-6 PROPELLER SHAFT
YAD3C040
YAD3C050
YAD3C060
SSANGYONG Y200
PROPELLER SHAFT 3C-7
YAD3C070
YAD3C080
Installation
1. Check the disassembled parts visually.
2. Align the assembly mark of each propeller shaft.
3. Install the front propeller shaft.
Installation Notice
YAD3C090
YAD3C100
SSANGYONG Y200
3C-8 PROPELLER SHAFT
YAD3C110
SSANGYONG Y200
PROPELLER SHAFT 3C-9
UNIT REPAIR
PROPELLER SHAFT
Disassembly
1. Mark the assembly mark and remove the propeller
shaft.
2. Do alignment mark before separating the spider.
YAD3C120
YAD3C130
YAD3C140
YAD3C150
SSANGYONG Y200
3C-10 PROPELLER SHAFT
YAD3C160
YAD3C170
Inspection
1. Visual Check
Check the disassembled parts for wear and crack.
Replace them if necessary.
2. Spider outer diameter
standard 16.647 mm
Limit 16.668 mm
YAD3C180
YAD3C190
SSANGYONG Y200
PROPELLER SHAFT 3C-11
Limit 0.4 mm
YAD3C200
Assembly
Clean the disassembled parts and replace then if
damaged.
1. Align the alignment marks of the yoke and
assemble the spider, bearing and snap ring.
YAD3C220
SSANGYONG Y200
3C-12 PROPELLER SHAFT
YAD3C230
YAD3C240
YAD3C250
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 3D
REAR AXLE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ............... 3D-2 Maintenance and Repair .................................. 3D-8
Specifications ................................................... 3D-2 On-Vehicle Service .............................................. 3D-8
Diagnostic Information and Procedures ........ 3D-3 Axle Shaft Assembly (With Disc Brake) .......... 3D-8
Component Locator ......................................... 3D-4 Axle Shaft Assembly (With Drum Brake) ...... 3D-11
Rear Axle Assembly ......................................... 3D-4 Rear Axle Housing .......................................... 3D-13
Cross Sectional View ........................................ 3D-5 Unit Repair ....................................................... 3D-18
Rear Axle Shaft Assembly ............................... 3D-6 Axle Assembly ............................................... 3D-18
Differential Gear Assembly ............................ 3D-19
3D-2 REAR AXLE
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-3
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-4 REAR AXLE
COMPONENT LOCATOR
REAR AXLE ASSEMBLY
YAD3D101
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-5
YAD3D020
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-6 REAR AXLE
YAD3D030
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-7
YAD3D150
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-8 REAR AXLE
YAD3D040
YAD3D050
YAD3D060
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-9
YAD3D070
YAD3D080
YAD3D090
YAD3D100
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-10 REAR AXLE
Installation
Clean the detached axle shaft, check the damage or
wear.
1. After checking the spline & shaft of rear axle shaft,
assemble the shaft into the rear axle housing.
YAD3D110
50 - 65 N•m
Tightening torque
(37 - 48 lb-ft)
YAD3D120
4 - 8 N•m
Tightening torque
(35 - 71 lb-in)
YAD3D130
YAD3D140
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-11
YAD3D160
YAD3D170
YAD3D180
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
YAD3D190
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-12 REAR AXLE
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
YAD3D200
Installation
1. Check the rear axle shaft.
2. Insert the rear axle shaft into the axle housing and
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
tighten the fixing nuts of axle shaft flange.
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
Installation Notice
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy Tightening Torque 50 - 65 N•m
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
(37 - 48 lb-ft)
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
YAD3D210
YAD3D220
YAD3D230
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-13
YAD3D240
YAD3D250
YAD3D260
YAD3D270
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-14 REAR AXLE
YAD3D280
YAD3D290
YAD3D300
YAD3D310
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-15
YAD3D320
YAD3D330
YAD3D340
Installation
1. Placing the rear axle housing on the assembly
position, install both coil springs.
YAD3D350
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-16 REAR AXLE
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 150 - 180 N•m
YAD3D370
YAD3D380
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-17
Inspection
1. Check the shaft spline for the wear and damage.
YAD3D400
YAD3D410
YAD3D420
YAD3D430
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-18 REAR AXLE
UNIT REPAIR
AXLE ASSEMBLY
YAD3D440
1 Drive Pinion Lock Nut .................. 240 - 310 N•m 17 Bolt ................................................. 87 - 124 N•m
2 Washer 18 Bearing
3 Companion Flange 19 Shim
4 Pinion Oil Seal 20 Ring Gear
5 Bearing Slinger 21 Shaft Lock Pin
6 Bearing 22 Differential Case
7 Shim 23 Ring Gear Mounting Bolt ................. 75 - 90 N•m
8 Shim 24 Thrust Washer
9 Bearing Cup 25 Differential Pinion
10 Breather Nipple 26 Thrust Washer
11 Rear Axle Housing 27 Side Gear
12 Oil Drain Plug ................................... 28 - 42 N•m 28 Differential Shaft
13 Shim 29 Housing Cover
14 Bearing 30 Bolt ................................................... 38 - 46 N•m
15 Drive Pinion 31 Oil Filler Plug ................................... 28 - 42 N•m
16 Bearing Cap
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-19
YAD3D450
YAD3D460
YAD3D470
YAD3D480
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-20 REAR AXLE
YAD3D490
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-21
YAD3D500
2. Abnormal contact
YAD3D510 YAD3D520
B
A
YAD3D530 YAD3D540
YAD3D550 YAD3D560
YAD3D570 YAD3D580
SSANGYONG Y200
3D-22 REAR AXLE
Assembly
1. Clean all parts and check the followings.
• Check the ring gear, drive pinion for wear and
damage. If damaged, replace it as a set.
• Check the bearing for sticks, wear, noise and
turning resistance.
• Check the side gear, pinion, pinion shaft and
thrust washer for wear and damage.
• Check the differential carrier for crack and wear
(bearing contact surface). Check the gear case
for crack.
YAD3D590
YAD3D600
YAD3D610
YAD3D620
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR AXLE 3D-23
YAD3D630
YAD3D640
YAD3D650
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 4A
BRAKE SYSTEM
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 4A-2 Component Locator ........................................... 4A-11
Braking System Testing ....................................... 4A-2 Hydraulic Line .................................................... 4A-11
Hydraulic Brake System ...................................... 4A-2 Brake System (W/CBS) ...................................... 4A-12
Brake Pedal ......................................................... 4A-2 Master Cylinder and Booster .............................. 4A-13
Master Cylinder ................................................... 4A-2 Repair Instructions .............................................. 4A-14
Brake Booster ..................................................... 4A-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 4A-14
Specifications ...................................................... 4A-4 Vacuum Hose .................................................... 4A-14
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 4A-5 Brake Oil Level Switch ....................................... 4A-15
Maintenance and Repair ..................................... 4A-6 Brake Fluid Reservoir ......................................... 4A-16
Bleeding the Brakes ............................................ 4A-6 Master Cylinder ................................................. 4A-17
Brake Pedal ......................................................... 4A-7 Brake Booster ................................................... 4A-19
Stoplamp Switch .................................................. 4A-8 Stoplamp Switch ................................................ 4A-20
Brake Booster Functional Check ........................... 4A-9 Brake Pedal ....................................................... 4A-20
LCRV (Load Conscious Reducing Valve) .............. 4A-9 Brake Hose & Pipe ............................................ 4A-21
LCRV (Load Conscious Reducing Valve) ............ 4A-24
4A-2 BRAKE SYSTEM
• Tires having unequal contact and grip of the road MASTER CYLINDER
will cause unequal braking. Tires must be equally
inflated and the tread pattern of the right and the
left tires must be approximately equal.
• Unequal loading of the vehicle can affect the brake
performance since the most heavily loaded wheels
require more braking power and thus more braking
effort than the others.
• Misalignment of the wheels, particularly conditions
of excessive camber and caster, will cause the
brakes to pull to one side.
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-3
YAD4A040
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-4 BRAKE SYSTEM
SPECIFICATIONS
Thickness of
- 10 mm - ←
Brake Pad
Thickness of
- 24 mm - ←
Disc Plate
Rear Brake Type Drum Type Solid Disc Drum Type ←
I.D of Drum Ø 254 mm - Ø 254 -
Leading End Leading End
Shoe Type - -
Trailing Type Trailing Type
Lining 55 x 243 x 5 mm - 55 x 243 -
I.D. of Wheel
Cylinder Ø 23.87 mm - Ø 23.81 mm -
I.D. of Caliper
- Ø 42.9 mm - Ø 42 mm
Cylinder
Thickness of
- 10 mm - 10 mm
Brake Pad
Thickness of
- 10.4 mm - 10.4 mm
Disc Plate
Parking Brake Type Rear Wheel Internal Expansion
Type Mechanical
Brake Fluid Spec. DOT4 or DOT3
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-5
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-6 BRAKE SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-7
BRAKE PEDAL
Pedal Travel Check
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the pedal three times.
3. With the brake depressed by about 30 kg (66.15 lb)
load, measure the clearance between the pedal
pad and the lower dash panel.
4. Check pad or shoe wear, any leak for the brake
system when the measured value is below the
specified value.
5. If the pedal height is not in the specified value,
YAD4A110
loosen the lock nut of the brake booster push rod
and adjust the push rod length.
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-8 BRAKE SYSTEM
Pedal Height
Specification (A) 177 mm (From the floor mat)
YAD4A120
YAD4A140
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-9
YAD4A150
YAD4A160
YAD4A170
YAD4A180
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-10 BRAKE SYSTEM
Setting Method
1. Install the connecting rod (a) to the No.1 hole.
2. Adjust the clearance “X” to be 0mm and tighten
the bolt (c) using the lock nut (b).
Installation Notice
14 - 18 N•m
Tightening Torque
(10 - 13 lb-ft)
Inspection
When it occurs the malfunction in the LCRV, the sensor
spring, valve body assembly, rear axle or rear spring
may be replaced. For these replacement, the following
inspection should perform;
Notice:
• Fluid leaking from LCRV results from poor valve
open/close or sealing wear caused by the foreign
materials in the LCRV.
• When you change or repair the LCRV, it may affect
the braking performance. Thus, ensure to use the
approved part.
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-11
COMPONENT LOCATOR
HYDRAULIC LINE
YAD4A060
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-12 BRAKE SYSTEM
YAD4A200
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-13
YAD4A210
MANDO
YAD4A220
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-14 BRAKE SYSTEM
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
VACUUM HOSE
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the brake
booster.
YAD4A230
YAD4A240
YAD4A250
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-15
Installation Procedure
1. Install the vacuum hose between the vacuum
pump and the power booster (Diesel Engine).
Tightening Torque
Bracket Mounting 35 - 45 N•m
Bolt (26 - 33 lb-ft)
Union Bolt to Vacuum 35 - 45 N•m
Pump (26 - 33 lb-ft)
YAD4A260
YAD4A270
YAD4A280
YAD4A290
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-16 BRAKE SYSTEM
YAD4A300
YAD4A310
YAD4A320
YAD4A330
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-17
MASTER CYLINDER
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the brake lines from the master
cylinder.
Notice: The brake fluid may damage paintwork, if
spillage onto paintwork, wash with cold water
immediately.
YAD4A340
YAD4A350
YAD4A360
YAD4A370
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-18 BRAKE SYSTEM
YAD4A380
Installation Procedure
1. Install the retainer ring using the snap ring plier.
YAD4A390
YAD4A400
YAD4A410
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-19
BRAKE BOOSTER
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the master cylinder assembly and pull
out the cotter pin from the push rod of the brake
booster.
2. Remove the clevis pin.
YAD4A420
YAD4A430
YAD4A440
Installation Procedure
1. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
2. Bleed the brake system after the installation.
YAD4A450
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-20 BRAKE SYSTEM
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Separate the stoplamp switch from the connector.
YAD4A460
YAD4A470
YAD4A480
BRAKE PEDAL
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Remove the bolts/nuts mounting the brake pedal
and disconnect the cotter pin.
YAD4A490
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-21
YAD4A500
YAD4A510
YAD4A520
YAD4A530
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-22 BRAKE SYSTEM
YAD4A540
YAD4A550
YAD4A560
YAD4A570
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-23
YAD4A580
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear brake hose and tighten the union
bolts.
Tightening Torque 15 - 18 N•m
at the caliper (11 - 13 lb-ft)
Tightening Torque 15 - 19 N•m
at the wheel cylinder (11 - 13 lb-ft)
YAD4A590
YAD4A600
YAD4A610
SSANGYONG Y200
4A-24 BRAKE SYSTEM
YAD4A630
YAD4A640
YAD4A650
SSANGYONG Y200
BRAKE SYSTEM 4A-25
YAD4A660
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 4B
FRONT BRAKE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 4B-2 Component Locator ............................................. 4B-6
Caliper ................................................................ 4B-2 Cross-Sectional View ........................................... 4B-6
Clearance Calibration ........................................... 4B-2 Front Caliper Brake .............................................. 4B-7
Specifications ...................................................... 4B-2 Repair Instructions ................................................ 4B-8
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 4B-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 4B-8
Inspection ............................................................. 4B-4 Front Brake .......................................................... 4B-8
Pad Thickness ..................................................... 4B-4 Brake Pad Replacement .................................... 4B-10
Brake Disc Thickness .......................................... 4B-4 Unit Repair .......................................................... 4B-13
Brake Disc Run Out ............................................. 4B-5 Brake Caliper .................................................... 4B-13
Caliper Housing I.D .............................................. 4B-5
4B-2 FRONT BRAKE
YAD4B010
CLEARANCE CALIBRATION
When the hydraulic pressure is applied to the piston,
the piston moves leftward. The piston seal, which extent
considerable pressure against the piston, moves with
cylinder.
YAD4B020
SPECIFICATIONS
MANDO Delphi Korea
Application Ventilated Disc Type ←
Caliper Cylinder I.D. Ø 60 mm ←
Pad Thickness 10 mm ←
Disc Thickness 24 mm ←
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-3
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-4 FRONT BRAKE
INSPECTION
Clean the dissembled parts and visually check the
followings;
• Wear, rust and damage on the cylinder and piston
• Damage, crack on the caliper body and damage,
wear on the guide pin
• Pad uneven wear and oil contamination
• Boot’s damage and tear
• Disc plate’s scratch and bending
PAD THICKNESS
1. Remove the front wheel.
2. Measure the thickness and replace as needed.
yyyy
;;;;
Thickness Max wear Limit
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
10 mm 2 mm
;;;;;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
yyyyy
YAD4B040
YAD4B050
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-5
YAD4B060
YAD4B070
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-6 FRONT BRAKE
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CROSS-SECTIONAL VIEW
YAD4B030
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-7
YAD4B080
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-8 FRONT BRAKE
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
FRONT BRAKE
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the front wheel and remove the brake hose
from the brake caliper.
Notice: Be carefully to prevent the brake fluid loss
and contamination.
YAD4B090
YAD4B100
YAD4B110
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-9
YAD4B120
YAD4B130
YAD4B140
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-10 FRONT BRAKE
YAD4B150
YAD4B160
YAD4B170 Full-time
YAD4B180 Part-time
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-11
Installation Procedure
1. Install the front brake disc assembly to the knuckle
and fasten the lock nut as specified torque (full-
time 4WD).
YAD4B190
YAD4B200
YAD4B210
YAD4B220
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-12 FRONT BRAKE
YAD4B230
SSANGYONG Y200
FRONT BRAKE 4B-13
UNIT REPAIR
BRAKE CALIPER
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the caliper assembly.
2. Separate the cylinder assembly and carrier.
• Remove the guide rod bolt.
• Separate the cylinder assembly and carrier.
YAD4B240
YAD4B250
YAD4B260
YAD4B270
SSANGYONG Y200
4B-14 FRONT BRAKE
Assembly Procedure
1. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
Notice: Clean all the parts in denatured alcohol or
brake fluid. Dry the parts with unlubricated
compressed air and blow out all the passages in
the housing and the bleeder valve.
Apply the brake fluid on the surface of the piston
and cylinder.
YAD4B290
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 4C
REAR BRAKE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 4C-2 Component Locator ............................................. 4C-9
Drum Brake ......................................................... 4C-2 Drum Brake ......................................................... 4C-9
Wheel Cylinder .................................................... 4C-2 Disc Brake ........................................................ 4C-10
Brake Lining ........................................................ 4C-2 Rerair Instructions .............................................. 4C-11
Disc Brake .......................................................... 4C-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 4C-11
Specifications ...................................................... 4C-3 Disc Brake Assembly ........................................ 4C-11
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 4C-4 Drum Brake Assembly ....................................... 4C-16
Inspection ............................................................. 4C-5 Unit Repair .......................................................... 4C-21
Drum Brake Type................................................. 4C-5 Wheel Cylinder .................................................. 4C-21
Disc Brake Type .................................................. 4C-5 Parking Brake Lever ........................................... 4C-22
Cross Sectional View ........................................... 4C-7
Drum Brake (KDAC) ............................................. 4C-7
Disc Brake .......................................................... 4C-8
4C-2 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C010
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-3
DISC BRAKE
The disc brake uses at front wheel generally and
recently has been using at rear wheel. The floating
type caliper disc brake installed by this vehicle installs
only brake cylinder per caliper at one side. When the
master cylinder generates the hydraulic pressure, the
piston pushes the pad in order to compress to the
disc and at this time, the caliper is moved by this
reaction resulted in pushing the pad at the other side
to compress to the disc. Because the brake disc
contacts atmospheric conditions and effect on good
radiation, the braking variation keeps uniform forces,
the uneven braking may not be generated on high
speed driving.
YAD4C030
SPECIFICATIONS
Disc Brake
Application Drum Brake
MANDO Delphi Korea
Drum I.D. Ø 254 mm - -
Shoe Type Leading and Trailing - -
Lining Width x Length x Thickness 55 x 243 x 4.7 mm - -
Wheel Cylinder I.D. Ø 23.81 mm - -
Caliper Cylinder I.D. - Ø 42.9 mm Ø 42 mm
Brake Pad Thickness - 10 mm 10 mm
Disc Thickness - 10.4 mm 10.4 mm
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-4 REAR BRAKE
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-5
INSPECTION
DRUM BRAKE TYPE
1. Inspect the drum for crack or damage or defor-
mation.
2. Measure the inside diameter.
Inside Diameter Wear Limit
Ø 254 mm Ø 255.5 mm
• Measure two more position.
YAD4C060
Brake Lining
1. Inspect the surface hardening or excessive wear
of the lining. Inspect the lining for stain with oil.
2. Measure the lining thickness.
Wear Limit 1 mm
YAD4C070
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
2. If the measured value is below the limit value,
replace the pad.
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy Wear Limit 2 mm
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
yyyyy
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
YAD4C080
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-6 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C090
YAD4C100
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-7
YAD4C040
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-8 REAR BRAKE
DISC BRAKE
YAD4C050
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-9
COMPONENT LOCATOR
DRUM BRAKE
YAD4C280
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-10 REAR BRAKE
DISC BRAKE
YAD4C110
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-11
RERAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear wheel.
Notice:
• Park the vehicle on the flat ground and fix the
vehicle not to move it.
• Release the parking brake.
• Position the transmission in NEUTRAL.
YAD4C120
YAD4C130
YAD4C140
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-12 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C150
YAD4C160
YAD4C170
YAD4C180
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-13
Inspection
1. Clean the dissembled parts and visually check
the followings;
• Wear, rust and damage on the cylinder and
piston
• Damage, crack on the caliper body and
damage, wear on the guide pin
• Pad uneven wear and oil contamination
• Boot’s damage and tear
YAD4C190
YAD4C200
Brake Pad
1. Remove the cylinder mounting bolt (lower) at the
brake caliper.
2. Raise and fix the caliper assembly at the proper
position not to cause any damage in the hoses or
others.
YAD4C210
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-14 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C220
YAD4C230
Installation Procedure
1. Install the brake lining between the backing plate
and the flange.
Installation Notice
4 - 8 N•m
Tightening Torque
(35 - 71 lb-in)
Notice: Apply a certain amount of grease on the
parking brake lining surface.
YAD4C240
YAD4C250
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-15
YAD4C260
YAD4C270
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-16 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C120
YAD4C290
YAD4C300
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
YAD4C310
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-17
YAD4C320
YAD4C330
YAD4C340
YAD4C350
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-18 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C360
YAD4C370
Inspection
1. Measure the inside diameter of the brake drum
and replace as needed.
I.D. Wear Limit
Ø 254 mm Ø 255.5 mm
Notice: Measure two more position.
YAD4C380
YAD4C390
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-19
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wheel cylinder to the backing plate.
Installation Notice
YAD4C400
YAD4C410
YAD4C420
YAD4C430
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-20 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C440
YAD4C450
SSANGYONG Y200
REAR BRAKE 4C-21
UNIT REPAIR
WHEEL CYLINDER
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the upper brake return spring and remove
the wheel cylinder with pulling the upper lining
outside.
YAD4C460
YAD4C470
SSANGYONG Y200
4C-22 REAR BRAKE
YAD4C490
YAD4C500
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 4D
PARKING BRAKE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation ................................... 4D-2 Component Locator ............................................. 4D-5
Parking Brake ...................................................... 4D-2 Cross Sectional View ........................................... 4D-5
Parking Brake Switch and Indicator ...................... 4D-2 Parking Brake Lever and Cable ............................ 4D-6
Braking Inspection .............................................. 4D-2 Repair Instructions ................................................ 4D-7
Specifications ...................................................... 4D-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 4D-7
Diagnostic Information and Procedure ............... 4D-4 Parking Brake ...................................................... 4D-7
4D-2 PARKING BRAKE
BRAKING INSPECTION
Inspect the parking brake as following;
1. Count the number of the notch sounds on pulling
out the parking brake at 19kg force.
Specified Notch 5
2. If the notch number is over the specified value,
adjust the notch number by the parking brake
cable adjusting nut.
3. Check the parking brake force after adjusting the
specified value.
YAD4D030
YAD4D040
SSANGYONG Y200
PARKING BRAKE 4D-3
SPECIFICATIONS
Application Spec.
Parking Brake Type Mechanical Rear-Wheel Drive Internal Expanded
Operation Manual
SSANGYONG Y200
4D-4 PARKING BRAKE
SSANGYONG Y200
PARKING BRAKE 4D-5
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CROSS SECTIONAL VIEW
YAD4D020
SSANGYONG Y200
4D-6 PARKING BRAKE
YAD4D050
SSANGYONG Y200
PARKING BRAKE 4D-7
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
PARKING BRAKE
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the console assembly.
YAD4D060
YAD4D070
YAD4D080
SSANGYONG Y200
4D-8 PARKING BRAKE
YAD4D090
YAD4D100
YAD4D110
Drum Type
• Remove the clip from the brake plate.
• Move the parking brake lever as shown using
driver etc. and then disconnect the cable.
7. Disconnect the cable bracket and the cable.
YAD4D120
SSANGYONG Y200
PARKING BRAKE 4D-9
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the parking brake cable to the parking
brake lever.
2. Install the bracket with the parking brake cable to
the body.
YAD4D130
YAD4D140
YAD4D150
YAD4D160
SSANGYONG Y200
4D-10 PARKING BRAKE
YAD4D170
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 4E
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-3
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-4 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-5
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-6 ABS AND TCS
Electronic Brake-Force Distribution (EBD) Failure Matrix
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD4E040
ABS AND TCS 4E-7
YAD4E050
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-8 ABS AND TCS
Electronic Brake-Force Distribution (EBD) Failure Matrix For Malfunction
SSANGYONG Y200
YAD4E060
ABS AND TCS 4E-9
The EBCM is attached to the hydraulic unit in the engine Valve Realy And Pump Motor Relay
compartment (ABS). The controlling element of ABS The valve relay and the motor pump relay are located
5.3 is a microprocessor-based EBCM. Inputs to the inside the electronic brake control module (EBCM) and
system include the four wheel speed sensors, the are not replaceable. If one should fail, replace the
stoplamp switch, the ignition switch, and the EBCM.
unswitched battery voltage. There is an output to a
be-directional serial data link, located in pin K of Wiring Harness
Assembly Line Diagnostic Link (ALDL) for service
The wiring harness is the mechanism by which the
diagnostic tools and assembly plant testing.
electronic brake control module (EBCM) is electrically
The EBCM monitors the speed of each wheel. If any connected to power and to ground, to the wheel speed
wheel begins to approach lockup and the brake switch sensors, the fuses, the switches, the indicators, and
is closed (brake pedal pressed), the EBCM controls the serial communications port. The components,
the solenoids to reduce brake pressure to the wheel considered part of the wiring harness, are the wires
approaching lockup. Once the wheel regains traction, that provide electrical interconnection, and connectors
brake pressure is increased until the wheel again (terminals, pins, contacts, or lugs) that provide an
begins to approach lockup. This cycle repeats until electrical/mechanical interface from the wire to a
either the vehicle comes to a stop, the brake pedal is system component.
released, or no wheels approach lockup.
Additionally, the EBCM monitors itself, each input Indicators
(except the serial data link), and each output for proper The electronic brake control module (EBCM)
operation. If it detects any system malfunction, the continuously monitors itself and the other ABS
EBCM will store a DTC in nonvolatile memory components If the EBCM detects a problem with the
(EERPOM) (DTCs will not disappear if the battery is system, the amber ABS indicator will light continuously
disconnected). Refer to “Self Diagnostics” in this to alert the driver to the problem. An illuminated ABS
section for more detailed information. indicator indicates that the ABS system has detected
a problem that affects the operation of ABS. On
Front Wheel Speed Sensors antilock braking will be available. Normal, non-antilock
The front wheel speed sensors are of a variable brake performance will remain. In order to regain ABS
reluctance type. Sensor is attached to the steering braking ability, the ABS must be serviced.
knuckle, close to a toothed ring. The result, as teeth The red BRAKE indicator will be illuminated when the
pass by the sensor, is an AC voltage with a frequency system detects a low brake fluid level in the master
proportional to the speed of the wheel. The magnitude cylinder or when the parking brake switch is closed
of the voltage and frequency increase with increasing (the parking brake is engaged).
speed. The sensor is not repairable, nor is the air gap
The EBD indicator will light continuously to alert the
adjustable.
driver to the problem in the basic brake system. The
EBD system must be serviced.
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-10 ABS AND TCS
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
ABS 5.3
Pressure Increase
YAD4E070
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-11
Pressure Hold
YAD4E080
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-12 ABS AND TCS
Pressure Decrease
YAD4E090
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-13
ABS/TCS 5.3
Pressure Increase
YAD4E100
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-14 ABS AND TCS
Pressure Hold
YAD4E110
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-15
Pressure Decrease
YAD4E120
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-16 ABS AND TCS
COMPONENT LOCATOR
ABS, ABS/TCS 5.3
1 3
2
4
YAD4E130
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-18 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E140
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-19
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-20 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E150
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-21
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-22 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-24 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E160
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-25
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-26 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-28 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E150
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-29
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-30 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-32 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E140
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-33
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-34 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-36 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E150
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-37
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-38 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-40 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E170
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-41
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-42 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E170
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-43
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-44 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E180
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-45
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-46 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E180
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-47
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-48 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E190
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-49
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-50 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E190
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-51
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-52 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E200
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-53
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-54 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E200
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-55
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-56 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E210
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-57
Diagnostic Aids teeth in the toothed wheel, as this material may cause
DTC 11 may be set by running the scan tool auto test this malfunction.
if the throttle angle readings are not updating while in A badly worn hub/bearing assembly may cause this
the date list mode. If this is the case, clear the DTCs, malfunction. The wheel speed sensor-to-toothed wheel
disconnect the scan tool, and road test the vehicle to air gap may change excessively due to bearing play.
at least 25 km/h (15 mph) to see if the DTC resets. If an improper rear hub assembly or front outer constant
Check the toothed wheels for any large grooves, velocity joint is installed, one with a toothed wheel
gouges, marks, etc. that might influence the tooth’s containing the incorrect number of teeth, this DTC can
signal at the wheel speed sensor. Also, check for a set. Be sure that all the toothed wheels have 52 teeth.
buildup of foreign material in the gaps between the
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-58 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-59
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-60 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E220
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-61
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-62 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E220
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-63
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-64 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E230
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-65
DTC 060/065 - Left Front Inlet and Outlet Valve Solenoid Fault
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-66 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E230
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-67
DTC 070/075 - Right Front Inlet and Outlet Valve Solenoid Fault
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-68 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E230
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-69
DTC 080/085 - Left Rear Inlet and Outlet Valve Solenoid Fault
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-70 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E230
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-71
DTC 090/095 – Right Rear Inlet and Outlet Valve Solenoid Fault
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-72 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E230
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-73
DTC 141/146 - Left Rear Prime Line and TCS Pilot Valve Fault
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-74 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E240
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-75
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-76 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E250
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-77
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-78 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E260
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-79
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-80 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-82 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E270
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-83
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-84 ABS AND TCS
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-86 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E270
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-87
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-88 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E280
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-89
YAD4E290
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-90 ABS AND TCS
YAD4E300
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-91
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
SERVICE PRECAUTIONS
Caution: Brake Fluid may irritate eyes and skin. In
case of contact, take the following actions:
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-92 ABS AND TCS
Bleeding System
Replacement modulators are shipped already filled
and bled. In normal procedures requiring removal of
the modulator, such as to replace the EBCM, air will
not enter the modulator, and normal bleeding will be
all that is needed.
If air enters the hydraulic modulator, or if an unfilled
modulator is installed, use the brake bleeding program
in the scan tool to bleed the modulator. Manual
bleeding of the hydraulic modulator is not possible.
HYDRAULIC MODULATOR/EBCM
ASSEMBLY
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the ABS wiring harness connector from
its socket on the EBCM.
3. Cover the connector and the socket with shop
cloths to protect them from brake fluid.
YAD4E310
YAD4E320
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-93
YAD4E340
YAD4E360
YAD4E370
SSANGYONG Y200
ABS AND TCS 4E-95
UNIT REPAIR
ABS FRONT TOOTH WHEEL
Tool Requires
661 589 16 33 00 ABS Tooth Wheel Puller
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the disc brake rotor. Refer to Front Disc
Brakes Section.
2. Remove the ABS front toothed wheel using the
ABS tooth wheel puller 661 589 16 33 00.
YAD4E400
Installation Procedure
1. Install the ABS front toothed wheel using the ABS
tooth wheel installer 661 589 17 33 00.
YAD4E410
SSANGYONG Y200
4E-96 ABS AND TCS
661 589 17 33 00
661 589 16 33 00
ABS Tooth Wheel
ABS Tooth Wheel Puller Installer
YAD4E420 YAD4E430
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 5A
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
CAUTION: Disconnect the negative battery cable before removing or installing any electrical unit or when a
tool or equipment could easily come in contact with exposed electrical terminals. Disconnecting this cable
will help prevent personal injury and damage to the vehicle. The ignition must also be in LOCK unless
otherwise noted.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description and Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-2 Shift Quality Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-45
BTRA M74 4WD Automatic Transmission . . . . . . 5A-2 After Teardown Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-47
Operators Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-2 Trouble Code Diagnosis - Gasoline Vehicle . . 5A-50
Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-3 TCM Diagnostic System Overview . . . . . . . . . . 5A-50
Electronic Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-3 Clearing Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-50
Hydraulic Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-10 Diagnostic Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-50
Hydraulic Control Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-11 Trouble Code Diagnosis - Disel Vehicle . . . . . . 5A-52
Power Train System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-15 TCM Diagnostic System Overview . . . . . . . . . . 5A-52
Power Flows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-19 Clearing Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-52
Park and Neutral . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-20 Diagnostic Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-52
Reverse. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-22 Repair Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-159
Manual 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-24 On-Vehicle Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-159
Drive 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-26 Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-159
Drive 2 and Manual 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-28 Unit Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-162
Drive 3 and Manual 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-30 Rebuild Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-162
Drive 3 Lock Up and Manual 3 Lock Up . . . . . . 5A-32 Disassembly Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-163
Drive 4 (Overdrive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-34 Assembly Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-173
Drive 4 Lock Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-36 Front and Rear Band Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-201
Diagnostic Information and Procedures . . . . . 5A-38 Gear Shift Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-204
Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-38 Kickdown Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-205
Basic Knowledge Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-38 Transmission Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-205
Functional Check Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-38 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-206
Transmission Fluid Level Service Procedure . . . 5A-38 General Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-206
Fluid Leak Diagnosis and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-39 Fastener Tightening Specifications . . . . . . . . . . 5A-210
Electrical / Garage Shift Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-40 Schematic and Routing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . 5A-211
Road Test Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-40 TCM Wiring Diagrams (Gasoline Engine) . . . . . 5A-211
Electronic Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-41 TCM Wiring Diagrams (Diesel Engine) . . . . . . . 5A-213
Symptom Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-42 Connector End View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-215
Drive Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-42 Special Tools and Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-216
Faulty Shift Pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-43 Special Tools Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-216
5A-2 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A010
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-3
allows the engine to be started. There is no power When NORMAL mode is selected upshifts will occur
transferred through the transmission in Neutral. But to maximize fuel economy. When POWER mode is se-
the final drive is not locked by the parking pawl, so lected, upshifts will occur to give maximum
thewheels are free to rotate. performance and the POWER mode indicator light is
• D - Overdrive range is used for all normal driving switched ON.
conditions. 4th gear (overdrive gear) reduces the When WINTER mode is selected, starting in second
fuel consumption and the engine noise. Engine gear is facilitated, the WINTER mode indicator light is
braking is applied with reduced throttle. switched ON and the POWER mode indicator light is
First to second (1 → 2), first to third (1 → 3), second switched OFF.
to third (2 → 3), second to fourth (2 → 4), third to Indicator Light
fourth (3 → 4), fourth to third (4 → 3), fourth to
The indicator light is located on the instrument panel.
second (4 → 2), third to second (3 → 2), third to
first (3 → 1) and second to first (2 → 1) shifts are • Auto shift indicator light comes ON when the ignition
all available as a function of vehicle speed, throttle switch ON and shows the gear shift control lever
position and the time change rate of the throttle posi-tion.
position. • POWER mode indicator light comes ON when the
Downshifts are available for safe passing by POWER mode is selected and when the kickdown
depress-ing the accelerator. Lockup clutch may be switch is depressed.
enabled in 3rd and 4th gears depending on vehicle • WINTER mode indicator light comes ON when the
type. WINTER mode is selected.
• 3 - Manual 3 provides three gear ratios (first through
CONTROL SYSTEMS
third) and prevents the transmission from operating
in 4th gear. 3rd gear is used when driving on long BTRA M74 4WD automatic transmission consists of
hill roads or in heavy city traffic. Downshifts are two control systems. One is the electronic control
available by depressing the accelerator. system that monitors vehicle parameters and adjusts
• 2 - Manual 2 provides two gear ratios (first and the transmission performance. Another is the hydraulic
second). It is used to provide more power when control system that implements the commands of the
climbing hills or engine braking when driving down electronic control system commands.
a steep hill or starting off on slippery roads.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
• 1 - Manual 1 is used to provide the maximum engine
braking when driving down the severe gradients. The electronic control system comprises of sensors, a
TCM and seven solenoids. The TCM reads the inputs
and activates the outputs according to values stored
in Read Only Memory (ROM).
The TCM controls the hydraulic control system. This
control is via the hydraulic valve body, which contains
seven electromagnetic solenoids. Six of the seven
solenoids are used to control the line pressure, operate
the shift valves and the torque converter lock-up clutch,
and to turn ON and OFF the two regulator valves that
control the shift feel.
The seventh solenoid is the proportional or Variable
Pressure Solenoid (VPS) which works with the two regu-
lator valves to control shift feel.
KAA5A020
Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Driving Mode Selector The TCM is an in-vehicle micro-processor based trans-
The driving mode selector consists of a driving mode mission management system. It is mounted under the
selector switch and indicator light. The driving mode driver’s side front seat in the vehicle cabin.
selector is located on the center console and allows The TCM contains:
the driver to select the driving mode.
• Processing logic circuits which include a central mi-
The driving modes available to be selected vary with croprocessor controller and a back-up memory
vehicle types. Typically the driver should have the system.
option to select among NORMAL, POWER and
WINTER modes.
• Input circuits.
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-4 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
• Output circuits which control external devices such the engine torque output, adjusts the variable pressure
as the Variable Pressure Solenoid (VPS) driver, On/ solenoid ramp pressure then executes the shift.
Off solenoid drivers, a diagnostics output and the The TCM continuously monitors every input and output
driving mode indicator light. circuit for short or open circuits and operating range.
Processing Logic When a failure or abnormal operation is detected the
Shift schedule and calibration information is stored in TCM records the condition code in the diagnostics
an Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM). memory and implements a Limp Home Mode (LHM).
Throttle input calibration constants and the diagnostics The actual limp home mode used depends upon the
information are stored in Electrically Erasable Program- fail-ure detected with the object to maintain maximum
mable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) that retains the drive-ability without damaging the transmission. In
memory even when power to the TCM is disconnected. general input failures are handled by providing a
TCM continuously monitors the input values and uses default value. Output failures, which are capable of
these, via the shift schedule, to determine the required damaging the transmission, result in full limp mode
gear state. At the same time it monitors, via the giving only third or fourth gear and reverse. For further
solenoid outputs, the current gear state, whenever the details of limp modes and memory retention refer to
input conditions change such that the required gear the Diagnostic Trouble Code Diagnosis Section.
state is different to the current gear state, the TCM The TCM is designed to operate at ambient
initiates a gear shift to bring the two states back into temperatures between - 40 and 85 °C (- 40 and 185 °F).
line. It is also protected against electrical noise and voltage
Once the TCM has determined the type of gearshift spikes, however all the usual precautions should be
required the TCM accesses the shift logic, estimates observed, for example when arc welding or jump
starting.
KAA5A030
TCM Inputs
To function correctly, the TCM requires engine speed, and on/off solenoid states. This ensures the correct
vehicle speed, transmission fluid temperature, throttle gear selection and shift feel for all driving conditions.
position, gear position and Kickdown Switch inputs to The inputs required by the TCM are as follows;
determine the variable pressure solenoid current ramp
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-5
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-6 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Maintaining good shift feel through the transmission Readings for Resistance / Shift Lever Positions
life span is dependant on having an accurate measure
of the engine throttle position. To achieve this the TCU Shift Lever Position Ω)
Resistance (kΩ
continuously monitors the maximum and minimum Manual 1 1 ~ 1.4
throttle potentiometer voltages and, if a change occurs, Manual 2 21.8 ~ 2.2
stores the new voltage values.
Manual 3 3 3 ~ 3.4
However these limits will be lost and will require
relearning should a new TCU be installed, or the throttle Drive 4.5 ~ 4.9
calibration data is cleared by the execution of a Neutral 6.8 ~ 7.2
particular sequence. This last instance depends on Reverse 10.8 ~ 11.2
the installation, and reference should be made to the
Diagnostics Section of this manual. The relearning will Park 18.6 ~ 19
happen automatically.
Kickdown Switch
The Kickdown Switch is used to signal the TCM that
the driver has pressed the acclerator to the floor and
requires a kickdown shift. When this switch is used,
the POWER light comes ON and the POWER shift
pattern is used.
Diagnostic Inputs
The diagnostic control input or K-line is used to initiate
the outputting of diagnostic data from the TCM to a
diagnostic test instrument. This input may also be used
to clear the stored fault history data from the TCM’s
retentive memory. Connection to the diagnostic input
of the TCM is via a connector included in the vehicle’s
YAD5A250
wiring harness or computer interface.
Gear Position Sensor Battery Voltage Monitoring Input
The gear position sensor is incorporated in the inhibitor The battery voltage monitoring input is connected to
switch mounted on the side of the transmission case. the positive side of the battery. This signal is taken
from the main supply to the TCM.
If the battery voltage at the TCM falls below 11.3 V,
the transmission will adopt a low voltage mode of
operating in which shifts into first gear are inhibited.
All other shifts are allowed but may not occur because
of the reduced voltage. This condition normally occurs
only when the battery is in poor condition.
If the battery voltage is greater than 16.5 V, the trans-
mission will adopt limp home mode and all solenoids
are turned OFF.
When system voltage recovers, the TCM will resume
normal operation after a 30 seconds delay period.
KAA5A060 TCM Outputs
The outputs from the TCM are supplied to the compo-
The gear position sensor is a multi-function switch pro- nents described below;
viding three functions;
• Solenoids
• Inhibit starting of the vehicle when the shift lever is
• Mode Indicator Light
in a position other than Park or Neutral
• Illuminate the reverse lamps when Reverse is se-
lected
• Indicate to the TCM which lever position has been
selected by way of a varying resistance.
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-7
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-8 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-9
Solenoid Valve Symbols This applies full Line 500 pressure to the plunger and
because Line 500 pressure is always greater than S5
(ON/OFF Solenoids)
pressure it squeezes the S5 oil out between the
The solenoid symbol shown adjacent to each solenoid regulator valve and the plunger. The friction elements
on the hydraulic system schematics indicates the state are then fed oil pressure equal to Line 500 multiplied
of the oil flow through the solenoid valve with the power by the amplification ratio.
ON or OFF.
When a shift is initiated the required ON/OFF solenoid
Normally Open (NO) Solenoid is switched ON cutting the supply of Line 500 to the
POWER ON: Line 500 port is closed. The output port plunger.
is open to exhaust at the solenoid valve. At the same time the VPS pressure is reduced to the
POWER OFF: The exhaust port is closed. The output ramp start value and assumes control of the regulator
port is open to line 500. valve by pushing the plunger away from the valve.
The VPS then carries out the required pressure ramp
and the timed shift is completed by switching OFF the
ON/ OFF solenoid and returning the VPS to the standby
pressure.
This system enables either the band or clutch or both
to be electrically controlled for each gearshift.
Mode Indicator Light
Depending on the application, the mode indicator light
may be used to indicate the mode that has been se-
lected or if an overheat condition exists. The mode
indicator light is usually located on the instrument
cluster.
KAA5A070 Communication Systems
Variable Pressure Solenoid Multiplexing System CAN
Friction element shifting pressures are controlled by The Controller Area Network (CAN) connects various
the Variable Pressure Solenoid (VPS). control modules by using a twisted pair of wires, to
Line pressure is completely independent of shift pres- share common information. This results in a reduction
sure and is a function of throttle position, gear state of sensors and wiring. TCM obtains the actual engine
and engine speed. speed and throttle position, vehicle speed and
accelerator position etc. from ECM via CAN without
S5 is a proportional or variable pressure solenoid that
any additional sensors.
provides the signal pressure to the clutch and band
regulator valves thereby controlling shift pressures. K-Line
VPS pressure is multiplexed to the clutch regulator The K-line is typically used for obtaining diagnostic
valve, the band regulator valve and the converter clutch information from the TCM. A scan tool with a special
regulator valve during automatic gearshifts. interface is connected to the TCM via Data Link
A variable pressure solenoid produces a hydraulic Connector (DLC) and all current faults, stored faults,
pressure inversely proportional to the current applied. runtime parameters are then available. The stored
During a gearshift the TCM applies a progressively trouble codes can also be cleared by scan tool.
increasing or decreasing (ramped) current to the The K-line can be used for vehicle coding at the
solenoid. Current applied will vary between a minimum manufacturer’s plant or in the workshop. This allows
oaf 200 mA and a maximum of 1000 mA. Increasing for one TCM design to be used over different vehicle
current decreases output (S5) pressure. Decreasing mod-els.
current increases output (S5) pressure. The particular code is sent to the microprocessor via
Line 500 pressure, (approximately 440 to 560 kPa), is the K-line and this results in the software selecting the
the reference pressure for the VPS, and the VPS output correct shift and VPS ramp parameters.
pressure is always below line 500 pressure. Data Link Connector (DLC)
When the VPS is at standby, that is no gearshift is
The Data Link Connector (DLC) is a multiple cavity
taking place, the VPS current is set to 200 mA giving
connector. The DLC provides the means to access the
maximum output pressure.
serial data from the TCM.
Under steady state conditions the band and clutch The DLC allows the technician to use a scan tool to
regulator valve solenoids are switched OFF. monitor the various systems and display the Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs).
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-10 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
The DLC connector is located within the driver’s The pump cover contains the following;
compartment, directly below the instrument panel on • Primary regulator valve for line pressure
the driver’s side.
• Converter clutch regulator valve
• Converter clutch control valve
• Solenoid S7
The main case contains the following;
• B1R exhaust valve
All upshifts are accomplished by simultaneously
switching on a shift valve(s), switching VPS pressure
to the band and/or clutch regulator valve, and then
sending the VPS a ramped current. The shift is
completed by switching the regulators OFF and at the
same time causing the VPS to reach maximum
pressure.
A103A321
All downshifts are accomplished by switching VPS pres-
sure to the band and/or clutch regulator valve and send-
HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM ing a ramped current to the VPS. The shift is completed
by simultaneously switching the regulators OFF,
The hydraulic controls are located in the valve body, switching the shift valves and at the same time causing
pump body and main case. the VPS to return to stand-by pressure.
The valve body contains the following; The primary regulator valve is located in the pump
• Manual valve cover and supplies four line pressures; high and low
• Three shift valves for forward gears, and high and low for reverse. This
pressure has no effect on shift quality and merely
• Sequence valve provides static clutch capacity during steady state
• Solenoid supply pressure regulator valve operation. Low pressure can be obtained by activating
• Line pressure control valve an ON/OFF solenoid with high line pressure being the
• Clutch apply feed regulator valve default mode.
• Band apply feed regulator valve Torque converter lock-up is initiated by toggling the
converter clutch control valve with an ON/OFF solenoid.
• Solenoid S1 to S6
The actual apply and release of the clutch is regulated
• Reverse lockout valve by the VPS via the converter clutch regulator valve.
The solenoid supply pressure regulator valve provides
reference pressure for all the solenoids.
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-11
HYDRAULIC CONTROL CIRCUIT
KAA5A08A
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-12 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Valve Body
KAA5A110
KAA5A090
2-3 Shift Valve
Manual Valve The 2-3 shift valve is a two position valve. It is used
on all 2-3 and 3-2 gearshifts.
The manual valve is connected to the vehicle selector
mechanism and controls the flow of oil to the forward The switching of this valve is achieved by S2 which is
and reverse circuits. The manual valve function is located at the end of the valve spool.
identical in all forward gear positions except that in In the 1, 2 position, second gear oil from the 1-2 shift
the Manual 1 position an additional supply of oil is valve is prevented from entering the third gear circuit.
directed to the 1-2 shift valve for application of the When the valve is moved to the 3, 4 position, oil from
rear band and the C4 overrun clutch. The manual valve the second gear circuit is routed to the third gear circuit
directs the line pressure into the PRND fluid circuits. and the transmission is changed to third gear.
KAA5A100 KAA5A120
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-13
During a 4-3 gearshift, the C4 clutch is engaged and line pressure control valve. When S6 pressure is applied
the front band (B1) is released. These actions are se- to the end of the Primary Regulator Valve (PRV), it is
quenced by the 4-3 sequence valve. opposed by spring force and causes LOW line
The 3-4 shift valve also switches during 1-2 and 2-1 pressure for light throttle application and cruising.
gearshifts where its function is to apply the overrun Heavy throttle application causes the normally open
clutch (C4) in second gear but to release it in first S6 to open (switch Off) thus closing line 500 and
gear. opening S6 to exhaust. Removal of S6 pressure from
Note that the C4 clutch is applied in Manual 1 by virtue the PRV results in HIGH line pressure.
of the manual valve and the 1-2 shift valve. Refer to
“1-2 Shift Valve” in this section.
KAA5A150
KAA5A160
KAA5A140
Band Apply Feed Regulator Valve
The band apply feed regulator valve is a fixed ratio
Solenoid Supply Pressure Regulator Valve (1.4:1) valve. It provides a regulated pressure to the
The solenoid supply pressure regulator valve supplies front servo, and controls the change rate of the front
a constant pressure to all solenoids (S1 to S7). Line band (B1) state to give the desired shift quality.
pres-sure is used as the feeding oil to this regulator Second gear oil supplied to the valve is regulated to
and the output is termed line 500. provide an output pressure, Band Apply Feed (BAF)
Line Pressure Control Valve pressure, of 1.4 times the S5 signal pressure when S4
is ON. When S4 is OFF the output pressure is 1.4 times
Line pressure is controlled by S6, which acts as the the line 500 pressure.
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-14 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
S1- S2 pressure is exhausted and the valve is held in
the lockout position by the spring. In this position,
engagement of B2 is prohibited.
This feature protects the transmission from abuse by
preventing the undesirable application of B2 at high
speed, and by providing a reverse lockout function.
Note that if the transmission is in failure mode, the
rear band will be applied at all times in P, R and N.
Pump Cover
KAA5A170
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-15
KAA5A200 KAA5A220
KAA5A210
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-16 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
• Gear set-sprag-centre support the B1 band. The 3-4 shift is accomplished by re-
• C1 -C2 -C3 -C4 clutch sub-assembly applying the B1 band and overrunning the 3-4 OWC.
Reverse gear is engaged by applying the C3 clutch
• Pump assembly
and the B2 band.
• Valve body assembly
The C4 clutch is applied in the Manual 1, 2 and 3 ranges
One, or a combination of selective washers are used to provide engine braking. In addition, the C4 clutch
between the input shaft flange and the number 4 is also applied in the Drive range for second and third
bearing to control the transmission end float. This gears to eliminate objectionable freewheel coasting.
arrangement allows for extensive subassembly testing
The B2 band is also applied in the Manual 1 range to
and simplistic final assembly during production.
accomplish the low-overrun shift.
A general description of the operation of the Power
Both the front and rear servos are dual area designs
Train System is detailed below.
to allow accurate friction element matching without the
First gear is engaged by applying the C2 clutch and need for secondary regulator valves. All the friction
locking the 1-2 One Way Clutch (1-2 OWC). The 1-2 elements have been designed to provide low shift
shift is accomplished by applying the B1 band and energies and high static capacities when used with
overrunning the 1-2 OWC. The 2-3 shift is the new low static co-efficient transmission fluids. Non-
accomplished by applying the C1 clutch and releasing asbestos friction materials are used throughout.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear Gear C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
Ratio OWC OWC CLUTCH
First 2.741 X X X
Second 1.508 X X X
Third 1.000 X X X X X X*
Fourth 0.708 X X X X X
Reverse 2.428 X X
Manual 1 2.741 X X X X
* For Certain Vehicle Applications, Refer to the Owner's Manual.
KAA5A250
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-17
KAA5A270
KAA5A260
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-18 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A290
KAA5A280
KAA5A300
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-19
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Park and Neutral - - - - - X - - -
Reverse - - X - - X - - -
Manual 1 - X - X - X - X -
Drive 1 - X - - - - X X -
Drive 2 and Manual 2 - X - X X - - X -
Drive 3 and Manual 3 X X - X - - - X -
Drive 3 Lock Up and X X - X - - - X X
Manual 3 Lock Up
Drive 4 Overdrive X X - - X - - X -
Drive 4 Lock Up X X - - X - - X X
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-20 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
PARK AND NEUTRAL
KAA5A31A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-21
Power Flow - Park and Neutral • Line (pump) pressure is applied to the Primary Regu-
lator Valve (PRV) and to the solenoid supply
In Park and Neutral, there is no drive to the planetary
pressure regulator valve.
gear set. The rear band is applied to eliminate ‘clunk’
on engagement of the reverse gear, and to improve • The converter, oil cooler, and lubrication circuits are
the low range engagement for 4WD applications. No charged from the primary regulator valve.
other clutches or bands are applied. • The line 500 circuit is charged by the solenoid
In Park the transmission is mechanically locked by supply pressure regulator valve.
engaging a case mounted pawl with teeth on the output • The S5 circuit is charged by the variable pressure
shaft ring gear. solenoid (S5).
Control • Line pressure is prevented from entering the drive
circuit by the manual valve.
To maintain this arrangement in the steady state sole-
noids and valves are activated as follows: • The B1 circuit and all clutch circuits are open to ex-
haust.
• Solenoids S1 and S2 are switched OFF.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Park and Neutral - - - - - X - - -
KAA5A320
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-22 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
REVERSE
KAA5A33A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-23
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Reverse - - X - - X - - -
KAA5A340
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-24 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
MANUAL 1
KAA5A35A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-25
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Manual 1 - X - X - X - X -
KAA5A360
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-26 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 1
KAA5A37A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-27
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 1 - X - - - - X X -
KAA5A380
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-28 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 2 AND MANUAL 2
KAA5A39A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-29
Power Flow - Drive 2 and Manual 2 • Drive (line pressure) oil from the manual valve en-
gages the C2 clutch.
In Drive 2 and Manual 2, transmission drive is via the
input shaft and forward clutch cylinder. The elements • When S1 switches OFF, S1 oil pressure, which is
of the transmission function as follows; derived from line 500 pressure, moves the 3-4 shift
valve to the left. At the same time S1 oil is directed
• The C2 clutch is applied to drive the forward sun to the 1-2 shift valve which moves the valve to the
gear.
second gear position.
• The forward sun gear drives the short pinion anti-
clockwise. • 2nd oil (line pressure) from the 1-2 shift valve is di-
rected to the band apply regulator valve, and to
• The short pinion drives the long pinion clockwise. the 2-3 shift valve.
• The B1 band is applied holding the reverse sun • The band apply feed regulator valve supplies 2nd
gear stationary therefore the long pinion walks oil (regulated to line pressure multiplied by the valve
around the reverse sun gear taking the internal ring ratio) to the Band Apply Feed (BAF) circuit.
gear and output shaft with it in a clockwise or
forward direction. • Band apply feed oil is directed to;
- The outer apply area of the front servo
• The C4 clutch is applied to bypass the 3-4 OWC
and provide engine braking on overrun. - The 1-2 shift valve to provide an exhaust port
when the transmission is shifted to first gear
Control
- The 3-4 shift valve for use when the transmission
To maintain this arrangement in the steady state sole- is shifted into fourth gear
noids and valves are activated as follows;
• Drive (line pressure) is routed through the 3-4 shift
• Solenoid S1 is switched OFF. S2 is switched ON. valve to apply the C4 clutch.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 2 and Manual 2 - X - X X - - X -
KAA5A400
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-30 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 3 AND MANUAL 3
KAA5A41A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-31
Power Flow - Drive 3 and Manual 3 • The band apply feed regulator valve supplies 2nd
oil (regulated to line pressure multiplied by the valve
In Drive 2 and Manual 2, transmission drive is via the
ra-tio) to the Band Apply Feed (BAF) circuit.
input shaft and forward clutch cylinder. The elements
of the transmission function as follows; • Band apply feed oil is directed to;
• The C2 clutch is engaged to drive the forward sun - The outer apply area of the front servo
gear. - The 1-2 shift valve to provide an exhaust port
• The C1 clutch is engaged to drive the planet carrier. when the transmission is shifted to first gear
• The short pinion drives the long pinion clockwise. - The 3-4 shift valve for use when the transmission
is shifted into fourth gear
• The forward sun gear and the planet carrier are driv-
en clockwise at the same speed therefore there is • 2nd oil at the 2-3 shift valve is directed to the 3rd
no relative motion between the sun gear and the oil circuit.
pinions. • 3rd oil from the 2-3 shift valve is directed to the
• The ring gear and output shaft are driven in a clock- clutch apply regulator valve, and to the 4-3
wise or forward direction at input shaft speed. sequence valve.
• The C4 clutch is applied to bypass the 3-4 OWC • The clutch apply regulator valve supplies oil (regu-
and provide engine braking on overrun. lated to line 500 pressure multiplied by the valve
ratio) to the Clutch Apply Feed (CAF) circuit.
Control
The CAF oil is directed to;
To maintain this arrangement in the steady state sole-
- The C1clutch
noids and valves are activated as follows:
- The 4-3 sequence valve
• Solenoid S1 is switched OFF. S2 is switched OFF.
• With S1 and S2 switched OFF, the 2-3 and 3-4 shift • At the 4-3 sequence valve the CAF oil becomes
Band 1 Release Feed (B1R-F) oil, and is directed
valves are held in the third gear position by line
through the 3-4 shift valve to the spring end of the
500 pressure.
4-3 sequence valve, and to the release side of the
• The 1-2 shift valve is held in the third gear position front servo piston to hold band 1 OFF.
by S1-S2 oil pressure.
• Drive (line pressure) is routed through the 3-4 shift
• 2nd oil (line pressure) from the 1-2 shift valve is di- valve to apply the C4 clutch.
rected to the band apply feed regulator valve and
to the 2-3 shift valve.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 3 and Manual 3 X X - X - - - X -
KAA5A420
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-32 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 3 LOCK UP AND MANUAL 3 LOCK UP
KAA5A43A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-33
Power Flow - Drive 3 Lock Up and Manual 3 • When S7 is switched ON, S7 feed oil to the converter
Lock Up clutch control valve is switched OFF and allowed
to exhaust through the S7 solenoid. This allows the
In Drive 3 Lock Up and Manual 3 Lock Up, transmission valve to move to the clutch engage position.
drive is the same as for Drive 3 but with the application
of the converter lock up clutch to provide positive no- • Regulated apply feed oil, drive oil at the converter
clutch regulator valve, is directed by the converter
slip converter drive.
clutch control valve to the engage side of the
Control converter clutch.
Control for Drive 3 Lock Up and Manual 3 Lock Up is • Converter clutch release oil is exhausted at the con-
the same as for Drive 3 with the addition of the verter clutch control valve.
converter clutch circuit activated by solenoid S7.
• Converter feed oil is re-routed by the converter clutch
control valve directly to the oil cooler and lubrication
circuit.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 3 Lock Up and Manual 3 X X - X - - - X X
Lock Up
KAA5A440
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-34 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 4 (OVERDRIVE)
KAA5A45A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-35
Power Flow - Drive 4 (Overdrive) • The 1-2 shift valve is held in the fourth gear position
by S2 oil pressure.
In Drive 4 (Overdrive), transmission drive is via the
input shaft to the forward clutch cylinder. • 2nd oil (line pressure) from the 1-2 shift valve is di-
rected to the band apply feed regulator valve, and
The elements of the transmission function as follows;
to the 2-3 shift valve.
• The C1 clutch is applied to drive the planet carrier
clockwise. • The band apply feed regulator valve supplies 2nd
oil (regulated to line pressure multiplied by the valve
• The B1 band is applied to hold the reverse sun gear ra-tio) to the Band Apply Feed (BAF) circuit.
stationary.
• Band apply feed oil is directed to;
• As the planet carrier tuns, the long pinion walks - the outer apply area of the front servo
around the stationary reverse sun gear and rotates
around its axis driving the internal ring gear and - the inner apply area of the front servo piston via
output shaft in a clockwise or forward direction at a the 3-4 shift valve
speed faster than the input shaft i.e. in overdrive - the 1-2 shift valve to provide an exhaust port
ratio. when the transmission is shifted to first gear
• The forward sun gear is also driven faster than the • 2nd oil at the 2-3 shift valve is directed to the 3rd
input shaft and overruns the 3-4 OWC. oil circuit.
• The C2 clutch is engaged to reduce the speed differ- • 3rd oil from the 2-3 shift valve is directed to the
ential across the 3-4 OWC. clutch apply regulator valve, and to the 4-3
sequence valve.
Control
To maintain this arrangement in the steady state sole- • The clutch apply regulator valve supplies oil (regu-
noids and valves are activated as follows; lated to line 500 pressure multiplied by the valve
ratio) to the Clutch Apply Feed (CAF) circuit.
• Solenoid S1 is switched ON. S2 is switched OFF.
• The CAF oil is directed to;
• With S1 switched ON, the 3-4 shift valve is held in
- the C1 clutch
the fourth gear position by line 500 pressure on the
small end of the valve. - the 4-3 sequence valve
• With S2 switched OFF, the 2-3 shift valve is held in • Drive oil (line pressure) from the manual valve en-
the fourth gear position by line 500 pressure on the gages the C2 clutch.
large end of the valve.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 4 Overdrive X X - - X - - - -
KAA5A460
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-36 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DRIVE 4 LOCK UP
KAA5A47A
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-37
Power Flow - Drive 4 Lock Up • Regulated apply feed oil, drived from drive oil at
the converter clutch regulator valve, is directed by
In Drive 4 Lock Up, transmission drive is the same as
the converter clutch control valve to the engage side
for Drive 4 but with the application of the converter
of the converter clutch.
lock up clutch to provide positive no-slip converter
drive. • Converter clutch release oil is exhausted at the con-
verter clutch control valve.
Control
• Converter feed oil is re-routed by the converter clutch
To maintain this arrangement in the steady state sole- control valve directly to the oil cooler and lubrication
noids and valves are activated as follows; circuit.
• When S7 is switched ON, S7 feed oil to the converter
clutch control valve is switched OFF and allowed
to exhaust through the S7 solenoid. This allows the
valve to move to the clutch engage position.
ELEMENTS ENGAGED
Gear State C1 C2 C3 C4 B1 B2 1-2 3-4 LU
OWC OWC CLUTCH
Drive 4 Lock Up X X - - X - - - -
KAA5A480
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-38 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-39
3. Park the vehicle on a hoist, inspection pit or similar ranges, pausing a few seconds in each range and
raised level surface. The vehicle must be control adding the fluid until gear application is felt.
level to obtain a correct fluid level measurement. Then add an additional 0.5 litres of fluid. Return
4. Place a fluid container below the fluid filler plug. the gear shift lever to P (Park). Turn the engine OFF
5. Clean all dirt from around the fluid filler plug. and raise the vehicle. Install the fluid filler plug and
Remove the fluid filler plug. Clean the filler plug tighten it to 33 N•m (24 lb-ft).
and check that there is no damage to the ‘O’ ring. 5. Drive the vehicle at 3.5 to 4.5 kilometers with light
• If fluid drains through the filler hole the transmis- throttle so that the engine does not exceed 2500
sion may have been overfilled. When the fluid rpm.
stops draining the fluid level is correct. Install This should result in the transmission temperature
the fluid filler plug and tighten it to 33 N•m (24 being in the range 50 - 60 °C (82 - 140 °F). With the
lb-ft). brake applied, move the shift lever through the gear
• If fluid does not drain through the filler hole, the ranges, pausing a few seconds in each range at
transmission fluid level may be low. Install the the engine idling.
filler pump into the filler hole. Lower the vehicle 6. Return the gear shift lever to P (Park).
with the filler pump still connected and partially Turn the en-gine OFF and raise the vehicle on the
fill the fluid through the filler hole. hoist, if applicable, ensuring the vehicle is level.
Start the vehicle in P (Park) with the parking When the three minutes passed after the engine
brake and the brake applied. With the engine stopped, remove the filler plug.
idling, move the gear shift. control lever through Check if the fluid level is aligned with the bottom of
the gear ranges, pausing a few seconds in each the filler hole. If not, add a small quantity of fluid to
range and adding the fluid until gear application the correct level. Install the fluid filler plug and
is felt. tighten it to 33 N•m (24 lb-ft).
Return the gear shift lever to P (Park). 7. Wipe any fluid around the filler plug with a rag or
Turn the engine OFF and raise the vehicle. When shop towel.
the three minutes passed after the engine
stopped, remove the filler pump. FLUID LEAK DIAGNOSIS AND
Check if the fluid level is aligned with the bottom REPAIR
of the filler hole. If not, add a small quantity of
The cause of most external leaks can generally be lo-
fluid to the correct level. Install the fluid filler
cated and repaired with the transmission in the vehicle.
plug and tighten it to 33 N•m (24 lb-ft).
•If fluid does not drain through the filler hole al- Methods for Locating Leaks
though adding a total of 1.5 liters, the General Method
transmission should be inspected for fluid leaks 1. Verify that the leak is transmission fluid.
and any leaks should be fixed before setting
the transmission fluid level. 2. Thoroughly clean the suspected leak area.
6. When the fluid level checking procedure is com- 3. Drive the vehicle for approximately 25 km (15 miles)
pleted, wipe any fluid around the filler plug with a or until the transmission reaches normal operating
rag or shop towel. temperature (88 °C, 190 °F).
4. Park the vehicle over clean paper or cardboard.
Fluid Level Set After Service
5. Turn the engine OFF and look for fluid spots on the
1. Depending on the service procedure performed, paper.
add the following amounts of fluid through the filler
plug hole prior to adjusting the fluid level: 6. Make the necessary repairs to correct the leak.
Converter empty 8.0 liters (8.5 quarts) Powder Method
Converter full 3.8 liters (4.0 quarts) 1. Thoroughly clean the suspected leak area.
2. Follow steps 1 through 4 of the Fluid Level 2. Apply an aerosol type powder (foot powder) to the
Diagnosis Procedure. suspected leak area.
3. Clean all dirt from around the fluid filler plug. 3. Drive the vehicle for approximately 25 km (15 miles)
Remove the fluid filler plug. Clean the filler plug or until the transmission reaches normal operating
and check that there is no damage to the ‘O’ ring. temperature (88 °C, 190 °F).
4. Lower the vehicle with the filler pump still connected 4. Turn the engine OFF.
and start the vehicle in P (Park) with the parking 5. Inspect the suspected leak area and trace the leak
brake and the brake applied. With the engine idling, path through the powder to find the source of the
move the gear shift control lever through the gear leak.
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-40 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
• Gaskets, seals or sleeves are misaligned, damaged • GEAR SHIFT LEVER POSITION VOLTAGE
or worn. • TRANS. FLUID TEMPERATURE VOLTAGE
• Damaged, warped or scratched seal bore or gasket • A/C SWITCH
surface. • KICKDOWN SWITCH VOLTAGE
• Loose or worn bearing causing excess seal or sleeve • 4WD LAMP LOW VOLTAGE
wear.
• 4WD LAMP HIGH VOLTAGE
• Case or component porosity.
• MODE SWITCH VOLTAGE
• Fluid level is too high.
• BATTERY VOLTAGE
• Plugged vent or damaged vent tube. 6. Monitor the A/C COMPRESSOR STATUS signal
• Water or coolant in fluid. while pushing the A/C switch.
• Fluid drain back holes plugged. • The A/C COMPRESSOR STATUS should come
ON when the A/C switch is pressed, and turn
ELECTRICAL / GARAGE SHIFT OFF when the A/C switch is repushed.
TEST 7. Monitor the GEAR SHIFT LEVER POSITION signal
This preliminary test should be performed before a hoist and move the gear shift control lever through all
or road test to make sure electronic control inputs are the ranges.
connected and operating. If the inputs are not checked • Verify that the GEAR SHIFT LEVER POSITION
before operating the transmission, a simple electrical value matches the gear range indicated on the
condition could be misdiagnosed as a major instrument panel or console.
transmission condition. • Gear selections should be immediate and not
A scan tool provides valuable information and must harsh.
be used on the automatic transmission for accurate 8. Move gear shift control lever to neutral and monitor
diagnosis. the THROTTLE POSITION signal while increasing
1. Move gear shift control lever to P (Park) and set and decreasing engine speed with the accelerator
the parking brake. pedal.
2. Connect scan tool to Data Link Connector (DLC) • THROTTLE POSITION should increase with en-
terminal. gine speed.
3. Start engine.
ROAD TEST PROCEDURE
4. Turn the scan tool ON.
5. Verify that the appropriate signals are present. • Perform the road test using a scan tool.
These signals may include: • This test should be performed when traffic and road
conditions permit.
• ENGINE SPEED
• Observe all traffic regulations.
• VEHICLE SPEED
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-41
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-42 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
DRIVE FAULTS
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-43
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-44 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-45
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-46 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-47
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-48 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-50 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-51
DTC Types • TCM stores a history DTC on the first driving cycle
with a fail.
Each DTC is directly related to a diagnostic test. The
Diagnostic management system sets DTCs based on • EOBD system stores a history DTC on the second
the failure of the tests during a driving cycle or cycles. consecutive driving cycle with a fail, (the DTC will
The following are the two types of DTCs and the charac- be armed after the first fail).
teristics of those codes; • EOBD system stores a freeze frame on the second
Type B consecutive driving cycle with a fail, (if empty).
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-52 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
DTC Description
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-53
DTC Description
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-54 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
YAD5A010
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-55
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-159
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
TRANSMISSION
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the connectors from transfer case.
3. Disconnect the speedometer connector from
transfer case.
4. Disconnect the inhibitor connector, gear position
sensor connector and transmission case connector.
YAD5A080
YAD5A090
YAD5A100
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-160 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
YAD5A110
YAD5A120
YAD5A130
YAD5A140
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-161
YAD5A150
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-162 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
UNIT REPAIR
REBUILD WARNINGS
Prior to rebuilding a transmission system, the following warnings are to be noted.
• Ensure that, before replacing a transmission the cooler lines are flushed out to remove any debris. This can be
done by applying compressed air to the rear cooler line forcing oil and any contaminants out of the front cooler
line.
• The cooler flow should be checked after the transmission has been fitted. With the front cooler line connected
and the rear line run into a suitable container, measure the flow over 15 seconds with the vehicle idling in park.
• The flow rate should exceed 1 liter in 15 seconds.
• Be wary of any situation where water enters the transmission. This may result in fluid foaming and leaking
through the breather.
• Ensure that both earth straps (one at the battery terminal and one on the vehicle body) are connected in the
vehicle before connecting the positive side of the battery.
• Follow the throttle position calibration procedure in this manual if the engine control module/ transmission
control module (ECM/TCM) is swapped.
KAA5A710
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-163
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
Transmission
Tools Required
0555-336256 Transmission Bench Cradle
0555-336257 Pump Puller
Notice:
KAA5A500
KAA5A510
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-164 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A520
KAA5A530
KAA5A540
KAA5A550
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-165
KAA5A560
19. Remove the rear band struts and remove the band.
Notice: Vise the both end of rear band using the
plier and lean forward about 15 degrees
KAA5A570
Transmission Case
Tools Required
0555-336258 Cross Shaft Pin Remover/Installer
(Detent Lever)
0555-336261 Cross Shaft Seal Remover
0555-336265 Cross Shaft Pin Remover/Installer
(Inhibitor Switch)
1. Remove the pin from the side of cross shaft
inhibitor switch using cross shaft pin remover/
installer (inhibitor switch) 0555-336265.
2. Remove the inhibitor switch bolts and inhibitor
KAA5A580 switch from the case.
KAA5A590
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-166 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A600
KAA5A610
KAA5A620
KAA5A630
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-167
KAA5A640
KAA5A650
KAA5A660
KAA5A670
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-168 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A680
KAA5A700
C3 Clutch Cylinder
Tools Required
0555-336259 Clutch Spring Compressor
1. Remove the forward sun gear, No.7 needle bearing
(2) thrust washer (1) and lipped thrust washer (3)
from the C3 clutch cylinder.
2. Remove the thrust plate (4), No.6 needle bearing
(5), thrust plate (6) and nylon thrust plate (7) from
the clutch cylinder hub.
3. Remove the clutch plate retaining circlip and re-
move the clutch plates.
KAA5A720
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-169
KAA5A730
KAA5A740
KAA5A750
3. Lift the one way clutch (1) from the planet carrier
(5).
4. Remove the circlip (2) retaining the one way clutch
outer race (3) in the planet carrier and remove the
race.
5. Remove the one way clutch retainer (4) from the
planet carrier.
KAA5A760
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-170 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Pump
Notice: The following valves are housed in the pump
cover:
• Solenoid 7
• Converter clutch control valve
• Converter clutch regulator valve
• Primary regulator valve
KAA5A770
KAA5A780
KAA5A790
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-171
KAA5A800
KAA5A810
Valve Body
1. Remove the manual valve detent spring and retain-
er plate using a T40 Torx bit.
2. Slide the manual valve out of the lower valve body.
Notice: Be aware that the manual valve will fall out
of the valve body.
KAA5A830
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-172 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A840
10. Remove the filter (1) and the large nylon check
ball (2) from the lower valve body.
11. Remove the retaining plates and pins from the 1-
2, 2-3, 3-4, BAR and CAR valves. The pins can
be removed with a magnet.
Notice: Once the pins are removed, the plates are
loose in the valve body and will drop out when the
valve body is turned over.
KAA5A85A
KAA5A860
KAA5A870
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-173
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
Transmission
Tools Required
0555-336256 Transmission Bench Cradle
0555-336258 Cross Shaft Pin Remover/Installer
(Detent Lever)
0555-336262 Cross Shaft Seal Installer
0555-336263 Cross Shaft bullet
0555-336265 Cross Shaft Pin Remover/Installer
(Inhibitor Switch)
Notice:
KAA5A500
KAA5A880
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-174 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A890
KAA5A900
KAA5A910
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-175
KAA5A920
13. Install the detent lever drive pin in the shaft using
cross shaft pin remover/installer (detent lever)
0555-336258 with the adaptor over the pin.
14. Press the pin into the shaft until the tool bottoms.
15. Remove the tool and fit the spring retaining circlip
to the shaft.
KAA5A600
16. Install the new cross shaft seals using cross shaft
seal installer 0555-336262 (1) and cross shaft
bullet 0555-336263 (2).
KAA5A930
KAA5A580
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-176 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A940
KAA5A610
KAA5A980
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-177
KAA5A950
KAA5A960
KAA5A630
KAA5A990
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-178 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A0A0
KAA5A750
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-179
KAA5A0C0
5. Install the front servo block and spring into the case.
6. Install the front servo assembly into the case.
KAA5A520
KAA5A0D0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-180 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A0E0
KAA5A550
KAA5A0F0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-181
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-182 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-183
KAA5A0J0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-184 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
29. Align the tangs and fit the nylon thrust washer
onto the C4 hub.
30. Align and fit the C4 hub to the C2 clutch and the
OWC assembly.
31. Check the rotation of the C2 hub. While holding
the C4 hub, the C2 hub should rotate in the
clockwise direction and lockup in the anti-
clockwise direction when viewed from the C2 hub.
KAA5A0N0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-185
KAA5A0P0
KAA5A0Q0
KAA5A730
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-186 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-187
KAA5A0U0
KAA5A0V0
KAA5A0W0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-188 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A0X0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-189
12. Coat the sealing rings with petroleum jelly and fit
onto the input shaft.
KAA5A1A0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-190 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A1B0
KAA5A1C0
KAA5A810
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-191
KAA5A1D0
KAA5A1E0
KAA5A1F0
KAA5A1GO
KAA5A1G0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-192 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A1H0
KAA5A1J0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-193
KAA5A1M0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-194 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Valve Body
Notice:
• Do not wash the nose of solenoids in solvent.
• Be aware of ball positions in the upper valve body.
• Be aware of 1-2 and 3-4 shift valve positions, they
can be swapped.
• Check the 4-3 sequence valve and spring
orientation.
• Check that the 12 mm ball is in the lower body.
• Check the line pressure relief valve for swarf, and
be aware of replacing the shims.
• When servicing the transmission, ensure that the
solenoid 5 damper spring is not broken.
• Locate the detent spring central to the detent lever.
• Wash the upper and lower valve bodies thoroughly
with cleansing solvent and blow dry.
• Check the valve body cavities, ports and holes for
damage or obstructions.
• The orifices in the valve body are for stability and
safeguard. Do not drill them larger.
• Thoroughly wash all loose components.
• Check that all valves slide freely in their location.
KAA5A1O0
KAA5A1P0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-195
KAA5A870
KAA5A860
KAA5A1Q0
KAA5A1R0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-196 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A1S0
KAA5A1T0
KAA5A1U0
12. Position the third feed ball (large nylon) in the valve
body and install the solenoid 6 filter.
13. Check the separator plate for burrs and damage.
Repair or replace the separator plate as
necessary.
14. Check the upper and lower valve body gaskets
for damage. Replace the gaskets as necessary.
15. Install the lower valve body gasket on the lower
valve body.
KAA5A850
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-197
KAA5A1V0
KAA5A840
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-198 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A1W0
KAA5A1X0
KAA5A1Y0
KAA5A1Z0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-199
KAA5A2B0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-200 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A2C0
KAC5A040
KAC5A040
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-201
KAA5A2E0
1. Measure the projection of the front servo push rod 2. Fit the selected shim(s) to the shank of the anchor
from the transmission case dimension ’A’. strut as follows:
a. Apply air at 650/700 kPa to the front servo apply a. Inspect the shim(s) for damage, wear or corro-
area (B1 outer) sion. Replace as necessary.
b. Measure the travel of the push rod and subtract b. The shim(s) are to be installed between the case
3 mm to find the shim size required. abutment face and the anchor strut flange.
c. Release the air. c. The shim(s) are to be fitted by hand and under
no circumstances to be hammered or forced.
Notice: A minimum of one shim is required at all times
- minimum shim size is 1 mm. The thickness of d. Shim(s) are to be pressed on by hand until an
available shims are listed in the table below. audible click is heard. The click indicates that
the shim is clipped home correctly.
Thickness(mm) Part Number 3. Re-check that the push rod travel. (3mm ±0.25mm)
0.95/1.05 0574-037017
1.15/1.25 0574-037018
1.44/1.56 0574-037019
1.73/1.87 0574-037020
1.93/2.07 0574-037021
2.12/2.28 0574-037022
2.42/2.58 0574-037023
2.61/2.79 0574-037024
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-202 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A2F0
1. Measure distance‘A’ from the rear servo piston to 2. Fit the selected shim(s) to the shank of the anchor
the inner face of the transmission case using vernier strut as follows.
calipers. a. Inspect the shim(s) for damage, wear or
a. Apply air at 650/700 kPa to the rear servo apply corrosion and replace as necessary. The shim(s)
area (B2 outer) are to be installed between the case abutment
b. Measure the travel of the piston, subtract 3.75 face and the anchor strut flange.
mm and divide the remainder by 2.5 to find shim b. The shim(s) are to be fitted by hand and under
size. no circumstances to be hammered or forced
c. Release the air. c. The shim(s) are to be pressed on by hand until
an audible click is heard. The click indicates
Notice: A minimum of one shim is required at all times
that the shim is clipped home correctly.
- minimum shim size is 1 mm. The thickness of
available shims are listed in the table below. 3. Re-check that the piston travel.
(3.75 mm ± 0.625 mm)
Thickness(mm) Part Number
0.0.95/1.05 0574-037017
1.15/1.25 0574-037018
1.44/1.56 0574-037019
1.73/1.87 0574-037020
1.93/2.07 0574-037021
2.12/2.28 0574-037022
2.42/2.58 0574-037023
2.61/2.79 0574-037024
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-203
KAA5A2G0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-204 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
KAA5A5Q0
KAA5A5R0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-205
KICKDOWN SWITCH
1. Separate the Kickdown Switch from the Kickdown
Switch bracket by pushing the lock.
2. Disconnect the Kickdown Switch connector.
3. Installation should follow the removal procedure in
the reverse order.
KAA5A5S0
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
MODULE
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Push the driver's seat and disconnect the
transmission control module connector.
YAD5A160
YAD5A170
YAD5A180
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-206 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL SPECIFICATION
Model Specifications
Application Descriprtion
Torque Converter
Mean Diameter of Fluid Circuit Description 260 mm (10.2 in.)
Maximum Torque Multiplication 2.0 : 1
Gear Ratios
First 2.741 : 1
Second 1.508 : 1
Third 1.000 : 1
Fourth 0.708 : 1
Reverse 2.429 : 1
Lubricant
Type Castrol TQ95
Capacity
Dry System 9.0 Liters (approx.)
Service Refill 4.5 Liters (approx.)
Gear Train End Float 0.50 - 0.65 mm (0.020 - 0.026 in.)
Gear Set Pinion End Float 0.10 - 0.50 mm (0.004 - 0.020 in.)
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-207
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-208 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-209
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-210 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-211
YAD5A210
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-212 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
TCM WIRING DIAGRAM (GASOLINE ENGINE-2 OF 2) YAD5A220
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-213
TCM WIRING DIAGRAM (DIESEL ENGINE-1 OF 2)
YAD5A230
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-214 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
TCM WIRING DIAGRAM (DIESEL ENGINE-2 OF 2) YAD5A240
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-215
KAA5A5O0
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-216 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
0555 - 336256
0555 - 336257
Transmission Bench
Pump Puller
Cradle
KAA5A2P0 KAA5A2Q0
0555 - 336259
Clutch Spring
Compressor
KAA5A2R0 KAA5A2S0
KAA5A2T0 KAA5A2U0
0555 - 336262
0555 - 336263
Cross Shaft Seal
Cross Shaft Bullet
Installer
KAA5A2V0 KAA5A2W0
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION 5A-217
0555 - 336265
0555 - 336266
Cross Shaft Pin
Adaptor Housing Seal
Remover / Installer
Installer
(Inhibitor Switch)
KAA5A2X0 KAA5A2Y0
KAA5A2Z0 KAA5A3A0
KAA5A3B0 KAA5A3C0
KAA5A3D0 KAC5A050
SSANGYONG Y200
5A-218 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
0555 - 332083
Solenoid /Thermistor
Electronic Tester
KAC5A060
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 5B
MANUAL TRANSMISSION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ..................... 5B-2 Maintenance and Repair ................................... 5B-14
Shift Lever ........................................................... 5B-2 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 5B-14
Transmission Assembly ....................................... 5B-2 Semi-Remote Kit ................................................ 5B-14
Specifications ...................................................... 5B-3 Transmission ..................................................... 5B-19
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 5B-4 Unit Repair .......................................................... 5B-24
Diagnosis Table ................................................... 5B-6 Major Unit .......................................................... 5B-24
Component Locator ............................................ 5B-7 Main Shaft ......................................................... 5B-34
Cross-Sectional View ........................................... 5B-7 Input Shaft ........................................................ 5B-38
Power Flow .......................................................... 5B-8 Counter Shaft .................................................... 5B-40
Seni-Remote Kit Disassembly and Assembly ....... 5B-9 Extension Housing ............................................. 5B-40
Transmission Assembly ..................................... 5B-10 Shift Cover ........................................................ 5B-41
Transmission Assembly Disassembled View ...... 5B-11 Inspection of Components ................................. 5B-45
5B-2 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B010
YAD5B020
TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
YAD5B030
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-3
SPECIFICATIONS
Application Description
Model T5WC
Type Floor Change
Gear Ratio 1st 3.969 : 1
2nd 2.341 : 1
3rd 1.457 : 1
4th 1.000 : 1
5th 0.851 :1
Reverse 3.710 : 1
Oil Specification ATF DEXRON II / III
Capacity(litre) 3.4 L
Change Interval Check : Every 15,000 km,
Replace : Every 50,000 km
Weight (Dry) 33kg
Notice: Add LUBRIZOL (280cc) in oil after overhauling.
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-4 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-5
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-6 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
DIAGNOSIS TABLE
Applicatio
1 Shift Hop-out
2 Shift Gear Crash
3 Shift Block-out
4 Hard Shift
5 Noise in Reverse Gear
6 Noise in 5th Gear
7 Noise in 4th Gear
8 Noise in 3rd Gear
9 Noise in 2nd Gear
10 Noise in 1st Gear
11 Noise in All Speeds
12 Leak at Transmission Rear Part
13 Leak at Transmission Center Part
14 Leak at Transmission Front
Possible Faulty Part
Transmission Case
Extension Housing
Shift Cover / Shift Shaft
Shift Control Lever
Input Bearing Retainer
Input Gear Set
3rd Speed Gear Set
2nd Speed Gear Set
Reverse Speed Gear Set
1st Speed Gear Set
5th Speed Gear Set
Clutch Housing and Release Derive
Crankshaft Pilot Bushing and Release Bearing
Input Bearing
Main Shaft Input Bearing
Main Shaft Thrust Bearing
3rd Speed Gear Bearing
2nd Speed Gear Bearing
1st Speed Gear Bearing
Reverse Idler Gear Bushing
Counter Shaft Front Bearing
Counter Shaft Rear Bearing
Counter Shaft Thrust Bearing
5th Speed Drive Gear Bearing
Slip Yoke Bushing
Slip Yoke Seal
Speedometer Drive / Driven Gears
Speedometer Driven Gear Housing
Input Shaft Seal
1 - 2 Synchronizer Assembly
3 - 4 Synchronizer Assembly
5th Synchronizer Assembly
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-7
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CROSS-SECTIONAL VIEW
YAD5B040
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-8 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
POWER FLOW
1st 2nd
YAD5B050 YAD5B060
3rd 4th
YAD5B070 YAD5B080
5th Reverse
YAD5B090 YAD5B100
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-9
YAD5B110
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-10 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
YAD5B270
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-11
YAD5B460
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-12 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-13
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-14 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B120
YAD5B130
YAD5B140
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-15
YAD5B150
YAD5B160
YAD5B170
YAD5B180
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-16 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B190
YAD5B200
Installation Procedure
1. Insert the shift rail to the cover.
YAD5B210
2. Pull the shift rail to the offset lever using the punch
and assemble them.
YAD5B220
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-17
YAD5B230
4. Push down the shift lever and the lining shift socket
from the control housing arm.
YAD5B160
YAD5B170
YAD5B240
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-18 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B250
YAD5B130
YAD5B260
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-19
TRANSMISSION
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative terminal from the battery.
2. Lift up the vehicle and fix it safely.
YAD5B280
YAD5B290
YAD5B300
YAD5B310
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-20 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B320
YAD5B330
YAD5B340
YAD5B020
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-21
YAD5B350
YAD5B360
YAD5B370
YAD5B380
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-22 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B390
YAD5B400
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission to the vehicle. At this time,
seat correctly the input shaft of the transmission
on the pilot bearing of the flywheel.
YAD5B410
YAD5B420
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-23
81 - 89 N•m
Front
Tightening (60 - 66 lb-ft)
Torque 70 - 90 N•m
Rear
(52 - 66 lb-ft)
YAD5B430
YAD5B440
YAD5B310
• Oil
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-24 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
UNIT REPAIR
MAJOR UNIT
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the shift lever from the extension housing.
YAD5B470
YAD5B480
YAD5B490
YAD5B500
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-25
YAD5B510
YAD5B520
YAD5B530
YAD5B540
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-26 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B550
YAD5B560
YAD5B570
YAD5B580
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-27
YAD5B590
19. Remove the slip yoke snap ring from the main
shaft.
YAD5B600
20. Remove the 5th speed drive gear snap ring from
the main shaft.
YAD5B610
YAD5B620
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-28 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B630
YAD5B640
YAD5B650
25. Remove the reverse fork and spring from the case.
YAD5B660
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-29
YAD5B670
YAD5B680
YAD5B690
YAD5B700
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-30 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
Assembly Procedure
1. Using a hydraulic press and a supporting tool,
press the counter shaft rear bearing into the case.
Be sure that the supporting tool inside of the case
should support the counter shaft.
YAD5B710
YAD5B720
YAD5B730
YAD5B740
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-31
YAD5B750
YAD5B770
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-32 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
12. Align the slots of the lever with the rollers of the
reverse fork and 5th shift rail. Apply sealer on the
5-R lever pivot bolt and install it into the case.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 28 N•m (21 lb-ft)
YAD5B780
YAD5B790
15. Using a snap ring piers, install the slip yoke snap
ring onto the end of the main shaft.
16. Make sure that the 1-2 and 3-4 synchronizer
sleeves and 5-R shift lever are in neutral position.
YAD5B800
17. Align the holes the case and cover with alignment-
type bolts. Tighten the 10 bolts.
Installation Notice
YAD5B810
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-33
YAD5B820
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-34 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
MAIN SHAFT
Disassembly Procedure
1. For correct reassemble, place an alignment mark
on the 3-4 Synchronizer hub and sleeve.
2. Using a hydraulic press and puller plate, remove
the 3-4 Synchronizer assembly and the 3rd speed
gear.
YAD5B850
YAD5B860
YAD5B870
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-35
YAD5B880
YAD5B890
YAD5B900
YAD5B910
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-36 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B920
YAD5B930
YAD5B940
YAD5B950
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-37
YAD5B960
Assembly Procedure
1. When assemble the synchronizer, make sure that
the hubs and sleeves are matched and the 3 keys
are installed properly. Also align blocking rings
with keys during installation.
Notice: Before assembly, coat all parts with
lubricant. In case of the paper-lined blocking rings,
soak them in DexronII/III before installation.
YAD5B970
YAD5B980
YAD5B990
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-38 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B0A0
YAD5B0B0
INPUT SHAFT
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the following parts from the input shaft :
• Main shaft thrust race and bearing.
• Main shaft pilot bearing rollers (15 rollers).
YAD5B0C0
YAD5B0D0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-39
YAD5B0E0
YAD5B0F0
Assembly Procedure
1. Using a hydraulic press and installer, press the
input shaft bearing onto the input shaft.
2. Apply grease to the thrust bearing inner roller (15
rollers) and install the main shaft thrust bearing
and its race in the rear of the input shaft.
YAD5B0G0
YAD5B0H0
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-40 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
COUNTER SHAFT
Disassembly Procedure
1. Using a hydraulic press and special tool, remove
the front bearing assembly from the counter shaft.
2. Check and clean all removed parts and replace if
necessary.
YAD5B0J0
Assembly Procedure
1. Using a hydraulic press and installer, press the
front bearing assembly onto the counter shaft.
YAD5B0K0
2. Install is as follows :
• Install a new O-ring on the counter shaft outer
race and lubricate it.
• Using a installer, lightly tap the race into its
bore until the O-ring is compressed.
• Install the race to be fully seated on the inside
of the case.
YAD5B0L0
EXTENSION HOUSING
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the vent from the extension housing.
2. Remove the O-ring and steel ring from the rear of
the extension housing.
3. Check and clean all removed parts and replace if
necessary.
YAD5B0M0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-41
Assembly Procedure
1. Install the O-ring and steel ring to the rear of the
extension housing.
2. Install the vent to the extension housing.
SHIFT COVER
Disassembly Procedure
1. Using a hammer and a pin punch (3/16) remove
the selector arm roll pin.
YAD5B0N0
YAD5B0P0
Assembly Procedure
1. If the shaft cup plug was removed, apply plug
outer surface with sealer and install it into the
cover.
YAD5B0Q0
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-42 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B0R0
YAD5B0S0
YAD5B0T0
YAD5B0U0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-43
YAD5B0V0
YAD5B0W0
YAD5B0X0
YAD5B0Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-44 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B0Z0
YAD5B1A0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-45
INSPECTION OF COMPONENTS
Inspection Procedure
1. Clean all parts with solvent and dry them with
compressed air. Check the following parts for
cracks and damaged sealing surfaces.
• Case
• Extension housing
• Shift Cover
• Input bearing retainer
• Counter shaft rear bearing retainer
YAD5B1B0 2. Check the parts which support bearings and shafts
for excessive wear and replace them if necessary.
YAD5B1C0
YAD5B1D0
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-46 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B1E0
YAD5B1F0
YAD5B1G0
YAD5B1H0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-47
YAD5B1J0
YAD5B1K0
YAD5B1L0
YAD5B1M0
SSANGYONG Y200
5B-48 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
YAD5B1N0
YAD5B1P0
12. Check the fit between the hub and sleeve of each
synchronizer
• Excessively tight or loose hub-to-sleeve fit.
• Wear of the cone clutch surfaces of brass
blocking rings and gears.
YAD5B1Q0
YAD5B1R0
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL TRANSMISSION 5B-49
YAD5B1S0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 5C
CLUTCH
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ..................... 5C-2 Maintenance and Repair ................................... 5C-10
General Description ............................................. 5C-2 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 5C-10
Bleeding of Clutch System ................................... 5C-3 Clutch Disc ........................................................ 5C-10
Specifications ...................................................... 5C-4 Master Cylinder ................................................. 5C-12
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 5C-5 Clutch Pedal ...................................................... 5C-13
Component Locator ............................................. 5C-6 Clutch Pedal Box ............................................... 5C-14
Cross Sectional View ........................................... 5C-6 Inspecton Procedure .......................................... 5C-15
Clutch Hydraulic Lines ......................................... 5C-7 Clutch Disc ........................................................ 5C-15
Clutch Disc Assembly ......................................... 5C-8 Clutch Pedal ...................................................... 5C-16
Clutch Pedal Assembly ....................................... 5C-9 Special Tools and Equipment ............................ 5C-17
Special Tools Table ............................................ 5C-17
5C-2 CLUTCH
Driven members
The driven member is the clutch disc with a splined
hub which is free to slide lengthwise along the splines
of the input shaft, but which drives the input shaft
through these same splines.
The driving and driven members are held in contact
by spring pressure. This pressure is exerted by a
diaphragm spring in the pressure plate assembly.
Operating members
The clutch release system consists of the clutch pedal,
the clutch release shaft, the clutch cable, the release
arm and the release bearing. When pressure is applied
to the clutch pedal, the clutch release shaft pushes
against the release bearing by rotating. The bearing
then pushes against the diaphragm spring in the
pressure plate assembly, thereby releasing the clutch.
YAD5C010
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-3
YAD5C040
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-4 CLUTCH
SPECIFICATIONS
Type Hydraulic
Clutch Pedal Type Suspended
Max. Pedal Stroke DSL 148 mm
GSL 150 mm
Pedal Free Play 5 - 10 mm
Clutch Disc Type Single Dry Diaphragm
Facing O.D. × I.D. × Thickness 240 × 155 mm
Facing and Quantity 22 cm2 × 1
Thickness of Disc Free 9.85 - 10.2 mm
With Load 9.2 mm
Clutch Cover Assembly Setting Weight 610 kg
Clutch Master Cylinder Stroke 28.4 mm
Inner Diameter Ø15.87 mm
Clutch Fluid DOT3 or DOT4
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-5
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-6 CLUTCH
COMPONENT LOCATOR
CROSS SECTIONAL VIEW
;;;;;
;;;;;;;; ;
;;;;;;;;
;; ;;
;;;; ;;;
;;;
;;;;
;; ;;;
;;;
;;;;
;;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;;
;;
;;;;;;;
;;;
;;;;
;;
;;
;;;;;;;
;;
;;;;;;;
;;
;;;;
;;;;;;;
;; ;;
;;
;;;;;;;
;;
;;;;;;;
;;;;;;; YAD5C050
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-7
YAD5C020
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-8 CLUTCH
YAD5C060
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-9
YAD5C180
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-10 CLUTCH
YAD5C070
YAD5C080
YAD5C090
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-11
Installation Notice
21 - 27 N•m
Tightening Torque
(15 - 20 lb-ft)
YAD5C100
YAD5C110
YAD5C120
YAD5C130
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-12 CLUTCH
YAD5C140
YAD5C150
MASTER CYLINDER
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Draw out the fluid.
2. Pull out the snap pin and clevis pin from the clutch
pedal connection.
3. Remove the clutch tube.
Installation Notice
YAD5C170
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-13
CLUTCH PEDAL
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Remove the turn over spring from the clutch pedal.
YAD5C190
2. Remove the snap pin and the clevis pin from the
clutch master cylinder push rod and separate the
push rod and the clutch pedal.
YAD5C200
YAD5C210
YAD5C220
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-14 CLUTCH
YAD5C230
YAD5C240
YAD5C250
YAD5C260
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-15
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CLUTCH DISC
1. Clutch Cover
• Check the diaphragm spring tip for wear and
height unevenness.
Unevenness Limit 0.8 mm
YAD5C270
2. Clutch Disc
• Check the facing for rivet looseness, excessive
runout, sticks, oil and grease.
• Measure the rivet head depth. If out limit,
replace the disc.
Wear Limit 0.3 mm
YAD5C280
YAD5C290
SSANGYONG Y200
5C-16 CLUTCH
YAD5C300
CLUTCH PEDAL
1. Pedal Stroke (A).
GSL 158 mm
Max. Stroke
DSL 148 mm
Notice: To adjust the pedal stroke, loosen the lock
nut (H) of the interlock switch (G) and turn the two
lock auto until the stroke is correct.
yyyyy
;;;;;
Free Play 5 - 10 N•m
Notice: To adjust the pedal free play, loosen the
lock nut (F) of the master cylinder and turn the
push rod until the free play is correct.
SSANGYONG Y200
CLUTCH 5C-17
YAD5C320 YAD5C330
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 5D1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Infromation and Operation .................. 5D1-2 Transfer Case Assembly .................................. 5D1-17
4WD Operation Overview ................................... 5D1-2 Disassembly and Assembly ............................ 5D1-18
System Structure ............................................... 5D1-3 Maintenance and Repair ................................. 5D1-20
2H Mode (Rear Wheel Drive) .............................. 5D1-5 On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 5D1-20
4H Mode (4WD Drive - High Speed) ................... 5D1-6 Maintenance of Transfer Case Lubricant ........... 5D1-20
4H Mode (4WD Drive - Low Speed) .................... 5D1-7 4H and 4L Indicator ......................................... 5D1-21
System Description ........................................... 5D1-8 TCCU Inspection ............................................. 5D1-21
Specifications .................................................... 5D1-9 Transfer Case Assembly .................................. 5D1-22
Diagnostic Infromation and Procedures .......... 5D1-10 TCCU .............................................................. 5D1-24
General Diagnosis ........................................... 5D1-10 Unit Repair ........................................................ 5D1-25
Self-Diagnosis Test .......................................... 5D1-11 Disassembly Procedure ................................... 5D1-25
Diagnostic Diagram ......................................... 5D1-15 Assembly Procedure ....................................... 5D1-35
Component Locator ......................................... 5D1-16
Cross Sectional View ....................................... 5D1-16
5D1-2 PART TIME - T/C
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-3
SYSTEM STRUCTURE
;;;
yyy
;;
yy;
y
;;
yy ;;;;;
yyyyy
; ;;
yyy
;
;;
yyyy
;;
;
yy
;
;;
y ;;;
yyy
y
yyy
;;;y
;
yy ;;;;;
;yyyyyy
; yyy
;;;
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
yy
;; ;;
yyyyy
;;;
yy
;;
y
;
y
;
;;
yy;
y;
y
;y
y ;
;;
yy
yyy
;;;;
y
;;
yy ; yyy
;;;
;
y
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy ;;
yy;;;
yyy
y
yy
;;
;
;;
yy
y
; ;
y;
y
;
y
;;
yy
;
y
;;
yy ;yyyyyy
;yyy
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;; ;;
yy;;;
yyy
;;;;;
y
;
;;
yyyy
;;
y
;
;;
yy
;;;
yyy
;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
y
;
yyy
;;;;;;
yyy ;;;;;
yyyyy
y
; y
;
;;
yy
;;;
yyy;;;;
yyyy
;
y;
y ;;
yy
;;;
yyy
;yyyyy
;;;;
y
; ;;
yy
;;;;
yyyy
;
yy
; ;;
yy
;;;;
yyyy yy
;; YAD5D010
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-4 PART TIME - T/C
Power Flow
Switch Transfer
2H, 4H↔4L
TCCU
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-5
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;
yyyyy
y
; yy
;;
;;
yy; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
; ;;
yyyy
y
;
;;
;
y y
;
;;;;;
y
;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
y
; ;;
;
yy ; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
;;
yy ; ;;
yyy
;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
;;
yy
;
y ;
y
;;
yy ;
y
yyyy
;;;; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
; ;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
yy
;;;
y ;
y
;;yyy
yy;;;
yyy
;;
yy
;
y ;;
yy yyyyyy
;;;;;;
y;yyyyyyyyyy
y
yyy
;;;
;;;;;;;;;;
;;; ;;;
yyy
; ;;
yyy
;
;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
yy
;
y;
yy
;;;
y ;
y
yyy
;;;
y;yy
;;;
yyy
;;
yy ;; ;yyyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy ;;
yy ;;;;
yyyy
yy
;;
;
y
yyy
;;;
;;;
yyy ;
y
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy y;yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
yyy
;;;;;;;
yyyy ;
y
;;
yy;;;
yyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;
y
;
yyy
;;; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
y
;
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;
y yy
;; ;;
yy
;yyyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;
yy
yy
;; ;;
yy
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;;
yy yy YAD5D020
Power Flow
Transmission Output
Shaft
Rear Wheel
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-6 PART TIME - T/C
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;
yy
yyyyy
;;;;;
y
;yy
;;;
;;
yy yyyyyy
;;;;;;
; y
;
;;
yy
;;
yy ;
yy
;
yyyyy
;;;;;
y
;
yyyy
;;;;
y
; ;;
;
yy; yyyyyy
;;;;;;
y
;;;
yyy
yyyyyyyyyy
;;
yy ; y
;
;;
yy
;;;;;;;;;;
;;
yy
yy
;;;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
;
yy
;
;;
yy;
y yyyyyy
;;;;;;
y
;;;
yyy
yyyyyyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyy
;;;; ; ;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
yy
;;
;
y ;
y
;;
yy;yyyyyyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;
y
;;
yy;;
yy
;;;
yyy y
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
yyy
;;;
;;;;;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
; y
;
yy
;;
yy
;;
yy ;;;;
yyyy
;
yy
;;
;
y;
y ;
y
;yy
y
;;;
yyy
;;
yy;;
;;;
yyy ;y yy
;;
;;
yy
;;;
yyy ;;;;
yyyy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;
y
;;;
yyy
;;;
yyy ;
y
;;
yy;
y
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
;;;
;;;;
yyyy
yyy ;
y
;;
yy;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;
yyyy
;
;;; yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
yyy y
;
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;
y yy
;;;;
yy
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy;;
yy
yyyyyyy
; ;;
yy
;;;;;;
;;
yy
yy
;;;;
yy
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;;
yy yy YAD5D030
Power Flow
Transmission
TCCU Motor
Input Shaft
Magnetic
Clutch
Chain
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-7
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;
yyyyy
y
; yy
;;;
;;
yy ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
; ;;
yyyy
y
;
;;
;
y y
;
;;;;;
y
;
yyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
y
; ;;
;
yy; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
;;
yy ; ;;
yyy
;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
;;
yy
;
y ;
y
;;
yy;
y
yyyy
;;;; ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
; ;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
yy
;;;
y ;
y
;;;
yyy
;;
yy ;yyyyyyyyyy
y
;;;
yyy
;;
yy
;
y ;;
yy yyyyyy
;;;;;;
y
yyy
;;;
;;;;;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
; ;;
yyy
;
;;
yy;;;;
yyyy
yy
;
y;
yy
;;;
y ;
y
;;;
yyy
;yy
y
;;;
yyy
;;
yy ;; ;yyyyyy
;;;;;;
y
;;;
yyy
;;
yy ;;;;
yyyy
yy
;;
;
y
;;;
yyy
;;;
yyy ;
y
;;
yyyyyyyy
;;;;;;
;
y
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
yyyy
;;;;
;;;
yyy ;
y
;;
yyyyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy y
;
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
;;;
yyy y
;
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;
y yy
;; ;;
yy
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
; ;;
yy
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy
yy
;; ;;
yy
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;;;
yy yy YAD5D040
Power Flow
Transmission
TCCU Motor
Input Shaft
Hub
Planetary Gear
(2.483)
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-8 PART TIME - T/C
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Transfer Case Control Unit (TCCU)
TCCU is located under the front left handed seat and
permits the vehicle to shift from two-wheel drive to
four-wheel drive (and back shift) according to drivers
switch operation during driving (For the shifting
between 4WD HIGH and 4WD LOW, stop the vehicle).
YAD5D050
1. Shifting from 2H to 4H
• Position the transfer case switch from ‘2H’ to
‘4H’.
• Shifting is possible during driving.
• ‘4WD Hl’ indicator light will turn on.
2. Shifting from 4H to 2H
• Position the transfer case switch from ‘4H’ to
‘2H’.
• Shifting is possible during driving.
• 4WD Hl’ indicator light will turn off.
YAD5D060
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-9
SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-10 PART TIME - T/C
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-11
SELF-DIAGNOSIS TEST
System Description
1. TCCU detects transfer case system malfunctions
and indicates malfunctioning part(s) through
flashing 4H,4L indicator lights.
Using a service connector, connect it to the
diagnosis box in the engine room and read the
flashing of the “4WD CHECK” indicator light.
The flashing indicator light will show you defective
code(s).
2. Identify 7 defective codes after reading the
YAD5D080 flashing indicator light.
• TCCU
• Shift motor
• Magnetic synchronizer clutch
• Speed sensor
• Hub solenoid
• Selector switch
• Motor position sensor
YAD5D090
YAD5D100
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-12 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D120
YAD5D130
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-13
Diagnostic Table
Connect a service connector. If turn the ignition switch
“ON” “4WD CHECK” indicator light will come on for
0.6 second and turn off for 3 seconds and then display
a defective code 3 times continuously.
4WD CHECK
1 Light TCCU
ON
OFF
YAD5D140
4WD CHECK
2 Light Shift Motor
ON
OFF
YAD5D150
4WD CHECK
3 Light Synchronizer Clutch
ON
OFF
YAD5D160
4WD CHECK
4 Light Speed Sensor
ON
OFF
YAD5D170
4WD CHECK
YAD5D180
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-14 PART TIME - T/C
4WD CHECK
6 Light Selector Switch
ON
OFF
YAD5D190
4WD CHECK
7 Light Motor Position Sensor
ON
OFF
YAD5D200
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-15
DIAGNOSTIC DIAGRAM
YAD5D210
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-16 PART TIME - T/C
COMTONENT LOCATOR
CROSS SECTIONAL VIEW
yyyyyy
;;;;;;
;;
yy ;;
yy ;;;;;
yyyyy
;
yyy
;;
;;
yy
;
y yy
;;
yy
;;
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;
y;
y
;;
yy yy
;; ; ;;;;;
yyyyy
;
yy
;
yy
;;
;
y
;;
yy
;
y;;;
yyy
;;
yy
;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
yyyy
;;;;
;
y y
; ;;;;;
yyyyy
yyy
;;;
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
;
y
yy
;;;;;
yyy
yy
;;;;
yyy
;
;;
yy
yyyy
;;;;
y
; ;;
yy
;;
yy ; ;;;
yyy
;;;
yy
;;;;;;;;;;
yyyyyyyyyy
y
;
y;;
;;
yy
y
;;;;;
yyy
yy;;
yy
; y
;
;;;
yyy
;;
yy y;
;
yy
;;y;;
yy;;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
; ;;;
yyy
;;;
yyy;
yyy
;;
;;
yy;;;
yyy
yy
;;
;;
yy
;;;
yyy;;
yy ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;
yyyyyyy
;;;;;;;
;;
yy;;;;
yyy ;;
yy
;;;
yyy ;;
yyy
;;;;;;;
yyyyyy
yyy
;;;
;;;
yyy y
;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;
yyy ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
y
;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;
yyy ;;
yy
y
; ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy;;
yy
;;;;
yyyy
;;
yy
y
; ;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy;;
yy
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;
yyyyy
y
; yy
;;
;;
yy;;;;;
yyyyy
;;
yy
;;;;;
yyyyy
yy
;;
YAD5D250
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-17
YAD5D260
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-18 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D370
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-19
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-20 PART TIME - T/C
2. Oil Change
• Clean the oil level plug and surrounding area
• Place a suitable container under the transfer
case.
• Remove the oil and tighten the drain plug.
• Fill the oil through the oil level plug until oil
;;;;;;
begins to drip out.
• Tighten the oil level plug.
YAD5D230
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-21
4H AND 4L INDICATOR
When the ignition switch turns on, 4H and 4L indicators
turn on for 0.6 seconds and turn off.
YAD5D240
TCCU INSPECTION
Notice:
• DC 12V for the TCCU operation should be
maintained.
• In case of J1-8 and J1-15, indicator light will turn
on for 0.6 second when turn the ignition switch ON.
• If 4H and 4L indicator lights remain turned on when
turn the ignition switch on or during driving, perform
the TCCU diagnosis.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-22 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D270
YAD5D280
YAD5D290
YAD5D300
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-23
YAD5D310
YAD5D320
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-24 PART TIME - T/C
TCCU
1. Disconnect the negative terminal from the battery.
YAD5D330
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy YAD5D340
;;;;
yyyy
3. Remove the TCCU mounting bolt and remove the
TCCU.
• TCCU installation position : Under the driver’s
seat
;;;;
yyyy YAD5D350
;;;;
yyyy
4. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
Notice: Be careful not to give any impact to the
TCCU body.
;;;;
yyyy
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 10 N•m (89 lb-ft)
YAD5D360
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-25
UNIT REPAIR
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
Shift Motor Assembly
1. Separate the harness bracket.
2. Remove the shift motor mounting bolt and remove
the shift motor assembly.
YAD5D380
Companion Flange
1. Holding the companion flange, remove the nut and
washer and then remove the companion flange.
2. Remove the oil seal.
3. Remove the companion flange from the case
cover.
YAD5D390
YAD5D400
YAD5D410
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-26 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D420
5. Remove the snap ring and pull out the ball bearing
from the cover to remove the speed gear.
YAD5D430
YAD5D440
YAD5D450
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-27
YAD5D460
YAD5D470
YAD5D480
YAD5D490
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-28 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D500
YAD5D510
YAD5D520
YAD5D530
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-29
YAD5D540
YAD5D550
YAD5D560
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-30 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D570
YAD5D580
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-31
Cleaning Procedure
Notice: Before cleaning, check the magnet for the
presence of metal particles which indicate internal
chipping of the transfer case.
1. Using cleaning solvent, clean the residual oil and
dirt deposits.
Notice: During cleaning, be careful not to damage
the metal surfaces.
Inspection Procedure
1. Visually check the all removed parts.
Notice: Always replace the hose coupling, O-ring
and oil seal with new parts.
2. Inspection Terms
• Burr : Local rise of material forming protruding
sharp edge
• Chip : An area from which a small fragment has
been broken off or cut
• Crack : Surface break of line nature indicating
partial or complete separation of material.
• Excessive wear : Heavy or obvious wear beyond
expectations considering conditions of
operation.
• Indentation : Displacement of material caused
by localized heavy contact.
• Galling : Breakdown of metal surface due to
excessive friction between parts. Particles of
the softer material are torn loose and welded to
the harder material.
• Nick : Local break or notch, usually displacement
of material rather than loss.
• Scoring : Tear or break in metal surface from
contact under abnormal pressure.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-32 PART TIME - T/C
3. Specific Inspection
• Referring to normal gear tooth face, specifically
inspect the uneven wear and chips of gear tooth.
Replace or repair if necessary.
YAD5D590
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-33
YAD5D600
YAD5D610 YAD5D620
YAD5D630 YAD5D640
YAD5D650 YAD5D660
YAD5D670 YAD5D680
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-34 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D690
YAD5D700
YAD5D710
YAD5D720
YAD5D730
YAD5D740
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-35
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
• Use special tools during assembly of oil seals and
bearings.
• Lubricate bearings, oil seals and bushings before
assembly.
YAD5D750
YAD5D760
YAD5D770
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-36 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D780
YAD5D790
YAD5D800
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-37
YAD5D820
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-38 PART TIME - T/C
Input Shaft
Cross Sectional View
YAD5D830
YAD5D840
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-39
Oil Pump
1. Install the pump front cover to be the “TOP” mark
down and turn the cover to be the “TOP” mark up
when installed in vehicle.
2. Install the 2 pump pins and spring to the output
shaft.
Notice: Flat surface of the pins must point out
and align the center line of pins and spring.
Drive Chain
1. Position the drive sprocket to the rear output shaft
end and driven sprocket to the front output shaft
end.
2. Install the drive chain onto the sprocket.
3. Holding each sprocket to be the drive chain tight
and parallel with transfer case, install the drive
chain assembly to the output shafts.
4. Rotate the driven sprocket slightly to engage
splines on the front output shaft.
5. Install the spacer to the front output shaft and insert
YAD5D870
the snap ring into the shaft groove over spacer.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-40 PART TIME - T/C
Lockup Shift
1. Install the lockup hub and return spring to the
lockup collar and insert the snap ring.
2. Install the rail shaft through reduction shift fork
assembly previously installed and into the blind
hole in case.
3. Engage the lockup fork into the 2WD/4WD groove
and check operation.
4. Install the shift collar hub to the output shaft spline.
YAD5D880
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-41
Cover
1. Position the cover to be the open end up on the
work table.
2. Position the end of needle bearing to be
identification mark up and press into the cover
until upper end of bearing is 40.47 - 40.97 mm
below cover face that contacts with transfer case.
3. Press the ball bearing into the cover and install
the snap ring .
4. Install remaining parts as follows.
• Install the 4 O-rings on the stud bolts of the
YAD5D900
clutch coil assembly.
• Install the clutch coil assembly inside the cover
and tighten 3 nuts.
Installation Notice
Cover Assembly
1. Install the return spring over rail shaft in the transfer
case.
2. Insert the magnet into the transfer case slot.
3. Apply 1.6mm bead of Loctite RTV 598 to the
transfer case mounting surface.
Notice: For installation of cover, align the transfer
case with cover not to use excessive force.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D1-42 PART TIME - T/C
YAD5D920
YAD5D930
YAD5D940
SSANGYONG Y200
PART TIME - T/C 5D1-43
Companion Flange
1. Install the 2 plugs to the cover.
2. Install the companion flange, oil seal and washer.
3. Holding the companion flange, tighten the nut.
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 346 - 380 N•m
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 5D2
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-3
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-4 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SYSTEM STRUCTURE
yyy
;;;
¢
Q
; ¢
Q
;
;;;
yyy;
y
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
yy
;;
;
y
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;
@
À
À
@
;
;;;;;
;;;
yyy;;
yy
;
@
À
;;;;;
;
@
À
;;;
yyy;;
yy
;
y;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;
@
À
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
y;
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
yyy
;;;
;;
¢¢
QQ
;
Q
¢ ;;
QQ
¢¢
;@À ;;; ;
y
;;
yy
¢
Q
;;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;;
y
¢
Q
;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
@@
ÀÀ ;;
QQ
¢¢;
@
À
y
;;;;
yyy
yyy
;;;
;;;
yyy
yyy
;;;
;;
;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;;;;;;
;
Q
¢ ;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;;;;;;
¢Q;¢¢¢ ;;
QQ
¢¢
¢;
y
;
;;
yy
y
;
yy
;; ;
y
;;;
y
; y
;
;À@ À@;
;ÀÀ
@@
ÀÀ
;;
@@
À@;¢¢
;
Q
¢
;;
QQ
;;
y
À@;;
Q ¢
Q
; Q
¢
;;
QQ
¢¢
;
@
À ;;
@@
ÀÀ ;;
@@
ÀÀ
À
@
;
;;;
yyy
;;;
QQQ
; ;;
;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
ÀÀ
@@
;;
;;;
yyy;;;;
yyyy
ÀÀ
@@
;;
;;
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;
yy;;
;;;
¢¢¢¢
QQQQ
;;;;
y
;;;;
yyyy ;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;
yy¢
Q
;
;;
yy;;
;;;
¢
Q
;
;;;;
yyyy ¢
Q
;;;
;;;
;¢
Q
;
;;;;;;
yy YAD5D010
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-5
yyyyy
;;;;;
;;
;;;;;
yyyyy ;;
yy
;;;;;;
;;;;;;
;
y
;;;
yyy
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
y
;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;;
QQ
¢¢;;
yyyyy
y
;;
@
À
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;;;;
yyyy ;;
yy ;
y
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;;;;;;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;;;;¢¢
QQ
;; ¢
Q
;
;;;
yyy¢
Q
;
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;;;;
;
yy
;;
y
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;
Q
¢
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
QQ
¢¢
;
@
À;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
yyyy
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
¢¢
QQ
;; ;;
yy
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;
yyy
;;;;;;;;;;
;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
@
À ¢¢
QQ
;;
;
Q
¢ ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;;;;
yy
;;
;
y
;;;ÀÀ
;;
@@
;
Q
¢
¢
Q
;
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;
@
À
;;
yy
;;;
Q
¢;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;y
;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;;;;
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;;
yyyy
yyyy
;;;; ;; ;;;;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
¢¢¢¢¢
QQQQQ
;;;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
ÀÀ
@@
;; ;;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;
yyyy y
; ;;
yy
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
;;;;;
yyyyy ;;
;;;;;;
¢
Q
;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;
Q
¢;;;;;;
;;
yy;;
¢¢
QQ
;;
;
¢¢
QQ;
;;;
yyy
;;;;;
yyyyy;;;;;;
;
yy;;
;
;;;;;;;
Q
¢ ¢;
Q ¢
Q
;;;
yyy ;;
;;;;;;
; YAD5D020
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-6 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
Power Flow
Transmission Input
Rear Speed Sensor TOD Control Unit
Shaft
Magnetic Clutch
MAX DUTY
Multi-Plate Clutch
Chain
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-7
;;;;;
yyyyy
;;;;;
yyyyy ;; ;;
yy
;;;;;;
;;;;;;
;
y
;;;
yyyÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
y
;
;;;;
yyyy
¢¢¢¢
QQQQ
;;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;;;;
yyyyy
y
;;
@
À
¢¢¢¢
QQQQ
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy ;;
;;;;;;;;;;
¢¢
QQ¢¢
QQ
;;
;;
yy ¢
Q
;;
y
;;;
yyy
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
¢
Q
;
;;;;;;
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;
yy
;;
y
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;
Q
¢
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
QQ
¢¢
;
@
À
¢¢¢¢
QQQQ
;;;;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
yyyy
¢¢
QQ
;;
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;;;;;;;;;;
;;
yy
;;;;;;;;;;
À@;;;
¢¢
QQ ¢¢
QQ
;;
;
Q
¢
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
;;
@@
ÀÀ
yy
;;
;
y
;;;ÀÀ
@@@
ÀÀÀ ;;
@@
;
Q
¢
¢
Q
;
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;
@
À
;;;;
;;
yy
;;;
Q
¢ ;;;;;;
;;;
yyy;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;
;;;;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ y
;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;ÀÀÀ
;;;
@@@
;;;;
yyyy
;;;;
yyyy ;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
¢¢¢¢¢
QQQQQ
;;;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
ÀÀ
@@
;; ;;
;;;;;;
;;;;
yyyy ;;;;;
yyyyy
y
;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
;;;;;
yyyyy ;;
yy ;;
;;;;;;
¢
Q
;
;;;;;
yyyyy
;
Q
¢ ;;
yy ;;
;;;;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;
;
¢¢
QQ ;
;;;
yyy
;;;;;
yyyyy ;
yy ;;
;;;;;;
;
¢Q;;;;;;;
Q¢;Q¢
;;;
yyy ;;
;;;;;;
; YAD5D030
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-8 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
Power Flow
Transmission Input
Front Speed Sensor
Shaft
Multi-Plate Clutch
Chain
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-9
SPECIFICATIONS
Check Action
TOD Model TOD (Torque On Demand) Transfer Case (4423E)
Length 343.0 mm
Weight (w/oil) 37.9 kg
Shift Mode 4H and 4L
Gear Ratio High 1:1
Low 2.48 : 1
Oil Specification ATF S-3, S-4 or Dexron II, III
Capacity 1.4 L
Interval Inspect Every 15,000km,
Max. Torque Replace Every 50,000km
550 lb ft (76kg cm)
TOD Control Voltage Normal Range 9-16 V
Unit CAN Comm. 6-16 V
Current(Below Max. Ignition Switch OFF 2 mA
Operation Voltage) Ignition Switch ON 1A
Max. Operation Current Motor OFF 7A
Motor ON 20 A
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-10 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-11
COMPONENT LOCATOR
TRANSFER CASE CROSS SECTIONAL VIEW
;;;; ;;;
;;;;
ÀÀ¢¢
;;;; ;;;
;;
QQ ;;;;;;;;;;;
@@
;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ;;
yy
;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢
¢
Q
; ;;;;;;;;;;;
;;
yy
y
;
¢¢
QQ
;;;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;;
yyy
;;;
yy
;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;
yy
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ;;;
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ ;;;;;;;;;;;
yyy
;;;
;;
yy
¢¢
QQ
;;yy
;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
ÀÀÀ
@@@
;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ ;
Q
¢
;;;;
yyy
;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
yyy
;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
;
Q
¢ ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
¢
Q
; ¢¢
QQ
;;
;;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
yyy
;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
yyy
;;;
;;;;
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ ;;;;;;;
;
Q
¢ ;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;
yy ;;
yy
¢
Q
;;;
;;;;
yy
;;
yyy
;;;
¢¢
QQ
;;;
y;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;;;;;;;;;;
;;
yy
yyy
;;;
;;;;
Q
¢
;;;;
;
Q
¢
¢¢¢
QQQ
;;;
;;;;;;;
;
Q
¢
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;
Q
¢
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;
yy ;;
yy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢ ;;
QQ
¢¢¢
Q
;;;
yyy
;;;
;;;
yyy ;
y;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢ ;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;
yy
;;;;
;
Q
¢
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy;
Q
¢
;;;
@@@
ÀÀÀ;;
yy
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;
yy ;;;
yyy
;;;;;;
yyyyyy
;;;;;;;;;;; ;;
QQ
¢¢
;;;
yyy
;;;;
yy
;
Q
¢ ;;
yy
;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢ ;
Q
¢ ;;
;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;;; ; yyyyyy
;
Q
¢
@
À ;;;;;;
;;;
yyy
;;
;;;
yyy
;;
;
;;
yy
;
Q
¢
yy
;;
;;
yy
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢ ;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;;
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢ ;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;
yy
;
Q
¢ ;;
;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;;;;;
yyyyyyy
;;
yy
;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢ ;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;
@@
ÀÀ
;;;
QQQ
¢¢¢
@
À ;;;
yyy
; yyyyyy
;
@
À
;;;;;;
; ;;
yy
yyy
;;;
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
ÀÀ
@@
;;
;;;;
QQQQ
¢¢¢¢
;;
yy ;;
yy
;;;;;;;
;;;
;;
QQ
¢¢ yyyyyyy
;;
QQ
¢¢
;;
yy
;;;
yyy
;;;
yyy
YAD5D040
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-12 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
1 Case 37 Chain
2 Bearing 38 Cover
3 Ring Gear 39 Bearing
4 Oil Seal 40 Oil Seal
5 Retaining Ring 41 Dowel Pin
6 Input Shaft 42 Bearing Sleeve
7 Carrier 43 Seal
8 Pinion Gear 44 Snap Ring
9 Pinion Shaft 45 Center Bearing Support
10 Thrust Washer 46 Ball Bearing
11 Needle Roller 47 Dowel Pin
12 Spacer 48 Viscous Coupling
13 Bearing 49 Pinion Gear
14 Bushing 50 Thrust Washer
15 Sun Gear 51 Pinion Shaft
16 Thrust Plate 52 Thrust Washer
17 Hub 53 Thrust Washer
18 Bearing 54 Bushing
19 Snap Ring 55 Output Shaft
20 Snap Ring 56 Ring Gear
21 Snap Ring 57 Retaining Ring
22 Hub Reduction 58 Needle Bearing
23 Shift Fork 59 Ball Bearing
24 Spacer 60 Speed Gear
25 Shaft Shift 61 Flange
26 Spring 62 Oil Seal
27 Cam 63 Washer
28 Breather Hose 64 Nut
29 Breather Plug 65 Flange
30 Shift Rail 66 Dust Deflector
31 Intermediate Shaft 67 Tone Wheel
32 Thrust Washer 68 Bolt
33 Pump 69 Motor
34 Clamp Hose 70 Bolt
35 Upper Sprocket 71 Cap Screw
36 Thrust Washer
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-13
YAD5D050
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-14 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
TOD SYSTEM SELECT MODE COMPONENT FUNCTION
4H is the mode when drive normally of which gear ratio Shift Motor
is 1 : 1 and 4L mode distributes power to front and
It locates backside transfer case, which drives rotary
rear wheels 50 : 50 of which gear ratio is 2.48 : 1.
helical cam. When mode select switch changes to 4L,
shift fork is on position for 2.48:1 by rotation of helical
cam.
Transfer Case
TOD transfer case distributes power into front and rear
axle by operation of 4H/4L switch and shift motor.
Shifting 4H to 4L, is performed towards reducing HI-
LO collar by means for connection HI-LO shift fork with
output shaft in order to join with planetary gear. Torque
transmits input shaft then sun gear rotating front
planetary gear. Front planetary gear join with output
shaft and drives LO position.
YAD5D060
TOD Control Unit
TOD control unit is located on the floor under the driver
TOD system controls clutch mechanism to comply with
seat.
rotation in front and rear propeller shaft and if its
difference exceeds the permissible range,
corresponding power is distributed into front wheel
through EMC (Electro-Magnetic Clutch). Hall effect
sensor signals speed on front and rear propeller shafts
going through with TOD control unit.
Transfer case clutch coil is activated by variable current
on exceeding difference of speed in front and rear
propeller shafts.
Select 4L Mode
When select 4L mode, EMC is locked to apply
maximum torque into front and rear propeller shafts.
Shift motor rotates also 4L position by rotation of cam
YAD5D070
thus propeller shaft torque changes from 1 : 1 to 2.48 : 1
by planetary gear set.
Shape and function of TOD Control Unit
Deselect 4L Mode
When select 4H mode, the 4WD mode is deselected
and returns the 4WD - high speed mode.
YAD5D080
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-15
YAD5D110
YAD5D090
Pin Function
H Clutch Coil
I Front Speed Return
J Front Speed
K Front Speed Sensor Voltage Supply
L Rear Speed Sensor Voltage Supply
M Rear Speed
N Rear Speed Return
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-16 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
DEFINITION OF TERMINOLOGY
Definitions Description
Rear Speed Sensor A Hall Effect speed sensor which produces a square wave. 0-5Vdc signal in response
to a rotating 30 tooth wheel coupled to the rear propeller shaft inside the Transfer
Case.
Each rotation of the rear propeller shaft will result in 30 speed sensor pulse.
YAD5D120
Front Speed Sensor A Hall Effect speed sensor which produces a square wave. 0-5Vdc signal in response
to a rotating 30 tooth wheel coupled to the front propeller shaft inside the Transfer
Case.
EMC (Electromagnetic Each rotation of the front propeller shaft will result in 30 speed sensor pulse.
Clutch) An Electromagnetic clutch used to control the amount of torque applied to the front
propeller shaft.
TOD TOD is an abbreviation of Torque On Demand and means that the torque is transferred
according to the operating condition.
TPS (Throttle Position TPS is an abbreviation of Throttle Position Sensor. For MSE engine, the potentiometer
Sensor) in the throttle actuator acts as TPS.
PWM PWM is an abbreviation of Pulse Width Modulation and is a type of output value
control by adjusting pulse width.
Duty Cycle Duty Cycle is the time the EMC is on divided by the period in which it is being modu-
lated.
Touch-off A minimum amount of duty cycle applied to the EMC.
Front Overrun A condition where the front propeller shaft is turning at a rate which is faster than the
rear propeller shaft.
Rear Overrun A condition where the rear propeller shaft is turning at a rate which is faster than the
front propeller shaft.
High Range The highest (numerically lowest = 1 : 1) gear ratio between the input and outputs of
the Transfer Case.
Low Range The lowest (numerically highest = 2.48 : 1) gear ratio between the input and outputs of
the Transfer Case.
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-17
Definitions Description
4H/4L Switch A switch which selects the desired gear ratio.
Electric motor which changes the Transfer Case range.
Shift Motor A set of 4 Gray code switches which provide feedback to the TOD indicating the
position of the Shift Motor.
Position Encoder A switch on vehicles equipped with a manual transmission which indicates that the
clutch pedal is depressed.
Neutral Safety Switch A switch on vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission which indicates that the
transmission is in neutral.
Shift Inhibit Speed The vehicle speed above which Transfer Case shifts are disallowed. Vehicle speed is
indicated by propeller shaft speed measurement.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-18 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
CONTROL UNIT
Input/Output diagram
TOD control unit and main wiring harness is linked by
30 pin connector. Each pin joins with switch and
actuator whose details refer to the below diagram.
YAD5D130
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-19
(1) K-LINE : It means that Communication line for coding and diagnosis with diagnostic scanning tool.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-20 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SYSTEM OPERATION
Initial Operation of TOD Control Unit
When ignition “ON”, “4L” and “4WD check” lamps
illuminates for 0.6 second to check bulb in instrument
panel, then perform diagnosis of system (See 3F-19
Self-Diagnosis Condition).
Position Encoder
The Position Encoder is used by the TOD to determine
the position of the Shift Motor. Each motor position is
identified by a position code below.
Notice:
• All other position codes are invalid
• Position
Input Open Circuit (> 4.5V) = 1
• Position Input shorted to Speed/Position Return
(< 0.5V) = 0
Position Code 1/2/3/4 Motor Position Position Code 1/2/3/4 Motor Position
1110 Left Stop 1001 Neutral
1010 Left of High 0001 Zone 2
0010 High 0101 Low
0000 Right of High 0100 Right Stop
1110 Zone 1 - -
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-21
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-22 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
A command to shift will only be acted upon if the TOD Indicator function on shifting
is reading a valid code at the time the command to Once a range change has been initiated the 4L Indicator
shift is made. will begin to blink at a rate of 0.3 seconds on, 0.3
After a shift has started, the TOD will power the shift seconds off until the shift is completed or canceled.
motor until the code for the requested position is read.
If an invalid code is read, the TOD will go into a default
mode.
During a shift attempt, the shift motor will be energized
for a maximum of 5 seconds.
Shift criteria
When a range change is initiated a Diagnostic Test
will be completed on the motor, speed sensors, and
position encoder. If the Diagnostic Test fails, the shift
will not be attempted. If all components are operating
properly, the TOD will attempt a range change after
the following shift criteria are met:
1. The transmission is in neutral for 2 seconds after
the shift is requested. YAD5D140
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-23
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-24 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
DIAGNOSIS
While the TOD is active it periodically monitors its inputs 5. If a shift command has been received, but not
and outputs. If a fault is detected the “4WD CHECK” acted upon when a failure occurs the TOD will
lamp is illuminated and a fault code is stored in the cancel the command and not respond to any
TOD memory. subsequent shift commands.
When requested, fault codes are downloaded to a 6. If a shift command is in progress when an invalid
diagnostic connector (K-line) serial communications position code is confirmed it will be halted and
using SCAN-100. the TOD will turn the motor toward the high
position. Afterwards the TOD will not respond to
DIAGNOSTIC TESTS any shift commands.
7. If the shift motor/position encoder assembly
TOD Internal Function failure (other than a motor failure which occurs
When the Ignition is turned on the TOD tests its ROM when the motor is energized) recovers
and RAM. If there is a fault, the TOD immediately resets continuously for one second the TOD will function
itself and re-tests the ROM and RAM. If the fault normally. The “4WD CHECK” lamp is turned off
persists the TOD continues to reset and re-test until but the fault code will remain in memory.
the fault is corrected or the ignition is turned off. All 8. A motor failure (i.e. open or short circuit) which
TOD functions are inhibited until the fault is corrected. occurs when the motor is energized can only be
The 4WD CHECK lamp is not illuminated if there is a cleared by cycling the ignition off-on.
ROM or RAM fault.
If the ROM/RAM passes the EEPROM memory is Front Speed Sensor Test
tested. If there is a fault the 4WD CHECK lamp is If a Front Speed Sensor fault is detected continuously
illuminated and the TOD continues to operate using for 0.5 second the 4WD CHECK lamp is illuminated.
the default calibration data stored in ROM. Fault codes The TOD then responds as follows:
are not stored when there is an EEPROM fault.
1. If the system is in High Range the TOD uses the
An EEPROM fault can only be cleared by cycling Rear Speed Sensor to determine the EMC Touch
ignition off-on. Off level and wheel slip control is suspended.
2. If the system is in Low Range, the EMC Duty Cycle
Shift Motor Assembly Test
is set to maximum (independent of vehicle speed)
If the TOD detects a shift motor or position encoder until the system is shifted out of 4L.
fault continuously for one second the “4WD CHECK”
3. All Electric Shift activity is halted until the Ignition
lamp is turned on and the appropriate fault code is
is cycled. If a shift is in progress it will be
stored in memory.
completed.
1. A shift motor fault when the motor is off is defined
If the Front Speed Sensor recovers continuously for
as follows:
O.5 second the TOD will function normally. The 4WD
• Motor H-L shorted to Ground CHECK lamp is turned off but the fault code will remain
• Motor L-H shorted to Ground in memory.
• Motor open circuit
Rear Speed Sensor Test
2. A shift motor fault when the motor is energized is
defined as follows: If a Rear Speed Sensor fault is detected continuously
for 0.5 second the 4WD CHECK lamp is illuminated.
• Motor H-L shorted to Ground The TOD then responds as follows:
• Motor L-H shorted to Ground 1. If the system is in High Range the TOD uses the
• Motor H-L shorted to Motor L-H Front Speed Sensor to determine the EMC Touch
• Motor open circuit Off level and wheel slip control is suspended.
3. A position encoder fault is defined as follows: 2. If the system is in Low Range, the EMC Duty Cycle
• Any position code which does not correspond is set to maximum (independent of vehicle speed)
to the valid 9 codes. until the system is shifted out of 4L.
• A short to ground on any of the encoder lines. 3. All Electric Shift activity is halted until the Ignition
is cycled. If a shift is in progress it will be
4. If no shifts are in progress when a failure occurs
completed.
the TOD will not respond to any shift commands.
If the Rear Speed Sensor recovers continuously for
0.5 second the TOD will function normally. The “4WD
CHECK” lamp is turned off but the fault code will remain
in memory.
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-25
EMC Test
The EMC is tested for open circuit or short circuit to
ground. If a fault is detected continuously for 0.8
second the “4WD CHECK” lamp is turned on and all
TODTM activity is halted.
If the EMC recovers continuously for 0.8 second the
TOD will function normally. The “4WD CHECK” lamp
is turned off but the fault code will remain in memory.
CODING ON TOD
Connection of Coding Tool
Construct SCANNER into diagnosis connector (20
pins) near fuse box in engine room as below figure.
1. Diagnosis Connector
2. SCANNER
Notice: Coding ; An input activity of data for the
proper performance by matching specification,
devices and system with control unit.
Coding required
1. Replacement of TOD control unit.
YAD5D150 2. Adjustment by input error.
3. Change of tire specification.
Coding method
1. Check and record engine type, axle ratio and tire
size.
2. Ignition “OFF”.
3. Connect SCANNER with diagnosis connector in
engine room.
4. Ignition “ON”.
5. Read the current memorized specification in TOD
control unit.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-26 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D170
YAD5D180
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-27
YAD5D190
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-28 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-29
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-30 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
Diagnostic Aids
• If the 4WD CHECK indicator illuminates steadily the
TOD may detect some fault. TOD should be
checked by scan tool to solve the problem.
• The 4WD CHECK indicator also illuminates steadily
if the terminal B2 of TOD connector is shorted to
ground. The shorted wire or terminals should be
repaired.
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-31
Diagnostic Aids
• If the 4WD LOW indicator illuminates steadily the
transfer case in 4WD low range and 4H/4L switch
set to 4L. It is normal condition.
• The 4WD LOW indicator also illuminates steadily if
the terminal B9 of TOD connector is shorted to
ground. The shorted wire or terminals should be
repaired.
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-32 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
Diagnostic Aids
If the both of the 4WD CHECK and 4WD LOW indicator
were not illuminating there would be some problems
with fuse, power supply line, improper connection of
connector or transfer case control unit (TOD).
If one of the indicators illuminates, the fuse and power
supply line is good and the connector or TOD may be
the cause of problems.
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-33
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-34 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-35
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-36 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-37
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-38 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-39
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-40 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-41
11 Replace TOD.
Is the repair complete? - System OK -
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-42 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-43
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-44 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-45
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-46 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-47
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-48 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-49
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-50 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-51
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-52 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-53
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-54 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-55
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-56 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-57
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-58 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-59
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-60 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-61
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-62 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-63
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-64 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-65
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-66 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-67
YAD5D200
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-68 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
03E-019
YAD5D220
03E-019
YAD5D230
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-69
03E-019
YAD5D240
YAD5D250
YAD5D260
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-70 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
yyyy
;;;;
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect (-) cable from battery.
2. Pull toward the driver seat and disconnect the 30
pin connector from TOD control unit.
;;;;
yyyy YAD5D280
;;;;
yyyy
3. Unscrew 2 bolts.
;;;;
yyyy YAD5D290
;;;;
yyyy
4. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
Notice: When replace TOD control unit, it is
required to make a coding correspondent with
vehicle specification.
;;;;
yyyy
Installation Notice
Tightening Torque 10 N•m (89 lb-in)
YAD5D300
SHIFT MOTOR
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect (-) cable from battery.
2. Disconnect shift motor/magnetic clutch coil
connector (black pin7) upper backside.
3. Unscrew 3 shift motor mounting bolts (M10).
4. Unscrew a bracket mounting bolt (M10).
Notice: When disconnecting shift motor and
mounting bracket, it is required to unscrew 2 units
of adjusting bolts (M10) form motor and bracket.
YAD5D310
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-71
03E-019
YAD5D330
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-72 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
03E-019
YAD5D340
03E-019
YAD5D350
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-73
Installation Notice
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-74 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
UNIT REPAIR
TRANSFER CASE, DISASSEMBLED VIEW
YAD5D360
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-75
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-76 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect transfer case from vehicle
2. Using a 30 mm thin-wall socket, first remove the
rear output nut, output shaft yoke washer, oil seal
then the case flange.
3. Disconnect shift motor/clutch coil connector and
speed sensor connector from upper bracket of
transfer case.
Notice: When disconnect connector, pull
forwards grasping connector housing.
03E-019
YAD5D380
YAD5D390
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-77
YAD5D400
YAD5D420
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-78 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D430
YAD5D440
YAD5D450
26. Remove the magnet from the slot in the front of the
case bottom.
27. Remove the output shaft and oil pump as an
assembly.
28. If required, to remove the pump from the output
shaft, rotate the pump to align.
29. Pull out the shift rail.
30. Remove the helical cam from the front case.
31. If required, remove the helical cam, torsion spring
and sleeve from the shaft.
YAD5D460
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-79
YAD5D470
Notice: Be careful not to damage the bearing,
bearing cage or case.
37. Remove the internal snap ring from the planetary
carrier.
38. Separate the front planet from the input shaft.
39. Remove the external snap ring from the input shaft.
YAD5D480
YAD5D490
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-80 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D500
YAD5D510
Assembly Procedure
1. Before assembly, lubricate all parts with Automatic
Transmission Fluid or equivalent.
2. If removed, drive the bearing into the front output
case bore.
YAD5D520
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-81
YAD5D530
YAD5D540
YAD5D550
12. Install the front planet to the sun gear and input
shaft.
13. Install the internal snap ring to the planetary carrier.
YAD5D560
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-82 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D570
YAD5D580
YAD5D590
19. Install the output shaft and oil pump in the input
shaft.
Make sure that the internal splines of the ouput
shaft engage the internal splines of the high-low
shift collar.
Make sure that the oil pump retainer arm and oil
filter leg are in the groove and slot of the front case.
YAD5D600
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-83
20. Install the magnet in the slot in the front case just
above the oil filter leg.
21. Install the front output shaft in the front case.
22. Install the thrust washer on the rear output shaft.
YAD5D610
YAD5D620
24. Install tone wheel onto the front output shaft. Make
sure the spline on the tone wheel engages the
spline on the front output shaft.
25. Install clutch pack assembly onto the rear output
shaft. Make sure the spline of the clutch pack
engages to the spline of the sprocket.
YAD5D630
26. Install snap ring onto the rear output shaft. Start
the snap ring over the spline and use the wave
spring to seat the snap ring in the snap ring
groove.
If the snap ring will not install, the thrust washer
inside the clutch pack may not be seated properly.
27. Install wave spring, insulator washer and armature.
(Three offset slots must align with housing to be
installed)
Notice: Three slots on the thrust washer must be
aligned with the three tabs on the clutch pack
housing.
YAD5D640
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-84 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D650
YAD5D660
YAD5D670
35. Install the clutch coil from inside the rear case until
the wire and studs extend through the cover.
Notice: Do not kink or trap the wire while seating
the clutch coil to the case.
YAD5D680
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-85
YAD5D690
43a
YAD5D700
YAD5D710
42. Install the pin on the tang end of the helical cam
into the hole in the front case. Position the torsion
spring tangs so that they are pointing toward the
top side of the transfer case and just touching the
high-low shift fork.
Notice: Do not bend the helical cam during
installation to the front case because of possible
damage to the pin at the tang end of the motor
shaft.
43. Install the shift rail through the high-low shift fork
and make sure that the reverse gear shift rail is
seated in the front case bore.
YAD5D720
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-86 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
YAD5D730
YAD5D740
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-87
YAD5D750
YAD5D760
YAD5D770
SSANGYONG Y200
5D2-88 TRANSFER CASE - TOD
SSANGYONG Y200
TRANSFER CASE - TOD 5D2-89
YAD5D780 YAD5D790
Bearing Removal/
Bearing Installer
Installer
YAD5D800 YAD5D810
Seal Installer
YAD5D820
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 6A
POWER STEERING
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ..................... 6A-2 Oil Quantity Check and Air Bleeding .................... 6A-9
Specifications ...................................................... 6A-2 Maintenance and Repair ................................... 6A-12
Diagnostic Information and Procedures .............. 6A-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 6A-12
Component Locator ............................................ 6A-4 Power Steering Pipe/Hose .................................. 6A-12
Power Steering System Locator ............................ 6A-4 Power Steering Box Assembly ........................... 6A-13
Steering Gear Box Cross Section ......................... 6A-5 Steering Gear Pump .......................................... 6A-14
Power Steering Assembly .................................... 6A-6 Assembly Installation ........................................ 6A-14
General Inspection ............................................... 6A-7 Unit Repair .......................................................... 6A-17
Oil Pump Pressure ............................................... 6A-7 Steering Gear Box ............................................. 6A-17
Power Steering Gear Preload Adjustment ............. 6A-8 Special Tools and Equipment ............................ 6A-23
Oil Change .......................................................... 6A-8 Special Tools Table ............................................ 6A-23
6A-2 POWER STEERING
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-3
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-4 POWER STEERING
COMPONENT LOCATOR
POWER STEERING SYSTEM LOCATOR
1
A
YAD6A020
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-5
10
6
5
1 3 4
2
8 7
9
YAD6A030
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-6 POWER STEERING
12
2
11 10 1
13
14
9
3
9
11
10 4
6
8
7
YAD6A150
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-7
GENERAL INSPECTION
OIL PUMP PRESSURE
Do the pressure checking followed to check the defect
of power steering pump.
Notice: Before checking, check the power steering oil
level and belt tension. When tightening of removing
the fitting, prepare the oil container because the oil
may drop down.
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-8 POWER STEERING
YAD6A050
OIL CHANGE
1. Lift the vehicle slightly using the lifter.
2. Separate the oil supply hose from the power
steering pump.
3. Discharge the oil in the oil tank.
4. Connect the oil supply hose with the power
steering pump.
MAX 5. Separate the oil return line from the oil tank.
MIN
6. Remove the high pressure cable in the ignition
coil.
7. Operating the ignition motor periodically, turn the
YAD6A070
steering wheel from lock to lock and discharge
the oil through the return line.
8. Connect the return line with the oil tank.
9. Charge the oil in the oil tank as specified quantity.
10. Do bleeding procedure.
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-9
YAD6A080
Air Bleeding
1. Disconnect the fuel line. Using a starter motor,
crank the engine and turn the steering wheel from
lock to lock several times.
2. Connect the fuel feed line and start the engine at
idle steed.
3. Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock until there
is no more air in oil reservoir.
4. Connect the oil lever is within specification.
5. By turning the steering wheel left to right, check
the oil level change.
YAD6A090 Notice:
• Do bleeding with engine cranking. If bleed with
idling, there con be a air contact with oil.
• If oil is not changes more than 5mm, do bleeding
again.
• If oil level rises suddenly when stopped engine,
do bleeding again.
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-10 POWER STEERING
YAD6A100
YAD6A110
Standard Max. 30 mm
YAD6A130
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-11
YAD6A140
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-12 POWER STEERING
YAD6A160
YAD6A170
YAD6A180
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-13
YAD6A190
YAD6A200
YAD6A210
YAD6A220
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-14 POWER STEERING
YAD6A230
YAD6A240
ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering pump in engine and
tighten the bolt/nut as specified torque.
Nut Torque
Upper 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
Bolt
Lower 23 N•m (17 lb-ft)
YAD6A250
Installation Notice
70 - 90 N•m
95 mm Bolt/Nut (Upper)
(52 - 66 lb-ft)
70 - 90 N•m
95 mm Bolt/Nut (Lower)
YAD6A260 (52 - 66 lb-in)
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-15
Installation Notice
70 - 90 N•m
Center Bolt/Nut
(52 - 66 lb-ft)
70 - 90 N•m
Left Bolt/Nut
(52 - 66 lb-in)
YAD6A270
YAD6A280
YAD6A290
Installation Notice
6. Install the clamp of return pipe in front end panel.
Installation Notice 7 - 10 N•m
Tightening Torque
(62 - 89 lb-in)
YAD6A300
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-16 POWER STEERING
YAD6A310
YAD6A320
YAD6A330
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-17
UNIT REPAIR
a
STEERING GEAR BOX
Disassembly
1. Disassembly the tie rod end boot (a).
YAD6A340
YAD6A350
4. Remove the lock nut (1) and separate the plug (2)
1 and spring (3).
YAD6A360
5. Remove the dust cover (1) and pull off the retainer
1 ring (2).
YAD6A370
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-18 POWER STEERING
3
YAD6A380
YAD6A390
YAD6A400
YAD6A410
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-19
YAD6A420
2
1
YAD6A430
3. Check the tie rod end, rack and pinion bellows for
the damage.
• Check the tie rod end boot (1) for the crack or
wear.
1
• Check the rack and pinion boot for the crack or
2 wear.
YAD6A440
YAD6A450
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-20 POWER STEERING
5. Check the tie rod end and ball joint for the damage.
• Check the tie rod end ball joint for the normal
operating,
• Check the tie rod ball joint for the normal
operating and the deflection by the self-weight
of tie rod.
6. After checking, if out of specified value or
damaged, replace them with the new one.
YAD6A460
7. Check the tie rod end and the rotation part of ball
joint for the damage.
YAD6A470
8. Check the tie rod end and rack/pinion boot for the
crack and wear.
9. Check the metal part for the damage.
• Check the pinion gear for the damage or wear.
• Check the rack gear for the damage or wear.
• Check the steering gear housing for the damage
or wear.
YAD6A480
10. Check the bearing and oil seal for the damage.
1 • Check the pinion shaft seal for the wear or
leakage.
2
• Check the needle bearing for the wear.
• Check the steering pinion bearing for the wear.
11. After checking, if out of specified value or
damaged, replace them with the new one.
YAD6A490
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-21
Assembly
1. Install the steering pinion assembly gear.
• Install the retaining ring.
1 • Install the needle bearing.
• Tapping the pinion shaft seal carefully in
diagonal direction using the thin draft (1),
assemble them.
YAD6A500
4
YAD6A510
5
YAD6A520
YAD6A480
SSANGYONG Y200
6A-22 POWER STEERING
YAD6A530
YAD6A540
SSANGYONG Y200
POWER STEERING 6A-23
YAD6A550
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 6E
STEERING COLUMN
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ............... 6E-2 Steering Column & Wheel ................................ 6E-7
Steering Wheel ................................................. 6E-2 Maintenance and Repair .................................. 6E-8
Column & Shaft Assembly ............................... 6E-2 On-Vehicle Service .............................................. 6E-8
Lower Shaft ....................................................... 6E-2 Steering Column ............................................... 6E-8
Tightening Torque ............................................. 6E-3 Steering Wheel & Shaft ................................... 6E-11
Diagnostic Information and Procedures ........ 6E-4 Unit Repair ........................................................ 6E-15
Component Locator ......................................... 6E-5 Steering Gear Box ...........................................6E-15
Steering Column Assembly .............................. 6E-5 Special Tools And Equipment ........................ 6E-16
Steering Assembly Cross Section ................... 6E-6 Special Tools Table ......................................... 6E-16
6E-2 STEERING COLUMN
STEERING WHEEL
YAD6E020
LOWER SHAFT
YAD6E010
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-3
TIGHTENING TORQUE
Item Torque
Steering Column Shaft Steering Column Mounting Bolt (upper) 20 - 25 N•m (15 - 18 lb-ft)
Steering Column Mounting Bolt (lower) 20 - 25 N•m (15 - 18 lb-ft)
Steering Wheel and Steering Column shaft Lock Nut 40 - 60 N•m (30 - 44 lb-ft)
Steering Column and Airbag Module Connection Bolt 7 - 11 N•m (62 - 97 lb-in)
Steering Column and Lower Shaft Connection Bolt 25 - 30 N•m (18 - 22 lb-ft)
Power Steering Gear Steering Gear Box and Gear Box Cross Member 70 - 90 N•m (52 - 66 lb-ft)
Box Mounting Bolt
Steering Gear Box and Lower Shaft Connection Bolt 25 - 30 N•m (18 - 22 lb-ft)
Tie Rod End and Steering Lock Connection Nut 35 - 45 N•m (26 - 33 lb-ft)
Tie Rod End Lock Nut 65 - 80 N•m (48 - 59 lb-ft)
Steering Gear Box and Pressure Hose Connection Nut 15 - 20 N•m (11 - 15 lb-ft)
Steering Gear Box and Return Line Connection Nut 15 - 20 N•m (11 - 15 lb-ft)
Power Steering Pump Power Pump Bracket and Timing Gear Case Cover 20 - 23 N•m (15 - 17 lb-ft)
Mounting Bolt
Power Pump and Pressure Hose Connection Nut 40 - 50 N•m (30 - 37 lb-ft)
Power Steering Line Return Line and Cilp Connection Bolt 9 - 14 N•m (80 - 124 lb-in)
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-4 STEERING COLUMN
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-5
COMPONENT LOCATOR
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
YAD6E040
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-6 STEERING COLUMN
Side
Rear
YAD6E050
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-7
3
4
5
2
6
YAD6E060
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-8 STEERING COLUMN
YAD6E080
YAD6E090
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-9
YAD6E100
YAD6E110
YAD6E120
YAD6E130
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-10 STEERING COLUMN
YAD6E140
YAD6E150
YAD6E160
YAD6E170
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-11
YAD6E180
YAD6E190
Installation
B A 1 1. Insert the lower shaft into the gear box (spline part)
and then tighten the blots as specified torque.
Notice:
2 • Install the lower shaft to tighten the bolt in non-
spline part of upper spline part
• Install to align the assembly marking
Installation Notice
30 - 40 N•m
Tightening Torque
(22 - 30 lb-ft)
YAD6E200
YAD6E210
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-12 STEERING COLUMN
YAD6E230
YAD6E240
YAD6E250
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-13
Classification Color
Fuel Cut Vacuum Hose-Inlet Green
Fuel Cut Vacuum Hose-Outlet Blue
YAD6E260
YAD6E270
10. Install the fuse box in the panel, each cable and
switch. Insert the panel side cover.
Notice: The panel side cover should be inserted
to the inside of molding and then installed.
YAD6E280
YAD6E220
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-14 STEERING COLUMN
YAD6E290
SSANGYONG Y200
STEERING COLUMN 6E-15
UNIT REPAIR
1
STEERING GEAR BOX
Disassembly
1. Remove the steering column assembly from the
vehicle.
Notice: Be careful so that the steering column/
steering column shaft is not gotten the impact. If
being gotten the impact, in case of the frontal
collision, the plastic sleeve may be broken.
YAD6E300
YAD6E310
YAD6E320
Assembly
1. Assemble in reverse order of disassembly.
YAD6E330
SSANGYONG Y200
6E-16 STEERING COLUMN
SteeringWheel
Remover
YAD6E340
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 7A
YAD7A010
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-3
SPECIFICATIONS
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-4 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
YAD7A020
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-5
YAD7A030
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-6 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
YAD7A040
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-7
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-8 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-9
BLOWER ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-10 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
Check Action
Check Is the cable connected Yes Check the range of the door travel and the effort required to
connection and retained properly? move it.
and the No Connect and attach the cable properly.
attachment
Check the operation of the temperature control switch.
of the door
cable Does the door operate Yes If required, repair.
properly? No Recheck the system using “Control setting/Correct Results”
test.
Is there a problem with Yes Repair or replace the temperature control switch or the cable.
the temperature control No System OK
switch or wiring?
Is the system OK after Yes Check the airflow from the defroster or the vent outlets.
the repair complete? No System OK
Is the heavy airflow? Yes Switch the mode knob to defrost.
No Remove the heater outlet and then remove any obstructions
in the heater outlet.
Is the airflow proper? Yes Check the blower speed for change in the airflow as the
control is turned 1 to 4.
No Repair or replace any obstructions at heater and air delivery
case.
Does the blower motor Yes Go to “Blower Electrical”
speed increase? No System OK
Is the system OK after Yes Set the blower switch to 4th.
the repair complete? Rotate the temperature control from full cold to full hot.
No Listen to an airflow change.
Does the airflow change? Yes Repair or replace any obstruction between the blower and the
system outlets.
No Check and repair the door adjustments, the cables, the
linkage and the control.
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-11
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-12 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
HEATER CONTROLS
Check Action
Turn the Is excessive effort Yes Check the cable for improper routing, kinks, wiring
temperature required to move the interference or other instrument panel interference.
control control? No Set the blower switch to 4th.
switch
Repeat to turn the temperature control knob to full hot, then
rapidly to full cold
Does the control operate Yes Remove the cable from any door that binds on the cable.
properly? Cycle the door manually.
Check the door binding.
No Repair or replace the problem.
Is there any door Yes Check the door seal for proper installation.
binding? No Check the control for binding.
Does the control bind? Yes Reinstall the cable to the door.
Repair the instrument panel interference with the cable.
No Remove the cable from the control.
Check the control for binding.
Does the control bind? Yes Replace the control switch.
No Replace the cable.
Is excessive effort Yes Remove the cable from the control.
required to move the Operate the control switch.
control?
No System OK
Does the control operate Yes System OK
properly without any No Replace the control switch.
interference?
Is the installation good Yes Check a binding door for the shaft alignment, a bent shaft, a
condition? bent door or warped case and then repair as needed.
No Repair the door seal or replace as needed.
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-13
BLOWER NOISE
Check Action
Cycle Is the blower noise Yes Remove any obstruction or foreign material of the duct.
through the constant at high blower Check floor/defroster door seals.
blower speeds or certain modes,
Repair or replace as needed.
speeds, but absent at lower
the modes speeds or in other No Check for the vibration from the blower motor and fan
and the modes? assembly at each blower speed by feeling the blower motor
temperature housing.
settings in Check for the foreign materials at the opening of the blower
order to inlet.
find the Did you find the Yes Remove all foreign materials and repair or replace the blower
noise. excessive vibration and motor and fan assembly.
-Close all any foreign material? No Set the blower switch to 4th.
of the Check any noise from full hot to full cold temperature
doors and positions in the defroster, floor and vent modes.
windows.
Is the noise constant? Yes Remove any obstruction or foreign material of the duct.
-Turn the
ignition Check the floor/defroster door seals.
“ON”. Repair or replace as needed.
-Set the No Check any noise in the floor mode.
blower Is the noise constant? Yes Remove any obstruction or foreign material of the duct.
switch to Check the floor/defroster door seals.
4th.
Repair or replace as needed.
-Set the
No Check any noise in the vent mode.
control
switch to Is the noise constant? Yes Remove any obstruction or foreign material of the duct.
full hot Check the vent door seals.
position. Repair or replace as needed.
Is the blower noise Yes Check the temperature door seals
constant at any modes No Check the system for obstructions, foreign materials between
but absent at all modes the fan and the temperature door and then repair or replace
of temperature control the fan as required.
lever?
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-14 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
COMPONENT LOCATOR
AIRFLOW THROUGH VENTS WITH REAR HEATING DUCT
YAD7A050
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-15
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
AIR DUCT ASSEMBLY
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Remove the instrument assembly.
2. Remove the defroster nozzle retaining screws and
the defroster nozzle assembly.
YAD7A060
YAD7A070
YAD7A080
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-16 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
YAD7A090
YAD7A100
YAD7A110
YAD7A120
SSANGYONG Y200
HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM 7A-17
YAD7A130
YAD7A140
YAD7A150
YAD7A160
SSANGYONG Y200
7A-18 HEATING AND VENTILATION SYSTEM
YAD7A170
YAD7A180
YAD7A200
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 7B
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-3
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-4 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-5
;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;
ÀÀ
;;
@@
;;;;;
;;;;;
;;
@@
ÀÀ ;;;;;
;;;;;
;; ;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ;;;;;
;;;;;
;; ;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ;;;;;
;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ;;;;;
;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
;;;;;;;
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
@@@@@@@
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
;;;;;
;;;;;;;;
;;;;;
;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;; ;;
;;;;;;;;;;
;;
YAD7B010
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-6 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
Airflow - Typical
;;
;;
;; ;;
;; ;;; ;;;
;;;
;;
;;; ;;;
YAD7B020
YAD7B030
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-7
COMPONENT LOCATOR
A/C SYSTEM COMPONENT
YAD7B040
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-8 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B330
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-9
COMPRESSOR LOCATION
Gasoline Engine
YAD7B050
Diesel Engine
YAD7B060
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-10 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-11
YAD7B070
YAD7B080
1. High and low pressure are abnormally high. • Insufficient cooling and • Keep the specified
faulty condenser cooling amount of the
by excessive refrigerant, Clean the
refrigerant. condenser
• Repair the belt
YAD7B090
1. High and low pressure are abnormally high. • Belt is slipped • Clean and repair the
2. Connection at the low pressure is not cold. • There is an air in the receiver-drier
cooling system • Check the oil
contamination etc.
YAD7B100
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-12 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B110
1. The low-side pressure is high or normal inter- • The mixed moisture is • Repair the receiver-drier
mittently. frozen at the expansion and perform the
valve bleeding
YAD7B120
1. The low-pressure and high-pressure are exces- • The faulty expansion • Repair the receiver-drier
sive high. valve, the improper • Check the oil
2. There are a lot of moistures in the connection installation of the heat contamination etc.
of the low-side pressure reducer
• Fail to control the flow
rate
YAD7B130
1. The low-pressure is excessive high and high- • There is an oil leak in • Replace the compressor
pressure is excessive low. the compressor
YAD7B140
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-13
Discharging Refrigerant
1. Connect the manifold gauge to the charging valve.
2. Place the free end of the center hose in a shop
towel.
3. Slowly open the high pressure hand valve and
discharge refrigerant.
Notice: If refrigerant is allowed to escape too fast,
compressor oil will be drawn out of the system.
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-14 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
Important: R e f e r t o t h e m a n u f a c t u r e r ’ s
instructions for the charging station in use. It is
necessary to evacuate the system before
recharging it with new or recycled refrigerant.
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-15
Charging Refrigerant
Charging for Gas
1. Connect the tap valve to the refrigerant tank.
2. Open the low pressure and adjust the low-side
reading below 4.2 kg/cm 2.
3. Place the refrigerant tank in the warm water
(40 °C) and keep the gas pressure in the refrigerant
tank higher than the gas pressure in the charging
valve.
4. Run the engine at high speed and operate A/C
system.
YAD7B210
Notice: Place the refrigerant tank on the flat floor
to protect the liquid refrigerant from coming
through the suction inlet resulting in the
compressor’s damage.
Notice:
• If the charging speed is low, it’s more efficient
to place the refrigerant tank in the warm water
YAD7B220
(40 °C). But the temperature should keep below
(52 ° C) at any situation.
• Be careful not to contact the heating device or
material.
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-16 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
Operation Check
;;;;;
Notice: Operation Check is recommended before
removing the manifold gauge.
;;;;;
1. Install the manifold gauge set.
;;;;;
2. Run the engine at 2,000 rpm and set the blower
switch at ‘HI’ and A/C switch ‘ON’. Set the
temperature control lever at ‘COOL’.
3. Keep opening all of the window and door.
4. Place a dry bulb thermometer to the front duct.
5. Place a psychrometer close to the inlet of the
cooling unit.
YAD7B240
6. Check the high pressure gauge reading within
14 - 16 kg/cm2
If the reading indicates high excessively, spray
the water to the condenser.
If the reading indicates low excessively, cover the
condenser with the towel.
7. Check the temperature of air inlet within 25 - 35 °C.
8. Calculate the relative humidity from the
psychrometic graph comparing the wet/dry
temperature at the air inlet.
9. Measure the wet/dry temperature at the cold air
outlet and calculate the temperature difference of
the dry bulb between the inlet and the outlet.
10. Check the cross point of the relative humidity and
check the temperature difference between the
black line. If the cross point is located between
the black line, the cooling performance is normal.
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-17
COMPRESSOR OIL
REPLACEMENT
Before Oil Replacement
When any part is replaced or there are a lot of gas
leaks in the A/C system, you should add the specified
amount of the oil to keep the approval oil capacity
because the oil for lubricating the compressor
circulates through the A/C system during operating
the compressor.
Total Oil Capacity 265 cc
Handling Oil
• Be careful that moistures, dusts etc. must not flow
into the oil.
• Do not mix with any other material.
• If the oil leaves outside for long time, it’s possible
to mix it with the moistures and so keep the oil
sealed with a container.
Circulating Oil
For checking or adjusting the oil level, set the control
unit to full cold and max blower speed with keeping
the engine run at idle for 20 - 30 minutes in order to
circulate the oil through the compressor.
Replacement Oil
1. Perform the oil circulation and stop the engine.
Remove the compressor on the vehicle.
2. Drain the oil at the position of the system line
connection.
Notice: It may be difficult to discharge the oil when
the compressor is cold. At this time warm the
compressor (40 - 50 ° C) before discharging the
oil.
YAD7B250
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-18 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B260
REPLACEMENT OF REFRIGERANT
CONNECTION
1. When connecting a O-ring type, apply compressor
oil to portions shown in illustration. Be careful not
to apply oil to threaded portion.
Notice: Use the approval compressor oil.
YAD7B270
YAD7B280
YAD7B290
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-19
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
AIR FILTER (AUTO A/C)
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Remove the glove box.
2. Remove the lower bracket of crash pad.
3. Remove the air filter.
YAD7B300
YAD7B310
YAD7B320
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-20 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
RECEIVER-DRIER
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Discharge and recover the refrigerant from the
system.
2. Remove the head lamp assembly.
YAD7B340
YAD7B350
YAD7B360
YAD7B370
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-21
YAD7B380
CONDENSER
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Discharge and recover the refrigerant from the
system.
2. Remove the radiator grill and front bumper.
YAD7B390
YAD7B400
YAD7B410
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-22 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B420
GSL YAD7B430
DSL YAD7B440
YAD7B450
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-23
COMPRESSOR
Removal & Installation Procedure
1. Discharge and recover the refrigerant from the
system.
2. Remove the fan belt.
3. Disconnect suction/discharge hose from the
compressor.
• Remove the flange bolt retaining the hoses.
• Disconnect the hoses.
• Remove two sealing washer.
YAD7B460
YAD7B470
YAD7B480
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-24 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B490
Installation Procedure
Notice: Discard the used O-ring and sealing washer.
Installation Procedure
1. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
2. Tighten five bolts securing A/C module with the
specified torque.
3. Recharging the coolant.
4. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system.
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-25
UNIT REPAIR
COMPRESSOR
Disassembly and Assembly Procedure
1. Remove the compressor.
2. Remove the clutch driver.
• Install the compressor holding fixture to the
compressor and hold the compressor holding
fixture using a bench vise.
• Use the clutch hub holding tool to keep the
clutch drive plate and the hub assembly from
YAD7B510
turning to remove the shaft nut.
• Remove the snap ring using the ring plier.
• Remove the clutch drive using the special tool.
YAD7B520
YAD7B530
SSANGYONG Y200
7B-26 GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7B540
YAD7B550
YAD7B560
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL HVAC SYSTEM 7B-27
DW 100-010
Spring Clamp
Remover & Installer
YAD7B570
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 7C
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7C-3
SSANGYONG Y200
7C-4 MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SPECIFICATIONS
Component Description
Compressor Type Variable Displacement
Model Single V-5 Compressor
Dual V-7 Compressor
Gasoline 10PAIRC
Displacement Single 9.8 - 151 cc/rev
Dual 179 cc/rev
Gasoline 170.5 cc/rev
Max. RPM 6,000 - 7,500 rpm
Refrigerant Type R-134a
Capacity Single 850 ± 50 g
Dual 1200 ± 50 g
Oil Type Synthetic PAG Oil
Capacity 260 cc
Receiver-Drier Material Aluminum
Capacity 260 cc
A/C Condenser Max. Capacity 11,400 Kcal/h
Evaporator Size 263.0 x 228.6 x 88.9 mm
Capacity 6,500 Kcal/h
A/C Pressure Sensor High Pressure A/C ON/OFF 305/425 psi
Low Pressure A/C ON/OFF 39/30 psi
A/C Cutoff Pressure High Pressure 32 Kgf/cm2
Low Pressure 4 Kgf/cm2
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7C-5
SSANGYONG Y200
7C-6 MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7C-7
SSANGYONG Y200
7C-8 MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
1. Remove the center instrument panel.
YAD7C010
YAD7C020
YAD7C030
SSANGYONG Y200
MANUAL CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7C-9
YAD7C040
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 7D
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-3
FATC CONTROL
YAD7D010
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-4 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D020
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-5
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-6 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
Airflow Control
For setting at Full AUTO, it is possible to control the
blower motor operation both manually and
automatically in order to adjust the airflow according
to the set temperature.
Manual Control
When you push the blower switch, you can control the
blower motor manually and it increases or decreases
each step by moving the switch to HI/LO. (with the
ignition ON)
YAD7D040
Step Blower Voltage
1 4.5 V Blower Step Blower Motor Voltage
2 6.0 V 1 4.0 - 5.5 V
3 7.5 V 2 5.5 - 7.5 V
4 9.0 V 3 7.5 - 8.5 V
5 11.0 V
4 8.5 - 9.5 V
6 Max Hi 5 9.5 - 10.5 V
6 10.5 - 13.5 V
* The voltage of the blower motor may increase or
decrease (0.5 V) according to power voltage.
Vent Rate Control By Heating Operation
When the temperature of the engine coolant is low or
it’s difficult to obtain the desired hot air in winter, the
system controls to prevent the cold airflow from the
outlet due to the cold air give a negative effect to the
heating performance.
Therefore vent step is fixed 1st on blower AUTO step
until the coolant sensor detects above 20 °C and also
the blower step increases gradually according to going
up the coolant temperature. When the coolant
temperature goes up above 40 ° C, the heating
operation stops.
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-7
YAD7D060
Delivery Condition
For the initial installation (the initial current draw), the
initial mode follows;
Suction
Actuator Mode A/C Blower Mix
Air
YAD7D070
Condi- FOOT/ Td Basic
FRESH OFF OFF
tion DEF Control
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-8 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D080
AUTO Control
FATC Controller Illumination Control
When the tail lamp is ON, ATC Controller illumination
lamp turns on.
SYSTEM COMPONENTS -
CONTROL
Controller Assembly
The operation of the A/C system is controlled by the
switched on the control head. This console-mounted
controller consist of control knobs and a vacuum
YAD7D090 fluorescent display (VFD) indicating the status of the
control settings selected.
A/C Control
Sensors and Motors
Manual Control
• Inside air sensor, ambient sensor, coolant
When you pushed the A/C switch “ON” or the Def temperature and sun sensor
switch “ON”, A/C starts to operate.
• Door mode motor, intake air control door motor, air
AUTO Control mix door motor
Basic Control: A/C “ON” has the priority for the initial
operation. Inside Air Sensor
Inside air sensor located in left side of full automatic
Full Cold/Hot Control temperature control (FATC) controller, is a sensor that
When you sets the set temperature to full cold (LO) or detects the interior air temperature and a thermistor
full hot (HI), the system controls the temperature to that decreases its resistance when temperature up and
full cold or full hot regardless of sensor’s detection. increases when temperature down. If there is open or
For LO, it becomes A/C “ON”, front vent mode, short in the sensors, 25 ° C (77 ° F) will be substitute.
recirculation air, max blower speed, air mix door close Inspection
and for HI, A/C “OFF”, floor vent mode, ambient mode,
When the inside air temperature sensor error displays,
air mix door open.
check the followings;
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-9
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-10 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D120
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-11
YAD7D130 YAD7D140
Inspection Inspection
When the vent inlet mode displayed in the AUTO When the air mix door motor error displays, check the
temperature control is different from the actual mode, followings;
check the followings; 1. Turn the ignition ON.
1. Turn the ignition ON. 2. Measure the voltage within P1, P2 terminals
2. Measure the voltage between P1 - P5 and (+) (specified value; 12 V) and a,b (specified value;
terminal. (If it changes from 0V before the mode 5).
selection to 12 V after the mode selection, it’s 3. If the value is outside the specified value, check
normal) the open or short circuit.
3. If the value is outside the specified value, check 4. If the wiring is normal, replace the Mtr-Act, Temp.
the open or short circuit.
5. If the (+) (-) terminal connects to P1 and P2 of the
4. If the wiring is normal, replace the AUTO Mtr-Act, Temp alternately, the output by the each
temperature control. mode is following;
5. If the value is the specified value, replace the Mtr-
Act, AI. AMD Mode Bc Resistance
6. Check the motor operation connecting the (+) (-) Cool P1 (-), P2 (+) Below 300 Ω
terminal to the Mtr-Act mode and each terminal P1
Hot P1 (+), P2 (-) Above 2.4 KΩ
- P5 to (-) terminal sequentially using 12 V power.
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-12 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
Power Transistor
Power transistor controls the blower airflow and it
receives the airflow control signal from the AUTO
temperature control in order to for blower motor to shift
the speed without step by adding the current to the
power transistor basic current.
Inspection
When the power transistor error displays, check the
followings.
1. Turn the ignition ON.
2. Measure the voltage between blower connectors by
changing the step from 1st to 6th.
3. The voltage value by each step is the followings;
(specified value; 0.5)
4. If the value is outside the specified value, check
the open or short circuit.
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-13
SPECIFICATIONS
Component Description
Compressor Type Variable Displacement
Model V-5 Compressor
Displacement 9.8 - 151 cc/rev
Max. RPM 6,000 - 6,500 rpm
Receiver-Drier Material AL R/DRIER
Capacity 210 cc
Refrigerant Type R-134a
Capacity 750 ± 20 g
Oil Type Synthetic PAG Oil
Capacity 220 cc
Condenser Max. Capacity 11,400 Kcal/h
A/C Pressure Sensor High (Gauge Pressure) A/C ON 305 psi
A/C OFF 425 psi
Low (Gauge Pressure) A/C ON 39 psi
A/C OFF 30 psi
Blower Motor Max. Capacity 7,475 - 9,075 Kcal/h
Heater Core Fin Pitch 1.52 mm
Size 200.5 x 168.2 x 25.0 mm
Capacity 8,250 Kcal/h
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-14 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D150
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-15
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-16 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-17
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-18 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-19
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-20 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-21
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-22 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-23
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-24 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-25
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-26 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-27
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-28 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-29
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
1. Remove the center instrument panel.
YAD7D160
YAD7D170
YAD7D180
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-30 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D190
BLOWER MOTOR
1. Remove the glove box and put the floor mat aside.
2. Disconnect the connectors connecting the blower
motor.
YAD7D200
YAD7D210
YAD7D220
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-31
YAD7D230
YAD7D240
YAD7D250
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-32 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D270
SUN SENSOR
1. Remove the sun sensor from the instrument panel.
2. Disconnect the sensor connector and remove the
sun sensor.
3. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
Notice: For disconnecting the connector from the
sun sensor, be careful that the wiring must not
come into the instrument panel.
YAD7D280
YAD7D290
SSANGYONG Y200
AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM 7D-33
YAD7D300
YAD7D310
YAD7D320
YAD7D330
SSANGYONG Y200
7D-34 AUTOMATIC CONTROL HVAC SYSTEM
YAD7D340
COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
1. Disconnect the coolant temperature sensor at the
side of the heater core (at left bottom of the glove
box).
2. Installation should follow the removal procedure
in the reverse order.
YAD7D350
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 8A
SEAT BELTS
CAUTION: Disconnect the negative battery cable before removing or installing any electrical unit or when a
tool or equipment could easily come in contact with exposed electrical terminals. Disconnecting this cable
will help prevent personal injury and damage to the vehicle. The ignition must be in B unless otherwise
noted.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Specifications ....................................................... 8A-2 Maintenance and Repair ..................................... 8A-5
Fastener Tightening Specifications ....................... 8A-2 On-Vehicle Service ............................................... 8A-5
Diagnosis .............................................................. 8A-3 Front Seat Belt ..................................................... 8A-5
Seat Belt Warning Lamp is Inoperative ................. 8A-3 Front Seat Belt Buckle ......................................... 8A-6
Component Locator ............................................. 8A-4 2nd-Row Seat Belt ............................................... 8A-7
Seat Belt Assembly ............................................. 8A-4 3rd-Row Seat Belt ................................................ 8A-8
8A-2 SEAT BELTS
SPECIFICATIONS
FASTENER TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Application N•m Lb-Ft Lb-In
Front Seat Belt Adjuster Mounting Bolt 30 - 40 22 - 30 -
Retractor Mounting Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Upper Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Lower Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Belt Buckle Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
2nd-Row Seat Retractor Mounting Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Belt Upper Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
3rd-Row Seat Upper Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Belt Lower Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
Retractor Bolt 30 - 45 22 - 33 -
SSANGYONG Y200
SEAT BELTS 8A-3
DIAGNOSIS
SEAT BELT WARNING LAMP IS INOPERATIVE
SSANGYONG Y200
8A-4 SEAT BELTS
COMPONENT LOCATOR
SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY
YAD8A010
SSANGYONG Y200
SEAT BELTS 8A-5
YAD8A020
3. Pry off the upper bolt cap using the special tool
and remove the upper bolt.
YAD8A030
YAD8A040
SSANGYONG Y200
8A-6 SEAT BELTS
YAD8A050
Installation Procedure
1. Tighten the adjuster and the seat belt retractor
bolt as specified torque.
Installation Notice
YAD8A060
30 - 45 N•m
Upper Bolt (1)
(22 - 33 lb-ft)
30 - 45 N•m
Lower Bolt (2)
(22 - 33 lb-ft)
YAD8A070
YAD8A080
SSANGYONG Y200
SEAT BELTS 8A-7
YAD8A090
YAD8A100
YAD8A110
YAD8A120
SSANGYONG Y200
8A-8 SEAT BELTS
YAD8A130
YAD8A140
YAD8A150
YAD8A160
SSANGYONG Y200
SEAT BELTS 8A-9
30 - 45 N•m
Upper Bolt (1)
(22 - 33 lb-ft)
30 - 45 N•m
Lower Bolt (2)
(22 - 33 lb-ft)
30 - 45 N•m
Retractor Bolt (3)
(22 - 33 lb-ft)
YAD8A170
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 8B
RESTRAINTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description and Operation ..................... 8B-2 Diagnosis .......................................................... 8B-12
General Precautions ............................................. 8B-2 Diagnostic Trouble Codes .................................. 8B-13
SIR System ......................................................... 8B-3 Maintenance and Repair ................................... 8B-16
SIR System Operation ......................................... 8B-3 On-Vehicle Service ............................................. 8B-16
Airbag Module Discard ........................................ 8B-3 Airbag Module (Driver) ....................................... 8B-16
Component Function ............................................ 8B-5 Contact Coil ....................................................... 8B-17
Front Airbag ........................................................ 8B-7 Airbag Module (Passenger) ................................ 8B-18
Side Airbag ......................................................... 8B-8 Belt Pretensioner ............................................... 8B-19
Component Locator ............................................. 8B-9 Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) .............. 8B-19
Driver Airbag Assembly ....................................... 8B-9 Special Tool and Equipment.............................. 8B-20
Passenger Airbag Assembly ............................. 8B-10 Special Tools Table ........................................... 8B-20
Diagnostic Information and Procedures ............ 8B-11
General Diagnosis ............................................. 8B-11
8B-2 RESTRAINTS
- Clock spring
- Sensing and diagnostic module Abbreviation
- Wiring harness
1 SDM Sensing and Diagnostic Module
• When repairing SIR component, follow the service
(SDM)
notice;
- Inspect any SIR part before it is installed. 2 DAB Driver-side Airbag Module
- Use only new parts. 3 PAB Passenger-side Airbag Module
- Do not install used SIR parts from other vehicles. 4 SAB Side Airbag Module
- Do not install any part that has been dropped or (Driver, Passenger)
that has dents, cracks or other defects. 5 PRET Seatbelt Pretensioner
• Before testing, disconnect the negative battery (Driver, Passenger)
cable. Wait one minute for the SDM capacitor to
6 SIS Side Impact Sensor
discharge. The capacitor supplies reserve power
to deploy the airbags, even if the battery is (Driver, passenger)
disconnected. Unintentional deployment of the
airbags can cause injury.
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-3
YAD8B030
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-4 RESTRAINTS
5. Use two additional wires, each at least 10 meters Observe following precaution if the airbag is
(33 feet) long, to reach from the deployment battery deployed:
to the airbag module. • Deploy the airbags only in an evacuated area.
6. Strip 13 mm (0.5 inch) of the insulation from the Service mechanics should be at least 10 meters
ends of these two additional wires. (33 feet).
7. Twist the two wires together at one end. • Do not connect the voltage source until after having
8. Place the twisted ends of the two wires near the completed all other preparations for the deployment
deployment battery. Do not connect the wires to of the airbags.
the battery at this time. • Allow a deployed airbag module or pretensioner to
9. Using the free ends of the 10 meters (33 feet) wires cool for at least 30 minutes before handling.
leading to the airbag module, make two splices, • If the deployment fails, disconnect the voltage
one at each wires from the airbag module. source and wait 5 minutes before approaching the
10. Wrap the splices with insulating tape. vehicle.
11. Now that the free ends of the 10 meters (33 feet) 1. Position the airbag module face up, on flat
wires are spliced to the airbag module wires and ground outdoors, at least 10 meters (33 feet)
the ends that are twisted together are near the from any obstacle or people.
deployment battery, clear the area. 2. Place a vehicle battery at least 10 meters (33
12. Untwist the wires that near the deployment feet) away from the airbag module.
battery. 3. Deploy the airbag module using the deployment
tool. If you do not have deployment tool, cut the
two additional wires to the airbag module and
strip 13 mm (0.5 inch) of the insulation from the
end of the wires leading to the airbag module.
4. Refer to “DEPLOYED AIRBAG MODULE
DISPOSAL PROCEDURE” in this section.
Deployed Airbag Module Disposal
Procedure
After deployment, a powdery residue may be on the
surface of the airbag. The powder consists primarily
of cornstarch (used to lubricate the bag as it inflates)
and by-products of the chemical reaction. Sodium
YAD8B050 hydroxide dust (similar to lye soap) is produced as a
by-product of the deployment reaction. The sodium
13. Touch one wire to the positive battery terminal and
hydroxide then quickly reacts with atmospheric
touch the other wire to the negative battery
moisture and is converted to sodium carbonate and
terminal. The airbag module will deploy.
sodium bicarbonate also known as baking soda}.
14. Refer to “DEPLOYED AIRBAG MODULE Therefore, it is unlikely that sodium hydroxide will be
DISPOSAL PROCEDURE” in this section. present after deployment. Wear gloves and eye
Airbag Module Discard (Passenger) protection during the disposal procedure.
The passenger airbag deployment is the same After deployment, the metal surfaces of the airbag
procedure of the driver’s. Remove the glove box module will be hot. In order to avoid the risk of an
instead of the contact coil and cut two passenger injury or a fire, do not place the deployed airbag module
airbag wires. near any flammable objects, and allow the airbag
module to cool for 30 minutes before handling. Deploy
Refer to “AIRBAG MODULE DISCARD (DRIVER)” in an airbag or pretensioner before disposing of it.
this section for more information.
This includes those in a whole vehicle being scrapped.
Airbag Module Deployment (Outside Vehicle) If the vehicle is still within the warranty period contact
Deploy airbag modules in following situations: the SsangYong regional service manager for approval
or special instructions before deploying an airbag
• If the airbag module is removed in the discarded
vehicle. module or pretensioner.
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-5
COMPONENT FUNCTION
Back (Cushion)
• The airbag system performance is influenced on
the cushion size, shape and position.
• The cushion strength is a important parameter on
the impact absorb effect.
• Therefore, the control of the airbag performance
depends on cushion size, shape, inflator
characteristic and vent hole size for the gas
discharge.
• The cushion’s material and folding function to control
the cushion deployment direction and the YAD8B060
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-6 RESTRAINTS
Safety Sensor The SDM performs a turn-on test when the ignition is
turned ON. The SDM flashes the AIRBAG indicator
The safety sensor is safety device made up of a dual-
seven tomes by supplying an intermittent ground to
contact, electro-mechanical switch that:
the indicator lamp circuit. After flashing seven times,
1. Acts independently of the electronic components. the AIRBAG indicator will turn off if no more
2. Connects the acceleration sensor in series in order malfunctions have been detected.
to make up for the weak points in the current
electronic sensor.
Micro Controller
This device receives the impact signal from the sensor
for vehicle impact and identifies whether the current
condition is necessary for airbag deployment or not.
And then the controller sends the specified currents
to the airbag ignition circuit as needed.
This device always monitors the airbag system in
conduction with the diagnostic circuit. When it is
detected any problem, it illuminates the airbag warning
indicator to inform driver of the fault and stores the
fault information. YAD8B080
Contact Coil
The contact coil is installed between the steering wheel Warning lamp Fault contents
and the steering column and contains a coil that enables status
to contact electrically between the airbag wiring Flash at seven System OK
harness, the driver airbag module and the horn switch.
times for 7 seconds
Notice: Turning the steering wheel more than three
and one-quarter turns may damage the clock spring. and then turn off
The contact coil should never be disassembled and Warning lamp stays System fault
must be replaced if the airbag have been deployed. ON Internal SDM fault
No turn on Power supply circuit open
and fuse open
Warning lamp circuit open
SDM fault
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-7
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-8 RESTRAINTS
SIDE AIRBAG
The side airbag receives each of the side airbag sensor
signal to deploy the airbag when the vehicle crashes
at side impact. The side airbag module is installed
inside the seat. When the airbag is deployed, replace
the deployed front seat assembly.
System Structure
Related System Component
1 Vehicle Structure and B/W 1 Side Airbag Module (LH/RH)
2 Seat System 2 Side Airbag Sensor (LH/RH)
3 Seat Belt System 3 SDM (Common use the SDM for frontal airbag)
4 Door Trim and Door Structure
5 B - Pillar Trim and Structure
6 Airbag Wiring Harness
• Chest, Head and Gas Airbag • Chest, Head and Gas Airbag
• Installed on door or seatback • Installed on door or seatback
SDM
• Operation Circuit
• Safety Sensor
• External Diagnosis
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-9
YAD8B090
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-10 RESTRAINTS
YAD8B100
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-11
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-12 RESTRAINTS
DIAGNOSIS
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-13
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-14 RESTRAINTS
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-15
Caution:
• Use only the scan tool to check the airbag disconnected. Unintentional deployment of the
module and the sensing and diagnostic module airbags can cause injury.
(SDM). Never measure the resistance of an airbag
module with an ohmmeter. An ohmmeter’s
• Do not attempt to repair the supplemental
inflatable restraints (SIR) wiring harness. An SIR
battery can deploy the airbag and cause injury. repair can create a high-resistance connection
• Before testing, disconnect the negative battery which can keep the airbags from deploying when
cable. Wait 1 minute for the SDM capacitor to needed, resulting in injury.
discharge. The capacitor supplies reserve power
to deploy the airbags, even if the battery is
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-16 RESTRAINTS
YAD8B110
YAD8B120
YAD8B130
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-17
CONTACT COIL
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Remove the steering wheel, the lower panel at the
driver side.
YAD8B140
YAD8B150
YAD8B160
YAD8B170
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-18 RESTRAINTS
yyyy
;;;; AIRBAG MODULE (PASSENGER)
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the glove box.
3. Disconnect the airbag module connector.
YAD8B190
YAD8B200
SSANGYONG Y200
RESTRAINTS 8B-19
BELT PRETENSIONER
Removal and Installation Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the upper belt bolt and disconnect the
panel.
3. Disconnect the airbag wiring connector.
4. Remove the mounting bolt of the belt pretensioner
and remove the belt assembly.
YAD8B210
YAD8B220
YAD8B230
YAD8B240
SSANGYONG Y200
8B-20 RESTRAINTS
YAD8B250 YAD8B260
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 9A
GENERAL BODY
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Specification ........................................................ 9A-2 Check ................................................................. 9A-4
Dignosis and Action Taken ................................... 9A-3 Repair ................................................................. 9A-7
Diagnosis for Leaking Water ................................ 9A-3 Special Tool and Equipment................................ 9A-9
Check and Repair ................................................. 9A-4 Special Tools Table .............................................. 9A-9
9A-2 GENERAL BODY
SPECIFICATION
Application Specification
Hood Type Rear Hinge and Type of Front Opening, Gas Lifter
Front Door Structure Front Hinge and Frame Door
Type of Regulator Wire and Drum
Lock System Pin and Fork
Rear Door Structure Front Hinge and Frame Door
Type of Regulator Wire and Drum
Lock System Pin and Fork
Tail Gate Type Internal Hinge, Gas Lifter
Thickness of Wind Shield 5 mm
Glass Front Door Glass 4.0 mm
Rear Door Glass 4.0 mm
Rear Fix Glass 4.0 mm
Glass of Tail Gate Fixing Type 4.0 mm
Opening Type 5.0 mm
Specification Type of Nozzle Spray Nozzle of #1/2 GG-25 or Nozzle with Sloping
of Test Water Angle 60° Equivalent
Leaking Height of Nozzle Keep Distance 1,600 mm from Ground
Quantity of Injecting 14L Per Mir
Pressure 155kPa(22.5 psi): Checking Pressure from nozzle
Position of a Piller Test Stand and Keep Injecting Water, 30° of Lower Direction and 45°
Wing Shield of Backwards, Approximately at the corner of Wind-
shield
Position of “B” Piller Test Stand Keep Injecting Water, 30° of Lower Direction and 45°
of Backwards, Approximately at the corner Line of
Rear Door.
Position of Rear Decklid Test and Tail Keep Injecting Water, 30° of Lower Direction and 45°
Gate Glass of Forwards, Approximately at Distance of 60mm to
the Corner of Rear Door
SSANGYONG Y200
9A-4 GENERAL BODY
YAD9A010
YAD9A020
YAD9A030
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL BODY 9A-5
YAD9A040
SSANGYONG Y200
9A-6 GENERAL BODY
YAD9A0650
Body
Periodically hood and locking system should be fed
for operating smoothly, specially feeding oil to the
section of closing and opening is depending on
operation smooth and prevention of noise.
YAD9A060
YAD9A080
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL BODY 9A-7
REPAIR
Repair Leaking Water
Leaking water on the section of glass can be repaired
without removal of glass.
Notice: Method to repair of following description is
applied on the equipped glass of urethane sealing.
1. Remove leaking moulding and section of trim, to
detect position of leaking water it is necessary for
technician to remove trim and garnish moulding
2. During injecting water on the leaking section, to
detect quantity of leaking water, carefully push
YAD9A090 the glass external area.
3. Mark accurate position of leaking water.
4. Wash section of leaking water and dry up air hose.
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;;;;;
YAD9A100
SSANGYONG Y200
9A-8 GENERAL BODY
YAD9A110
Notice: After repairing section of leaking water
completely, using stand for leaking. test, check
the section of leaking water again, if abnormal
pressure is checked, repaired cohesive material
may get out of position itself. So leaking water
test should not check on local section of leaking .
SSANGYONG Y200
GENERAL BODY 9A-9
09793-21000 09800-21000
Adjusting Wrench of Ornament Remover
Door Wrench
YAD9A120 YAD9A130
09853-31000 09861-31100
Remover of Headlning Cutting Tool of Sealant
Clip
YAD9A140 YAD9A150
YAD9A160 YAD9A170
09861-31400 09861-31000
Glass Holder Remover of Wind Shield
Molding
YAD9A180 YAD9A190
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 9B
BODY INTERIOR
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Components Location ......................................... 9B-2 Trim and Roof .................................................... 9B-10
Instrument Assembly ........................................... 9B-2 Handler ............................................................. 9B-15
Side Trim and Roof Assembly .............................. 9B-3 Sunvisor ............................................................ 9B-15
Seat .................................................................... 9B-4 Room Miror ........................................................ 9B-15
Console ............................................................... 9B-5 Seat .................................................................. 9B-16
Removal and Installation ..................................... 9B-6 Removal and Installation ................................... 9B-18
Instrument ........................................................... 9B-6 Front Seat .......................................................... 9B-18
Console Box ........................................................ 9B-9 Two Row Seat .................................................... 9B-19
Groove Box ....................................................... 9B-10 Seat of Three Row.............................................. 9B-20
9B-2 BODY INTERIOR
COMPONENTS LOCATION
INSTRUMENTS ASSEMBLY
YAD9B010
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-3
YAD9B020
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-4 BODY INTERIOR
SEAT
YAD9B030
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-5
CONSOLE
YAD9B040
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-6 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B050
YAD9B060
YAD9B070
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-7
YAD9B080
YAD9B090
YAD9B100
YAD9B110
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-8 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B120
YAD9B130
YAD9B140
YAD9B150
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-9
YAD9B160
COSOLE BOX
Removal / Installation
1. Separate front console cover and console tray.
YAD9B170
YAD9B180
YAD9B190
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-10 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B200
GROOVE BOX
Removal / Installation
1. Remove hook of left/right side in the groove box
from instrument.
Notice: If excessive force is put on hook, hook
may be broken.
YAD9B210
YAD9B220
A-pillar
1. Remove trim of A-pillar
• Pull key of A-pillar trim out of key home.
YAD9B230
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-11
YAD9B240
YAD9B250
YAD9B260
YAD9B270
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-12 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B280
YAD9B290
YAD9B300
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-13
YAD9B310
YAD9B320
B - pillar trim
1. Release fixing bolt upper and lower of seat belt.
YAD9B330
YAD9B340
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-14 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B350
YAD9B360
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-15
HANDLE
1. After downing handle, release screw.
2. Separate handle.
YAD9B370
SUNVISOR
1. Separate fixing hook of sun-visor.
YAD9B380
YAD9B390
ROOM - MIRROR
1. Pulling room mirror, separate it.
YAD9B400
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-16 BODY INTERIOR
SEAT
Removal / Installation
Front seat
1. Remove plastic cap (3ea) of seat rail.
2. Separate fixing bolt (4ea: M10) of seat rail right
and left.
YAD9B410
YAD9B420
YAD9B430
YAD9B440
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-17
YAD9B450
YAD9B460
YAD9B470
YAD9B480
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-18 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B490
YAD9B500
YAD9B510
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-19
YAD9B520
YAD9B530
YAD9B540
YAD9B550
SSANGYONG Y200
9B-20 BODY INTERIOR
YAD9B560
YAD9B570
YAD9B580
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY INTERIOR 9B-21
YAD9B590
YAD9B600
YAD9B610
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 9C
BODY EXTERIOR
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Parts Components ................................................ 9C-2 Door Lock Assembly ........................................ 9C-25
Front Bumper ...................................................... 9C-2 Door Handle ..................................................... 9C-26
Tail Gate .............................................................. 9C-3 Door Trim .......................................................... 9C-27
Hood ................................................................... 9C-6 Door Opening Weathr Strip ............................... 9C-28
Sun Roof And Roof Rack ..................................... 9C-7 Fork Striker ....................................................... 9C-29
Moulding ............................................................. 9C-8 Tail Gate Crank .................................................. 9C-31
Repair Procedure ................................................. 9C-9 Tail Gate ............................................................ 9C-32
Hood Assembly ................................................. .9C-9 Tail Gate Flip Up System ................................... 9C-33
Cowl Grill ......................................................... ..9C-12 Tail Gate Air Spoiler ........................................... 9C-34
Radiator. Grill .................................................... 9C-13 Check and Adjust Tail Gate ............................... 9C-35
Front Bumper Assembly .................................... 9C-14 Front Door Window ............................................ 9C-37
Rear Bumper Assembly ..................................... 9C-17 Front Door Glass Run And Regulator .................. 9C-38
Back Beam ....................................................... 9C-17 Rear Window ..................................................... 9C-39
Fender ............................................................... 9C-18 Rear Glass Run / Regulator / Channel ................ 9C-40
Fuel Filler Opening System ................................ 9C-20 Wind Shield Glass ............................................. 9C-42
Roof Carrier ....................................................... 9C-21 Front Quarter Glass ............................................ 9C-45
Side Step .......................................................... 9C-21 Rear Quarter Glass ............................................ 9C-48
Side Moulding .................................................. 9C-22 Tail Gate Glass .................................................. 9C-49
Out Side Mirror ................................................. 9C-22 Sun Roof ........................................................... 9C-53
Door Assembly ................................................. 9C-23 Motor And Relay Box ......................................... 9C-54
Door Hinge ....................................................... 9C-24 Glass Panel ....................................................... 9C-56
Door Check Link ............................................... 9C-24 Sun Shade ......................................................... 9C-57
9C-2 BODY EXTERIOR
PARTS COMPONENTS
FRONT BUMPER
YAD9C010
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-3
TAIL GATE
Mechanism
YAD9C020
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-4 BODY EXTERIOR
FLIP- UP SYSTEM
YAD9C030
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-5
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-6 BODY EXTERIOR
HOOD
YAD9C040
1 Bolt 4 Hood
2 Shock Absorber 5 Hood Striker
3 Hood Hinge
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-7
YAD9C050
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-8 BODY EXTERIOR
MOULDING
YAD9C060
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-9
REPAIR PROCEDURE
HOOD ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
1. Release bolt of fixing bracket of shock absorber
in the hood.
Notice: While fixing bracket of shock absorber is
removed, back up hood, to prevent closing of hood
or use another supporting bar to prevent closing
of hood.
YAD9C070
YAD9C080
YAD9C090
YAD9C100
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-10 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C110
YAD9C120
YAD9C130
YAD9C140
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-11
YAD9C150
YAD9C160
YAD9C170
YAD9C180
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-12 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C190
YAD9C200
COWL GRILL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove wiper arm and fixing nut of wiper in the
right and left. (M8)
YAD9C210
YAD9C220
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-13
YAD9C230
YAD9C240
RADIATOR GRILL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove fixing screw (2 ea) of radiator grill and
rivet (3 ea).
YAD9C250
YAD9C260
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-14 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C270
YAD9C280
YAD9C290
YAD9C300
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-15
YAD9C310
YAD9C320
YAD9C330
YAD9C340
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-16 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C350
YAD9C360
YAD9C370
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-17
YAD9C380
YAD9C390
YAD9C380
BACK BEAM
1. After releasing fixing bolt of rear bumper, remove
back beam assembly.
2. Install reverse order of removal.
YAD9C400
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-18 BODY EXTERIOR
FENDER
Removal and Installation
1. Vehicle is fixing safely, and then lift up the vehicle.
Notice: Before the fender is removed, adjust and
check the gap and clearance between front door,
side sill, and front bumper.
YAD9C410
YAD9C420
YAD9C430
YAD9C440
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-19
YAD9C450
YAD9C460
YAD9C470
YAD9C480
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-20 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C490
YAD9C500
YAD9C510
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-21
YAD9C520
ROOF CARRIER
Removal and Installation
1. In order to remove roof carrier , first remove
headlining
2. After releasing fixing nut of roof carrier, remove
roof carrier, assembly.
3. Install reverse order of removal.
YAD9C530
YAD9C540
SIDE STEP
Removal and Installation
1. After releasing bolt and nut of side step , remove
side step assembly.
2. Install reverse order of removal.
Bolt and Nut of Side 16.8 - 31.2 N•m
Step (44 - 52 lb-ft)
YAD9C550
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-22 BODY EXTERIOR
SIDE MOULDING
Removal and Installation
1. After releasing fixing screw of wheel housing
moulding in the front and rear, remove moulding.
YAD9C560
YAD9C570
YAD9C580
OUTSIDE MIRROR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove trim cover of front door.
YAD9C590
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-23
YAD9C600
YAD9C610
DOOR ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
1. remove the negative (-) terminal of battery.
2. After removing the trim of cowl side, separate
connector of door(1).
3. Disassemble the bolt of check link(2ea) in the
body.
4. Disassemble the fixing bolt(3ea) of hinge in the
body.
5. Remove the door assembly.
YAD9C620
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-24 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C630
YAD9C640
DOOR HINGE
Removal and Installation
1. After opening the door, remove hinge of door.
1) Release the bolt(2ea) of in the body side.
2) Release the bolt(2ea) of door.
3) Remove the hinge.
2. Install the reverse order of removal.
YAD9C650
YAD9C660
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-25
YAD9C670
YAD9C680
YAD9C690
YAD9C700
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-26 BODY EXTERIOR
DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. After removing door trim, separate internal handle
cable of door trim.
YAD9C710
YAD9C720
YAD9C730
YAD9C740
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-27
DOOR TRIM
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the negative (-) terminal of battery.
2. Separate power window switch assembly.
YAD9C750
YAD9C760
YAD9C770
YAD9C780
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-28 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C790
YAD9C800
YAD9C810
YAD9C820
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-29
YAD9C830
YAD9C840
YAD9C850
FORK STRIKER
Removal and Inatallation
1. Remove the striker of door lock.
1) Release screw (2 ea).
2) Remove the striker.
2. Install the striker of door lock.
1) Install temporarily striker of door lock .
2) After opening and closing the door, tighten
screw in the proper position.
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-30 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C870
YAD9C880
YAD9C890
YAD9C900
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-31
YAD9C920
YAD9C930
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-32 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C940
YAD9C950
TAIL GATE
Removal and Installation
1. After separating grommet of tail gate and wiring
connector (2 section), remove hose of nozzle
washer.
YAD9C960
YAD9C970
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-33
YAD9C980
YAD9C990
YAD9C0A0
YAD9C0B0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-34 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C0C0
YAD9C0D0
YAD9C0E0
YAD9C0F0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-35
YAD9C0G0
YAD9C0J0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-36 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C0K0
YAD9C0L0
YAD9C0M0
Adjust Flip Up
1. After removing the upper garnish, release little bit
mounting bolt of flip up glass.
YAD9C0N0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-37
YAD9C0P0
YAD9C0Q0
YAD9C0R0
YAD9C0S0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-38 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C0T0
YAD9C0U0
YAD9C0V0
YAD9C0W0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-39
YAD9C0X0
YAD9C0Y0
YAD9C0Z0
REAR WINDOW
Removal and Installation
1. Remove external weather strip of door window
2. Remove front garnish of rear door.
YAD9C1A0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-40 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C1B0
YAD9C1C0
YAD9C1D0
YAD9C1E0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-41
YAD9C1F0
YAD9C1G0
Installation
Fixing Nut of Regulator 8 N•m (26 lb-ft)
YAD9C1H0
YAD9C1J0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-42 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C1K0
YAD9C1L0
YAD9C1M0
YAD9C1N0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-43
;;;;;;
YAD9C1P0
;;;;;;
Installation
1. Clean up section to spread primer of wind shield
;;;;;;
glass by washing.
1) Section of washing keep distance 15 mm from
the end of glass.
;;;;;;
2) After using gauze 20 times, gauze is thrown
away.
;;;;;;
3) Gauze is a solvent (isopropyl alcohol), gauze
keep wet completely.
4) Keep an eye on the washed section of glass
not to be touched by any thing polluted.
YAD9C1Q0 5) After washed glass, spread primer on the glass
section of wet state.
2. Install new wind shield moulding on wind shield
glass.
Notice: After spreading sealant on the glass,
glass should be installed within 5 minutes.
YAD9C1R0
YAD9C1S0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-44 BODY EXTERIOR
;;
4. Wash up flange of wind shield glass.
• After using gauze 20 times, gauze is thrown
away
;;
• Gauze is a solvent (isopropyl alcohol), gauze
keep wet completely
• Keep an eye on the washed section of glass
not to be touched by any thing polluted.
• After washed body flange, spread primer on the
glass section of wet state.
• If oil is stuck on the body flange, primer does
not spread on the body flange.
YAD9C1T0 • After spreading, is available time for use : from
3 hours to 8 hours
• As the body is polluted by primer, as soon as
possible mixing with ethil alcohol and ethil
asetate (as a volume 50 : 50) and with this wet
cloth is wiping solvent.
• Term of validity of primer (90 days) which is
passed is thrown away.
• As spreading primer, flowing into other sections,
pay attention not to pollute other sections.
YAD9C1U0
YAD9C1V0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-45
YAD9C1W0
YAD9C1X0
YAD9C1Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-46 BODY EXTERIOR
;
Installation
1. Wash up body frame (section of glass installed).
2. As keeping distance like the left picture, spread
primer on the section of frame of installed glass.
;;;;
YAD9C1Z0
;;;;
new quarter glass.
;;;; YAD9C2A0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-47
YAD9C2B0
YAD9C2C0
SSANGYONG Y200
;;
;;
9C-48 BODY EXTERIOR
;;
1. After using special tool, remove sealant around
glass.
2. Remove rear quarter glass.
;;
;;
YAD9C2D0
Installation
;;
1. Wash up the section of body frame.
2. As keep distance like the left picture, spread
primer.
YAD9C2E0
YAD9C2F0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-49
YAD9C2G0
YAD9C2H0
YAD9C2J0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-50 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C2K0
YAD9C2L0
Installation
1. Wash up outer panel of tail gate.
• After using gauze 20 times, gauze is thrown
away.
• Gauze is a solvent (isopropyl alcohol), gauze
keep wet completely.
• Keep an eye on the washing section of glass
not to be touched by any thing polluted.
• After washing glass, spread primer on the glass
section of wet state.
• Wash up on the section of spreading primer
YAD9C2M0 without being touched by any thing polluted.
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-51
;;;;;;;
3. Wash up glass tail gate.
• The section washed of glass keep distance 15
;;;;;;;
mm from the end of glass.
• After using gauze 20 times, gauze is thrown
;;;;;;;
away.
• Gauze is a solvent (isopropyl alcohol), gauze
;;;;;;;
keep wet completely.
• Keep an eye on the washing section of glass
;;;;;;;
not to be touched by any thing polluted.
• After washing glass, spread primer on the glass
section of wet state.
YAD9C2P0 • Wash up on the section of spreading primer
without being touched by any thing polluted.
4. Installing dual lock (1) on the glass (2), install the
glass dam.
YAD9C2Q0
SSANGYONG Y200
;;;
9C-52 BODY EXTERIOR
;;;
• Mix up primer.
• Due to excessive spreading, keep eye on
overflowing spreading other section.
;;;
• Available hour for spreading primer to the
vehicle: after 3hour.
• Sealant is not available, if sealant has
sludgematerial.
• If available date of sealant is passed, this
sealant is throwing away. available date of
sealant is 90 day for use.
• After using gauze 20 times, gauze is thrown
away.
• Spread uniformly primer on the surface of glass.
YAD9C2R0
YAD9C2S0
YAD9C2T0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-53
YAD9C2U0
YAD9C2V0
SUN ROOF
Removal and Installation
1. Remove headlining, room lamp, and sun visor.
2. Separate hose clip of drain hose of sun roof
(4 ea), pull hose slow, turning hoses to the left
direction and to the right direction slow.
YAD9C2W0
YAD9C2X0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-54 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C2Y0
YAD9C2Z0
YAD9C3A0
YAD9C3B0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-55
YAD9C3C0
YAD9C3D0
YAD9C3F0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-56 BODY EXTERIOR
GLASS PANEL
Removal
1. Turn on the switch, tilt glass.
YAD9C3G0
YAD9C3H0
YAD9C3J0
Installstion
1. Install glass panel on internal panel of cover
(check the tightening position in the vehicle).
Notice: Install for marking glass indicator to put
rear direction.
YAD9C3K0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-57
YAD9C3L0
YAD9C3M0
YAD9C3N0
SUN SHADE
Removal
1. Remove glass panel.
YAD9C3P0
SSANGYONG Y200
9C-58 BODY EXTERIOR
YAD9C3Q0
YAD9C3R0
YAD9C3S0
Installation
1. Put sun shade on the guide rail.
2. Using driver, pushing slide block of sun shade
panel, and then insert guide rail.
YAD9C3T0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY EXTERIOR 9C-59
YAD9C3U0
SSANGYONG Y200
GROUP 9D
BODY ELECTRICAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Description ............................................. 9D-2 Component Of Lighting ...................................... 9D-27
Notice : Repairing Electrical System ..................... 9D-2 Location Of Lamp .............................................. 9D-31
Specification ........................................................ 9D-6 Horn And Audio System .................................... 9D-39
Diagnosis And Action Taken ................................ 9D-8 Wiper And Washer ............................................ 9D-44
Check And Adjust ............................................. 9D-10 Power Window ................................................... 9D-61
Repair Of Each System ...................................... 9D-13 Switch And Electrical System ............................. 9D-70
Instrument Panel Assembly ............................... 9D-13 Function Of Operation And The Characteristic .... 9D-76
Check And Repair ............................................. 9D-17 Self Diagnosis ................................................... 9D-84
Removal And Installation Of Instrument Panel .... 9D-20 Chart Of Diagnosis ............................................ 9D-85
Switch Of Multi - Function................................... 9D-22 Repair Of The System ........................................ 9D-86
9D-2 BODY ELECTRICAL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
NOTICE: REPAIRING ELECTRICAL
SYSTEM
1. While electrical parts is repaired, first of all
separate negative terminal of battery.
Notice: Before separate and link negative terminal,
turn starting switch or all the switch of lamp off (if
switches are not turned off, parts of semi-
conductor may be impaired).
YAD9D020
YAD9D030
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-3
YAD9D040
YAD9D050
YAD9D060
YAD9D070
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-4 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D080
YAD9D090
YAD9D100
YAD9D110
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-5
YAD9D120
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-6 BODY ELECTRICAL
SPECIFICATION
Description Spec
Multi - function Rated voltage DC 12 V
switch Range for operating temp -30 °C ~ +80 °C
Light switch Illumination: 1 A (Load of relay)
Rated load
Dimmer and passing High beam: 9.2 A
switch Lower beam: 1 A
Passing: 10 A
Switch of turn signal 6.6 ± 0.5
Wiper switch Lower: 5 A, High: 7 A
Intermittemt: 0.22 ± 0.05 A
Fixing: MA X 28 A
Washer switch :4A
Intermittent wiper switch MAX: 25 mmA
Horn connector 1A
Instrument panel Turn signal lamp 14 V,1.4 W Green
Seat belt 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
Charging lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
Fuel indicator lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
High beam 14 V, 3 W Blue
Oil pressure lamp 2.2 V, 20mA Red
Brake lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
Door open warning lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
ABS warning lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Orange
Pre heating lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
Air bag warning lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Red
Hazard lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
4WD check lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Red
4WD high lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Green
4WD low lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
Winter lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Green
Power lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
EBD lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Red
Engine check warning lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
TCS lamp 14 V, 1.4 W Orange
Rear defogger lamp 2.2 V, 20 mA Orange
Lamp Head lamp High beam 55 W X 2
Low beam 55 W X 2
Position lamp 5WX2
Front combi lamp Turn signal lamp 28 W X 2
Fog lamp 27 W X 2
Side mounted lamp 5WX2
High mounted lamp 5WX1
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-7
Description Spec
Lamp Rear combi lamp Tail/ Stop 27 W X 2
Tail lamp 8WX2
Stop lamp 27 W X 2
Turn signal lamp 27 W X 2
Brake lamp 27 W X 2
Licensee lamp 5WX2
Room lamp Front 8WX2
Center 10 W X 1
Rear 10 W X 1
Door lamp 5WX4
Glove box lamp 10 W
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-8 BODY ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-9
Lighting System
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-10 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D140
YAD9D150
YAD9D160
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-11
YAD9D170
;; ;;;
;;;;;
YAD9D180
YAD9D150
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-12 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D190
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-13
YAD9D200
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-14 BODY ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-15
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-16 BODY ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-17
Tacometer
1. Connect tacometer of testing, start engine.
2. Comparing value indicated between tester and
tacometer, error is big enough, replace tacometer.
3. While tacometer is inspected, tap tacometer, and
then remove magnetic power.
YAD9D250
Standard of speed 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000
Error of allowance ± 100 ± 125 ± 150 ± 150 ± 150 ± 180 ± 180 -
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-18 BODY ELECTRICAL
Fuel System
Gauge of fuel
1. Separate connector of fuel sender.
2. Ground connector (B11, B14) of direction of
harness through bulb (12 V, 3.4 W).
3. Turn the start switch on.
4. See if bulb of testing turn on, and see if indicator
of fuel gauge gradually move to position of ‘F’.
YAD9D260
Fuel sender
1. Connect testing bulb (12 V. 3.4 W) of fuel gauge
terminal deepen thermister in the water.
2. See if thermister is deepened in the water, light is
off, and see if thermister get out of water, light is
on.
Notice:
• If malfunction may happen, replace fuel sender
assembly.
• After this testing have done, before fuel sender
is installed, fuel sender should dry up
YAD9D270
completely.
Gauge of Temp
1. Separate wiring connector of water coolant in the
engine room.
2. Ground between testing bulb (12 V,3.4 W) and
connector to harness in a series.
3. Turn ignition switch on.
4. See if testing light turns on or not, check if gauge
of water temp operate or not.
YAD9D280
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-19
YAD9D290
YAD9D300
YAD9D310
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-20 BODY ELECTRICAL
Brake
If the switch of starting turns on, the fluid of brake is
under specified level, or while lever of parking brake
is pulling, sensor of brake or switch of parking brake
is “on” and then warning of brake turns on.
Notice: Sensor of brake fluid is installed on the
reservoir tank of master cylinder.
Door Switch
1. Switch of door is removed, check applying of
electric current between terminals.
2. If applying of electric current between terminals
get out of specification, replace switch of door.
YAD9D340
YAD9D350
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-21
YAD9D360
YAD9D370
YAD9D380
YAD9D390
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-22 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D400
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-23
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-24 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D420 YAD9D450
YAD9D430 YAD9D460
YAD9D440 YAD9D470
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-25
YAD9D480
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-26 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D490
YAD9D500
YAD9D510
YAD9D520
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-27
Fog lamp
Switch of fog lamp is located on the instrument panel
of left gauge panel of audio system, after position lamp
and head lamp are turned on, in the result of this, turn
switch of fog lamp on, so fog lamp is “on”, if switch of
fog lamp is turned on, fog lamp is “on”, indicated
lamp also is turned on,in the instrument panel, instead
of head lamp, fog lamp should not be used, in case
new fog lamp is replaced, adjustment of aiming to the
fog lamp should be inspected.
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-28 BODY ELECTRICAL
Specification
YAD9D530
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-29
YAD9D540
Operation Condition
Lamp
Condition of tail lamp Condition of head lamp Time of delaying
Illumination intensity
Illumination intensity of light on 30.5 ±¾5 (LUX) 8.9 ± 3 (LUX) 0.5 ± 0.1
Illumination intensity of light off 60.5 ±¾5 (LUX) 17.2 ± 3 (LUX) 3±1
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-30 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D550
Check
After turn to position of AUTO, put black cloth on the
section of sensor, check if head lamp, tail lamp are
turned on or not.
YAD9D560
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-31
LOCATION OF LAMP
YAD9D570
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-32 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D580
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-33
Specification of Lamp
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-34 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D590
YAD9D600
YAD9D610
YAD9D620
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-35
YAD9D630
YAD9D640
YAD9D650
YAD9D660
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-36 BODY ELECTRICAL
Side lamp
1. After pushing side lamp to front side, pulling rear
of lamp, and then remove side lamp.
2. After removing the connector, remove side lamp.
YAD9D670
YAD9D680
YAD9D690
YAD9D700
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-37
Door lamp
1. Remove the negative terminal of battery.
2. After removing door trim, and then separate
connector of lamp.
YAD9D710
YAD9D720
YAD9D730
Room lamp
Front lamp
1. After removing lense of lamp, remove bulb.
YAD9D740
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-38 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D750
YAD9D760
YAD9D770
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-39
YAD9D780
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-40 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D790
3. Adjust
• After operating the horn, and then adjust tone
of horn proper (adjust screw of controlling).
Notice: After adjusting screw, spread paint on the
screw of adjusting, do not release screw of
adjusting.
YAD9D800
Speaker
1. Remove front door speaker and rear.
1) Remove door trim and seal.
2) After separating connector of speaker, and then
release fixing screw of speaker.
3) Remove speaker.
4) Install the reverse order of removal.
YAD9D810
YAD9D820
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-41
YAD9D830
YAD9D840
3. Remove audio
• Release fixing screw of audio.
• Separate cable of antenna and connector.
• Remove audio.
4. Install the reverse order of removal.
YAD9D850
YAD9D860
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-42 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D870
YAD9D880
YAD9D890
YAD9D900
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-43
CD Changer
1. Remove the negative terminal of battery and
AUDIO.
2. Separate cable of CD changer from the AUDIO.
YAD9D910
YAD9D920
YAD9D930
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-44 BODY ELECTRICAL
Diagram Of System
Multifunction switch
Control wiper mode and ON/OFF
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-45
;;;;;;;
Wave which is transmitted reflects and reinput
;;;;;;; ;;;;;;
;;;;;;
YAD9D940
1. Unit of sensing rain is sensing by the LED and 3. Unit of sensing rain is correcting itself, so
the diode of photo. regardless of transmitting of windshield, this unit
2. As infrared ray is emitting from LED, diode of is constantly sensing rain.
photo which is reflected by drop of rain is sensing 4. This unit is sensing the area between the LED and
the quantity of rain. diode of photo.
Mode of operation
Wiper control system consist of OFF, MIST, LOW,
WASHER, plus AUTO mode, if turn to the position of
AUTO, rain sensor is sensing drop of rain, and then, is
controliing time of operation, speed of operation with
LOW, HIGH.
YAD9D950
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-46 BODY ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-47
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-48 BODY ELECTRICAL
If parking position of wipe motor is not feeding properly 3. On the turning, Applying the current between
or not, if parking position of wipe motor is not feeding, contact point of W of CAM switch and contact point
wiper motor can be operated quickly rather than the of C, relay 2 of CONT is “OFF” and relay 1 is
state of normal, intermittent speed shifting time of wiper “ON” and then, turn motor clock wise, wiper is
motor is not sensing, wiper motor is not operated operating between position of B and position of C
normally. by transfering pole of motor.
Notice: While unit of rain sensor is removed.
Operation of parking mode
1. Remove exterior cover, at this time, if exterior cover
1. Parking on the operation with the clockwise : Under
is removed by compulsion, keep in mind not to
the wiper is operating,switch of wiper is “off” On
break fixing hook of coupler, as exterior cover is
the turning,applying the current between contact
removed, using hole of cover by driver, after section
point of W of CAM switch and contact point C,
of fixing hook is pushing, and remove them.
after relay 1 is off, stopping the motor, within
2. As rain sensor is removed from coupler, using approximately 1 second, relay 2 of CONT is on,
driver after open up spring clip, remove them. turning motor counter-clockwise, apply the current
3. Remove connector to the wiring from the sensor. between “P” ground of CAM switch and C ground,
and then relay 2 of CONT is OFF, motor can stop.
Rear Wiper System Operation for washer mode
Turn washer switch on above 0.5 second, after
Summary
operation of wiper mode is operating twice, after
Controlling of existing rear wiper is controlled by relay operation of parking mode is operating and then motor
which is operated with switch, but rear wiper of Rexton is stopped, but if washer switch is on below 0.5 second,
is controlled by ECU, in the existing vehicle, brush of wiper motor is not operating.
rear wipe is installed on the rear glass, but rear glass
can is opened up, brush of rear wiper can not be Mode operation of limit switch ON
installed, so,this one is installed on the back panel, 1. Limit switch on: Under wiper is operating while
wiper motor is operating by second stage. wiper is operating, limit switch is “ON”,
immediately back to the position of parking, and
then stop the motor.
2. Limit switch on at the position of parking.
Though turn wiper switch or intermittent switch
on, motor is not operated.
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-49
;;
;;
;;;
YAD9D970 YAD9D990
YAD9D980
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-50 BODY ELECTRICAL
Trouble Shooting
Flow Chart – Mode Of Wiper Operation
ON
Ground of “W” is “ ON” ?
YES
ON
Ground of “W” is “ ON”?
YES
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-51
Parking Mode
Parking is under operation of the clock wise. Parking is under operation of the counter clock
wise.
NO NO
Ground of “W is “ON” ? Ground of “W is “ON” ?
YES YES
NO NO
Ground of P is ON ? Ground of P is ON ?
YES YES
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-52 BODY ELECTRICAL
NO
Is it passing time o.5 second
YES
NO
Ground of “W” is ON ?
YES
NO
Ground of “W” is ON ?
YES
NO
Ground of “W” is ON ?
YES
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-53
NO
Wiper switch is ON, or Intermittent is
Ground of W is ON?
ON
YES
NO
Ground of P is ON ?
YES
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-54 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D0A0
YAD9D0B0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-55
Specification
Description Specification
Motor Rated voltage DC 12 V ± 0.3 V
Test voltage DC 13.5 ± 0.3 V
Range of allowed voltage DC 10 - 15 V
Minimum operating voltage DC 8 V
Insulated resistence 500 V 1 MΩ
Restraint test Torque 1.1 Km
Current 14 A
YAD9D0C0
Range of atmosphere temp allowed - 40 °c ~ + 80°C
Control Rated voltage DC 12 V
Range of allowed voltage DC 9 ~ 16 V
Range of allowed temperature - 30 °C ~ + 80°C
Range of conserved temperature - 40 °C~ + 90°C
Insulated resistence 1 MΩ
(500 V)
Voltage dropping 0.5 V
YAD9D0D0
Test voltage 14.0 ± 0.5 A
Load allowed current 10 A
Circuit diagram
;
;
YAD9D0E0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-56 BODY ELECTRICAL
Components
YAD9D0F0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-57
YAD9D0G0
YAD9D0H0
YAD9D0J0
YAD9D0K0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-58 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D0L0
YAD9D0M0
YAD9D0N0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-59
Check
Check speed of front wiper motor
1. Remove connector from the motor of wiper.
2. Connect positive terminal into 3 terminal and
negative terminal into 6 terminal.
3. Check motor with low speed.
4. Connect positive terminal into 3 terminal and
negative terminal into 5 terminal.
5. Check motor with high speed.
YAD9D0P0
YAD9D0Q0
YAD9D0R0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-60 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D0S0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-61
POWER WINDOW
Components
YAD9D0T0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-62 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D0U0
YAD9D0V0
YAD9D0W0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-63
YAD9D0Z0
YAD9D0X0
YAD9D0Y0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-64 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D1C0
Passenger seat
YAD9D1A0
Rear seat
YAD9D1B0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-65
YAD9D1D0
YAD9D1E0
YAD9D1F0
YAD9D1G0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-66 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D1H0
YAD9D1J0
YAD9D1K0
YAD9D1L0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-67
5) Slim brush
Clean up the section of defogger which is broken,
indicating like left picture, with the state which is
sticking masking tape, clean up with alcohol. After
mixing between paint of applying electric current
and thinner per interval of 15 minutes, paint 3
times. Before power is supplying, pull tape out of
the section broken, to finish up better, after drying
up completely (approximately after one day),
remove the edge painting unnecessary with knife.
Notice: After repairing, clean up glass with the
soft towel, grid line with the towel wet.
YAD9D1M0
YAD9D1N0
YAD9D1P0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-68 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D1Q0
YAD9D1S0
YAD9D1T0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-69
YAD9D1U0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-70 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D1V0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-71
Description of System
Unit of seat position and seat warmer
This unit is located on the lower section of passenger
which controls driver seat and out side mirror manual
operation, put in memory, function of returning and
also has a function which warm up seat and fold up
outside mirror.
YAD9D1W0
Function of Operation
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-72 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D1X0
Item Description
Operation condition 1. Position of selector lever is “ P and N on condition that, ignition switch is
“ON”
2. Automatic vehicle: P/N or parking brake is “ON”
3. Manual transmission : parking brake is “ON”
4. Memory return is operating at the state of stop (vehicle speed : 0 km/h).
The state of operation: Another 1. If position button is operating while memory is returning, memory is
condition is set under function returnng as memory is set on before.
of memory is returning 2. While memory is returning, button of stop is set, return operation is stoping
immediately.
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-73
YAD9D1Y0
YAD9D1Z0
YAD9D2A0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-74 BODY ELECTRICAL
Power seat
Connector and connected circuit
YAD9D2C0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-75
YAD9D2D0
YAD9D2E0
Stics
Summary
Stics which is electron control unit, has the function of
sixteen, if stics is unnormal at the sensor or load, unit
of stics has self –diagnosis.
YAD9D2F0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-76 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D2H0
YAD9D2J0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-77
YAD9D2L0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-78 BODY ELECTRICAL
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-79
YAD9D2R0
YAD9D2S0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-80 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D2T0
YAD9D2U0
YAD9D2V0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-81
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-82 BODY ELECTRICAL
2. operation of alarm
• After the situation of robbery vigilance is set on,
not released the situation of robbery vigilance,
with all the door, tail gate and hood are closing,
after this situation are going on more than one
second, if door, tail gate and hood is opened,
alarm should be operating immediately.
• If only one thing among alarm conditions is
satisfied, immediately the operation should begin
to start, siren is operating continuously for 27
seconds, after siren,condition of alarming is again
satisfied, once again siren is operating
continuously for 27 seconds.
• Under the state of vigilance, if only tail gate is
opened by key, the state of vigilance should be
set on the regular state of vigilance into secondary
state of vigilance.(At this time, proceed alarming
as open up tail gate, hood, assist and rear door )
In other words, while not being releasing condition
of vigilance, although switch of tail gate is turned
on, alarming is not operating, state of closing tail
YAD9D2Y0
gate is going on more than one seconds, again
back to regular state of vigilance, with siren once,
tail lamp is “ON/OFF” two times for 0.5 seconds.
Under the operation of alarming, if battery is
removed, and then if the battery is installed, state
of memory which is previously removed gets
back, this state will be operating.
3. set vigilance of robbery free
• In case switch of driver key cylinder is unlocked
or rekes is unlocked, IGN1 OR IGN2 is turned,
under the those condition only, should be set
vigilance of robbery free.(while alarming of
robbery is turned on, turn IGN1, IGN2 ON, relay
of start inhibitor is “OFF”, alarming of robbery
is continuously operating for remaining times )
• Setting vigilance of robbery free is released by
key of driver seat, key of tail gate, unlock of
rekes and lock.
YAD9D2Z0
YAD9D3A0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-83
YAD9D3B0
YAD9D3C0
YAD9D3D0
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-84 BODY ELECTRICAL
SELF DIAGNOSIS
Summary
After using the service connector which is installed on
the instrument panel of lower driver seat, each failure
is diagnosed internal unit of stics, can be checked the
state of normal or mode of failure.
YAD9D3E0
Method to Diagnose
1. While failure is checking, use buzzer
2. While the switch of diagnosis is turned “ON”,
(stics of diagnosis socket box : number 7 and
ground 1 is connected), the following operation
should not proceed.
• warning : the first step of light is “ ON”(buzzer
is not operating, lock or unlock of door is not
operating)
• warning of seat belt(chime bell is not operating )
• warning of key reminder (chime bell is not
operating, lock or unlock of door is not operating)
• central door lock(lock or unlock of door is not
operating)
3. While switch of diagnosis is “OFF”, function of
number 2 should get back to original position
4. While switch of diagnosis is “ON,” data which is
diagnosed should output only once
5. If switch is operated by operation of other switch,
among them, first input data will be output(buzzer
is “ON”), and output is “OFF” for one seconds,
and remaining input data is proceeding output.
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-85
CHART OF DIAGNOSIS
SSANGYONG Y200
9D-86 BODY ELECTRICAL
YAD9D3G0
YAD9D3H0
Switch of Center IP
1. After panel of center IP is removed, each switch
can be separated.
2. After center panel is removed, disconnect
connector
3. Separate each switch from removed panel.
4. Install the reverse order of removal.
Notice: While each switch is checked, refer to the
following circuit, and then check whether apply
an electric current or not,
YAD9D3J0
• Switch of front fog lamp
Digital Watch
1. Remove the center panel
2. After releasing fixing screw from the panel, remove
the digital watch.
3. After digital watch is fixing on the panel, link the
connector, and then install panel on the panel of
IP.
YAD9D3K0
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY ELECTRICAL 9D-87
YAD9D3L0
YAD9D3M0
YAD9D3N0
Siren
1. After opening up the hood, disconnect the
negative terminal of battery.
2. Disconnect the connector (indicating arrow) of
siren.
3. After fixing bolt is released, remove the siren
4. Install the reverse order of removal.
YAD9D3P0
SSANGYONG Y200
SECTION 9E
YAD9E010
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION 9E-3
FRAME
YAD9E020
SSANGYONG Y200
9E-4 BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION
YAD9E030
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION 9E-5
YAD9E040
SSANGYONG Y200
9E-6 BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION
ENGINE ROOM
YAD9E050
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION 9E-7
YAD9E060
SSANGYONG Y200
9E-8 BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION
TAIL GATE
YAD9E070
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION 9E-9
CHART OF GAP
YAD9E080
SSANGYONG Y200
9E-10 BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION
YAD9E090
SSANGYONG Y200
BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION 9E-11
UNDER COATING
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;;
; ;
;;;;;;;;;
;;;;;;;;; YAD9E100
SSANGYONG Y200
9E-12 BODY’S MEASURING DIMENSION
BODY MOUNTING
Mounting Point
YAD9E110
SSANGYONG Y200